Ti-82 Stats
Ti-82 Stats
Ti-82 Stats
DOC TI-83 Intl English, Title Page Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 11:55 AM Printed: 10/28/05
11:57 AM Page iii of 8
TI-82 STATS
GRAPHING CALCULATOR
GUIDEBOOK
1996, 2000, 2005 Texas Instruments Incorporated.
IBM is a registered trademark of International Business Machines Corporation
Macintosh is a registered trademark of Apple Computer, Inc.
82STAT~2.DOC TI-83 Intl English, Title Page Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 11:55 AM Printed: 10/28/05
11:57 AM Page iv of 8
Texas Instruments makes no warranty, either expressed or implied,
including but not limited to any implied warranties of merchantability
and fitness for a particular purpose, regarding any programs or book
materials and makes such materials available solely on an as-is basis.
In no event shall Texas Instruments be liable to anyone for special,
collateral, incidental, or consequential damages in connection with or
arising out of the purchase or use of these materials, and the sole and
exclusive liability of Texas Instruments, regardless of the form of action,
shall not exceed the purchase price of this equipment. Moreover, Texas
Instruments shall not be liable for any claim of any kind whatsoever
against the use of these materials by any other party.
This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a
Class B digital device, pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC rules. These limits
are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful
interference in a residential installation. This equipment generates, uses,
and can radiate radio frequency energy and, if not installed and used in
accordance with the instructions, may cause harmful interference with
radio communications. However, there is no guarantee that interference
will not occur in a particular installation.
If this equipment does cause harmful interference to radio or television
reception, which can be determined by turning the equipment off and on,
you can try to correct the interference by one or more of the following
measures:
Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna.
Increase the separation between the equipment and receiver.
Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit different from
that to which the receiver is connected.
Consult the dealer or an experienced radio/television technician for
help.
Caution: Any changes or modifications to this equipment not expressly
approved by Texas Instruments may void your authority to operate the
equipment.
Important
US FCC
Information
Concerning
Radio Frequency
Interference
Introduction iii
82STAT~2.DOC TI-83 Intl English, Title Page Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 11:55 AM Printed: 10/28/05
11:57 AM Page iii of 8
This manual describes how to use the TI-82 STATS Graphing Calculator. Getting
Started is an overview of TI-82 STATS features. Chapter 1 describes how the
TI-82 STATS operates. Other chapters describe various interactive features. Chapter
17 shows how to combine these features to solve problems.
TI-82 STATS Keyboard..................................................................................... 2
TI-82 STATS Menus............................................................................................ 4
First Steps.................................................................................................................... 5
Entering a Calculation: The Quadratic Formula................................. 6
Converting to a Fraction: The Quadratic Formula ............................ 7
Displaying Complex Results: The Quadratic Formula................... 8
Defining a Function: Box with Lid............................................................. 9
Defining a Table of Values: Box with Lid............................................. 10
Zooming In on the Table: Box with Lid.................................................. 11
Setting the Viewing Window: Box with Lid......................................... 12
Displaying and Tracing the Graph: Box with Lid ............................. 13
Zooming In on the Graph: Box with Lid................................................. 15
Finding the Calculated Maximum: Box with Lid.............................. 16
Other TI-82 STATS Features.......................................................................... 17
Turning On and Turning Off the TI-82 STATS................................. 1-2
Setting the Display Contrast ............................................................................ 1-3
The Display ................................................................................................................ 1-4
Entering Expressions and Instructions...................................................... 1-6
TI-82 STATS Edit Keys..................................................................................... 1-8
Setting Modes ........................................................................................................... 1-9
Using TI-82 STATS Variable Names ....................................................... 1-13
Storing Variable Values ..................................................................................... 1-14
Recalling Variable Values ................................................................................ 1-15
ENTRY (Last Entry) Storage Area.............................................................. 1-16
Ans (Last Answer) Storage Area.................................................................. 1-18
TI-82 STATS Menus............................................................................................ 1-19
VARS and VARS Y.VARS Menus.............................................................. 1-21
Equation Operating System (EOS)......................................................... 1-22
Error Conditions...................................................................................................... 1-24
Table of Contents
Getting Started:
Do This First!
Chapter 1:
Operating the
TI-82 STATS
iv Introduction
82STAT~2.DOC TI-83 Intl English, Title Page Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 11:55 AM Printed: 10/28/05
11:57 AM Page iv of 8
Getting Started: Coin Flip................................................................................. 2-2
Keyboard Math Operations.............................................................................. 2-3
MATH Operations................................................................................................... 2-5
Using the Equation Solver ................................................................................ 2-8
MATH NUM (Number) Operations.............................................................. 2-13
Entering and Using Complex Numbers.................................................... 2-16
MATH CPX (Complex) Operations ............................................................ 2-18
MATH PRB (Probability) Operations........................................................ 2-20
ANGLE Operations................................................................................................ 2-23
TEST (Relational) Operations........................................................................ 2-25
TEST LOGIC (Boolean) Operations .......................................................... 2-26
Getting Started: Graphing a Circle.............................................................. 3-2
Defining Graphs ...................................................................................................... 3-3
Setting the Graph Modes ................................................................................... 3-4
Defining Functions ................................................................................................ 3-5
Selecting and Deselecting Functions.......................................................... 3-7
Setting Graph Styles for Functions.............................................................. 3-9
Setting the Viewing Window Variables................................................... 3-11
Setting the Graph Format .................................................................................. 3-13
Displaying Graphs.................................................................................................. 3-15
Exploring Graphs with the Free-Moving Cursor................................ 3-17
Exploring Graphs with TRACE..................................................................... 3-18
Exploring Graphs with the ZOOM Instructions .................................. 3-20
Using ZOOM MEMORY.................................................................................... 3-23
Using the CALC (Calculate) Operations.................................................. 3-25
Getting Started: Path of a Ball........................................................................ 4-2
Defining and Displaying Parametric Graphs ........................................ 4-4
Exploring Parametric Graphs.......................................................................... 4-7
Getting Started: Polar Rose.............................................................................. 5-2
Defining and Displaying Polar Graphs..................................................... 5-3
Exploring Polar Graphs ...................................................................................... 5-6
Table of Contents (continued)
Chapter 2:
Math, Angle, and
Test Operations
Chapter 3:
Function
Graphing
Chapter 4:
Parametric
Graphing
Chapter 5:
Polar Graphing
Introduction v
82STAT~2.DOC TI-83 Intl English, Title Page Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 11:55 AM Printed: 10/28/05
11:57 AM Page v of 8
Getting Started: Forest and Trees................................................................. 6-2
Defining and Displaying Sequence Graphs........................................... 6-3
Selecting Axes Combinations......................................................................... 6-8
Exploring Sequence Graphs............................................................................. 6-9
Graphing Web Plots.............................................................................................. 6-11
Using Web Plots to Illustrate Convergence........................................... 6-12
Graphing Phase Plots ........................................................................................... 6-13
Comparing TI-82 STATS and TI.82 Sequence Variables........... 6-15
Keystroke Differences Between TI-82 STATS and TI-82.......... 6-16
Getting Started: Roots of a Function.......................................................... 7-2
Setting Up the Table............................................................................................. 7-3
Defining the Dependent Variables............................................................... 7-4
Displaying the Table............................................................................................. 7-5
Getting Started: Drawing a Tangent Line............................................... 8-2
Using the DRAW Menu...................................................................................... 8-3
Clearing Drawings ................................................................................................. 8-4
Drawing Line Segments..................................................................................... 8-5
Drawing Horizontal and Vertical Lines ................................................... 8-6
Drawing Tangent Lines ...................................................................................... 8-8
Drawing Functions and Inverses................................................................... 8-9
Shading Areas on a Graph ................................................................................ 8-10
Drawing Circles....................................................................................................... 8-11
Placing Text on a Graph..................................................................................... 8-12
Using Pen to Draw on a Graph...................................................................... 8-13
Drawing Points on a Graph.............................................................................. 8-14
Drawing Pixels......................................................................................................... 8-16
Storing Graph Pictures (Pic)............................................................................ 8-17
Recalling Graph Pictures (Pic)....................................................................... 8-18
Storing Graph Databases (GDB)................................................................... 8-19
Recalling Graph Databases (GDB).............................................................. 8-20
Getting Started: Exploring the Unit Circle............................................. 9-2
Using Split Screen.................................................................................................. 9-3
Horiz (Horizontal) Split Screen..................................................................... 9-4
G-T (Graph-Table) Split Screen.................................................................... 9-5
TI-82 STATS Pixels in Horiz and G-T Modes .................................... 9-6
Chapter 6:
Sequence
Graphing
Chapter 7:
Tables
Chapter 8:
DRAW
Operations
Chapter 9:
Split Screen
vi Introduction
82STAT~2.DOC TI-83 Intl English, Title Page Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 11:55 AM Printed: 10/28/05
11:57 AM Page vi of 8
Getting Started: Systems of Linear Equations ..................................... 10-2
Defining a Matrix................................................................................................... 10-3
Viewing and Editing Matrix Elements...................................................... 10-4
Using Matrices with Expressions................................................................. 10-7
Displaying and Copying Matrices................................................................ 10-8
Using Math Functions with Matrices......................................................... 10-9
Using the MATRX MATH Operations ....................................................... 10-12
Getting Started: Generating a Sequence .................................................. 11-2
Naming Lists.............................................................................................................. 11-3
Storing and Displaying Lists........................................................................... 11-4
Entering List Names ............................................................................................. 11-6
Attaching Formulas to List Names.............................................................. 11-7
Using Lists in Expressions................................................................................ 11-9
LIST OPS Menu...................................................................................................... 11-10
LIST MATH Menu.................................................................................................. 11-17
Getting Started: Pendulum Lengths and Periods................................ 12-2
Setting up Statistical Analyses....................................................................... 12-10
Using the Stat List Editor .................................................................................. 12-11
Attaching Formulas to List Names.............................................................. 12-14
Detaching Formulas from List Names...................................................... 12-16
Switching Stat List Editor Contexts............................................................ 12-17
Stat List Editor Contexts.................................................................................... 12-18
STAT EDIT Menu .................................................................................................. 12-20
Regression Model Features.............................................................................. 12-22
STAT CALC Menu................................................................................................ 12-24
Statistical Variables............................................................................................... 12-29
Statistical Analysis in a Program.................................................................. 12-30
Statistical Plotting................................................................................................... 12-31
Statistical Plotting in a Program.................................................................... 12-37
Getting Started: Mean Height of a Population..................................... 13-2
Inferential Stat Editors......................................................................................... 13-6
STAT TESTS Menu ............................................................................................. 13-9
Inferential Statistics Input Descriptions ................................................... 13-26
Test and Interval Output Variables.............................................................. 13-28
Distribution Functions......................................................................................... 13-29
Distribution Shading............................................................................................. 13-35
Table of Contents (continued)
Chapter 10:
Matrices
Chapter 11:
Lists
Chapter 12:
Statistics
Chapter 13:
Inferential
Statistics and
Distributions
Introduction vii
82STAT~2.DOC TI-83 Intl English, Title Page Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 11:55 AM Printed: 10/28/05
11:57 AM Page vii of 8
Getting Started: Financing a Car................................................................... 14-2
Getting Started: Computing Compound Interest ................................ 14-3
Using the TVM Solver ......................................................................................... 14-4
Using the Financial Functions........................................................................ 14-5
Calculating Time Value of Money (TVM).............................................. 14-6
Calculating Cash Flows...................................................................................... 14-8
Calculating Amortization................................................................................... 14-9
Calculating Interest Conversion.................................................................... 14-12
Finding Days between Dates/Defining Payment Method....................... 14-13
Using the TVM Variables................................................................................... 14-14
Browsing the TI-82 STATS CATALOG.................................................. 15-2
Entering and Using Strings............................................................................... 15-3
Storing Strings to String Variables.............................................................. 15-4
String Functions and Instructions in the CATALOG........................ 15-6
Hyperbolic Functions in the CATALOG.................................................. 15-10
Getting Started: Volume of a Cylinder..................................................... 16-2
Creating and Deleting Programs................................................................... 16-4
Entering Command Lines and Executing Programs ........................ 16-5
Editing Programs .................................................................................................... 16-6
Copying and Renaming Programs............................................................... 16-7
PRGM CTL (Control) Instructions.............................................................. 16-8
PRGM I/O (Input/Output) Instructions..................................................... 16-16
Calling Other Programs as Subroutines ................................................... 16-22
Comparing Test Results Using Box Plots............................................... 17-2
Graphing Piecewise Functions....................................................................... 17-4
Graphing Inequalities........................................................................................... 17-5
Solving a System of Nonlinear Equations.............................................. 17-6
Using a Program to Create the Sierpinski Triangle.......................... 17-7
Graphing Cobweb Attractors .......................................................................... 17-8
Using a Program to Guess the Coefficients........................................... 17-9
Graphing the Unit Circle and Trigonometric Curves ...................... 17-10
Finding the Area between Curves................................................................ 17-11
Using Parametric Equations: Ferris Wheel Problem........................ 17-12
Demonstrating the Fundamental Theorem of Calculus.................. 17-14
Computing Areas of Regular N-Sided Polygons................................ 17-16
Computing and Graphing Mortgage Payments ................................... 17-18
Chapter 14:
Financial
Functions
Chapter 15:
CATALOG,
Strings,
Hyperbolic
Functions
Chapter 16:
Programming
Chapter 17:
Applications
viii Introduction
82STAT~2.DOC TI-83 Intl English, Title Page Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 11:55 AM Printed: 10/28/05
11:57 AM Page viii of 8
Checking Available Memory.......................................................................... 18-2
Deleting Items from Memory......................................................................... 18-3
Clearing Entries and List Elements............................................................. 18-4
Resetting the TI-82 STATS............................................................................. 18-5
Getting Started: Sending Variables............................................................. 19-2
TI-82 STATS LINK............................................................................................... 19-3
Selecting Items to Send....................................................................................... 19-4
Receiving Items ....................................................................................................... 19-5
Transmitting Items................................................................................................. 19-6
Transmitting Lists to a TI-82.......................................................................... 19-8
Transmitting from a TI-82 to a TI-82 STATS..................................... 19-9
Backing Up Memory............................................................................................ 19-10
Table of Functions and Instructions............................................................ A-2
Menu Map................................................................................................................... A-39
Variables....................................................................................................................... A-49
Statistical Formulas............................................................................................... A-50
Financial Formulas ................................................................................................ A-54
Battery Information............................................................................................... B-2
In Case of Difficulty............................................................................................. B-4
Error Conditions...................................................................................................... B-5
Accuracy Information.......................................................................................... B-10
Support and Service Information.................................................................. B-12
Warranty Information.......................................................................................... B-13
Table of Contents (continued)
Chapter 18:
Memory
Management
Chapter 19:
Communication
Link
Appendix A:
Tables and
Reference
Information
Appendix B:
General
Information
Index
Getting Started 1
82STAT~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/27/05 1:33 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:30
PM Page 1 of 18
Getting Started:
Do This First!
TI-82 STATS Keyboard..................................................................................... 2
TI-82 STATS Menus............................................................................................ 4
First Steps.................................................................................................................... 5
Entering a Calculation: The Quadratic Formula................................. 6
Converting to a Fraction: The Quadratic Formula ............................ 7
Displaying Complex Results: The Quadratic Formula................... 8
Defining a Function: Box with Lid............................................................. 9
Defining a Table of Values: Box with Lid............................................. 10
Zooming In on the Table: Box with Lid.................................................. 11
Setting the Viewing Window: Box with Lid......................................... 12
Displaying and Tracing the Graph: Box with Lid ............................. 13
Zooming In on the Graph: Box with Lid................................................. 15
Finding the Calculated Maximum: Box with Lid.............................. 16
Other TI-82 STATS Features.......................................................................... 17
Contents
2 Getting Started
82STAT~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/27/05 1:33 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:30
PM Page 2 of 18
Generally, the keyboard is divided into these zones: graphing keys, editing keys,
advanced function keys, and scientific calculator keys.
Graphing keys access the interactive graphing features.
Editing keys allow you to edit expressions and values.
Advanced function keys display menus that access the advanced
functions.
Scientific calculator keys access the capabilities of a standard
scientific calculator.
TI-82 STATS Keyboard
Keyboard Zones
Editing Keys
Advanced
Function Keys
Scientific
Calculator Keys
Graphing Keys
Getting Started 3
82STAT~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/27/05 1:33 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:30
PM Page 3 of 18
The keys on the TI-82 STATS are color-coded to help you
easily locate the key you need.
The gray keys are the number keys. The blue keys along the right
side of the keyboard are the common math functions. The blue keys
across the top set up and display graphs.
The primary function of each key is printed in white on the key.
For example, when you press , the MATH menu is
displayed.
The secondary function of each key is printed in yellow above
the key. When you press the yellow y key, the character,
abbreviation, or word printed in yellow above the other keys
becomes active for the next keystroke. For example, when you
press y and then , the TEST menu is displayed. This
guidebook describes this keystroke combination as y [TEST].
The alpha function of each key is printed in green above the
key. When you press the green key, the alpha character
printed in green above the other keys becomes active for the
next keystroke. For example, when you press and then
, the letter A is entered. This guidebook describes this
keystroke combination as [A].
Using the
Color.Coded
Keyboard
Using the y
and Keys
The y key
accesses the
second function
printed in yellow
above each key.
The key
accesses the alpha
function printed in
green above each
key.
4 Getting Started
82STAT~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/27/05 1:33 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:30
PM Page 4 of 18
Displaying a Menu
While using your TI-82 STATS, you often will
need to access items from its menus.
When you press a key that displays a menu, that
menu temporarily replaces the screen where you
are working. For example, when you press ,
the MATH menu is displayed as a full screen.
After you select an item from a menu, the screen
where you are working usually is displayed again.
Moving from One Menu to Another
Some keys access more than one menu. When you
press such a key, the names of all accessible
menus are displayed on the top line. When you
highlight a menu name, the items in that menu are
displayed. Press ~ and | to highlight each menu
name.
Selecting an Item from a Menu
The number or letter next to the current menu item
is highlighted. If the menu continues beyond the
screen, a down arrow ( $ ) replaces the colon ( : )
in the last displayed item. If you scroll beyond the
last displayed item, an up arrow ( # ) replaces the
colon in the first item displayed.You can select an
item in either of two ways.
Press or } to move the cursor to the number
or letter of the item; press .
Press the key or key combination for the
number or letter next to the item.
Leaving a Menu without Making a Selection
You can leave a menu without making a selection
in any of three ways.
Press to return to the screen where
you were.
Press y [QUIT] to return to the home screen.
Press a key for another menu or screen.
TI-82 STATS Menus
Getting Started 5
82STAT~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/27/05 1:33 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:30
PM Page 5 of 18
Before starting the sample problems in this chapter, follow the steps on this page to
reset the TI-82 STATS to its factory settings and clear all memory. This ensures that
the keystrokes in this chapter will produce the illustrated results.
To reset the TI-82 STATS, follow these steps.
1. Press to turn on the calculator.
2. Press and release y, and then press [MEM]
(above ).
When you press y, you access the operation
printed in yellow above the next key that you
press. [MEM] is the yoperation of the
key.
The MEMORY menu is displayed.
3. Press 5 to select 5:Reset.
The RESET menu is displayed.
4. Press 1 to select 1:All Memory.
The RESET MEMORY menu is displayed.
5. Press 2 to select 2:Reset.
All memory is cleared, and the calculator is
reset to the factory default settings.
When you reset the TI-82 STATS, the display
contrast is reset.
If the screen is very light or blank, press
and release y, and then press and hold }
to darken the screen.
If the screen is very dark, press and release
y, and then press and hold to lighten
the screen.
First Steps
6 Getting Started
82STAT~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/27/05 1:33 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:30
PM Page 6 of 18
Use the quadratic formula to solve the quadratic equations 3X
2
+ 5X + 2 = 0 and 2X
2
N X + 3 = 0. Begin with the equation 3X
2
+ 5X + 2 = 0.
1. Press 3 [A] (above ) to
store the coefficient of the X
2
term.
2. Press [ : ] (above ). The colon allows
you to enter more than one instruction on a
line.
3. Press 5 [B] (above ) to
store the coefficient of the Xterm. Press
[ : ] to enter a new instruction on the
same line. Press 2 [C] (above
) to store the constant.
4. Press to store the values to the variables
A, B, and C.
The last value you stored is shown on the right
side of the display. The cursor moves to the
next line, ready for your next entry.
5. Press [B] y[] [B]
4 [A] [C] 2
[A] to enter the expression for one
of the solutions for the quadratic formula,
+ b b ac
a
2
4
2
6. Press to find one solution for the
equation 3X
2
+ 5X + 2 = 0.
The answer is shown on the right side of the
display. The cursor moves to the next line,
ready for you to enter the next expression.
Entering a Calculation: The Quadratic Formula
Getting Started 7
82STAT~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/27/05 1:33 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:30
PM Page 7 of 18
You can show the solution as a fraction.
1. Press to display the MATH menu.
2. Press 1 to select 1:4Frac from the MATH menu.
When you press 1, Ans4Frac is displayed on
the home screen. Ans is a variable that
contains the last calculated answer.
3. Press to convert the result to a fraction.
To save keystrokes, you can recall the last expression you entered, and then edit it for
a new calculation.
4. Press y [ENTRY] (above ) to recall the
fraction conversion entry, and then press y
[ENTRY] again to recall the quadratic-formula
expression,
+ b b ac
a
2
4
2
5. Press } to move the cursor onto the + sign in
the formula. Press to edit the quadratic-
formula expression to become:
b b ac
a
2
4
2
6. Press to find the other solution for the
quadratic equation 3X
2
+ 5X + 2 = 0.
Converting to a Fraction: The Quadratic Formula
8 Getting Started
82STAT~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/27/05 1:33 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:30
PM Page 8 of 18
Now solve the equation 2X
2
N X + 3 = 0. When you set a+bi complex number mode,
the TI-82 STATS displays complex results.
1. Press z (6 times), and
then press ~ to position the cursor over a+bi.
Press to select a+bi complex-number
mode.
2. Press y [QUIT] (above z) to return to the
home screen, and then press to clear it.
3. Press 2 [A] [ : ] 1
[B] [ : ] 3
[C] .
The coefficient of the X
2
term, the coefficient
of the X term, and the constant for the new
equation are stored to A, B, and C,
respectively.
4. Press y [ENTRY] to recall the store
instruction, and then press y[ENTRY] again
to recall the quadratic-formula expression,
b b ac
a
2
4
2
5. Press to find one solution for the
equation 2X
2
N X + 3 = 0.
6. Press y [ENTRY] repeatedly until this
quadratic-formula expression is displayed:
+ b b ac
a
2
4
2
7. Press to find the other solution for the
quadratic equation: 2X
2
N X + 3 = 0.
Note: An alternative for solving equations for real numbers is to use the built-in Equation
Solver (Chapter 2).
Displaying Complex Results: The Quadratic Formula
Getting Started 9
82STAT~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/27/05 1:33 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:30
PM Page 9 of 18
Take a 20 cm. 25 cm. sheet of paper and cut X X squares from two corners. Cut
X 12.5 cm. rectangles from the other two corners as shown in the diagram below.
Fold the paper into a box with a lid. What value of X would give your box the
maximum volume V? Use the table and graphs to determine the solution.
Begin by defining a function that describes the
volume of the box.
From the diagram: 2X + A = 20
2X + 2B = 25
V = A B X
Substituting: V = (20 N 2X) (252 N X) X
1. Press o to display the Y= editor, which is
where you define functions for tables and
graphing.
2. Press 20 2 25 2
to define the volume
function as Y1 in terms of X.
lets you enter X quickly, without
having to press . The highlighted = sign
indicates that Y1 is selected.
Defining a Function: Box with Lid
20
A
X
X B X B
25
10 Getting Started
82STAT~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/27/05 1:33 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:30
PM Page 10 of 18
The table feature of the TI-82 STATS displays numeric information about a function.
You can use a table of values from the function defined on page 9 to estimate an
answer to the problem.
1. Press y [TBLSET] (above p) to display
the TABLE SETUP menu.
2. Press to accept TblStart=0.
3. Press 1 to define the table increment
@Tbl=1. Leave Indpnt: Auto and
Depend: Auto so that the table will be
generated automatically.
4. Press y [TABLE] (above s) to display
the table.
Notice that the maximum value for Y1 (boxs
volume) occurs when X is about 4, between 3
and 5.
5. Press and hold to scroll the table until a
negative result for Y1 is displayed.
Notice that the maximum length of X for this
problem occurs where the sign of Y1 (boxs
volume) changes from positive to negative,
between 10 and 11.
6. Press y [TBLSET].
Notice that TblStart has changed to 6 to reflect
the first line of the table as it was last
displayed. (In step 5, the first value of X
displayed in the table is 6.)
Defining a Table of Values: Box with Lid
Getting Started 11
82STAT~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/27/05 1:33 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:30
PM Page 11 of 18
You can adjust the way a table is displayed to get more information about a defined
function. With smaller values for @Tbl, you can zoom in on the table.
1. Press 3 to set TblStart. Press 1
to set @Tbl.
This adjusts the table setup to get a more
accurate estimate of X for maximum volume
Y1.
2. Press y [TABLE].
3. Press and } to scroll the table.
Notice that the maximum value for Y1 is
410.26, which occurs at X=3.7. Therefore, the
maximum occurs where 3.6<X<3.8.
4. Press y [TBLSET]. Press 3 6 to set
TblStart. Press 01 to set @Tbl.
5. Press y [TABLE], and then press and }to
scroll the table.
Four equivalent maximum values are shown,
410.60 at X=3.67, 3.68, 3.69, and 3.70.
6. Press and } to move the cursor to 3.67.
Press ~ to move the cursor into the Y1
column.
The value of Y1 at X=3.67 is displayed on the
bottom line in full precision as 410.261226.
7. Press to display the other maximums.
The value of Y1 at X=3.68 in full precision is
410.264064, at X=3.69 is 410.262318, and at
X=3.7 is 410.256.
The maximum volume of the box would occur
at 3.68 if you could measure and cut the paper at
.01-cm. increments.
Zooming In on the Table: Box with Lid
12 Getting Started
82STAT~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/27/05 1:33 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:30
PM Page 12 of 18
You also can use the graphing features of the TI-82 STATS to find the maximum
value of a previously defined function. When the graph is activated, the viewing
window defines the displayed portion of the coordinate plane. The values of the
window variables determine the size of the viewing window.
1. Press p to display the window editor,
where you can view and edit the values of the
window variables.
The standard window variables define the
viewing window as shown. Xmin, Xmax,
Ymin, and Ymax define the boundaries of the
display. Xscl and Yscl define the distance
between tick marks on the X and Y axes. Xres
controls resolution.
Xmax
Ymin
Ymax
Xscl
Yscl
Xmin
2. Press 0 to define Xmin.
3. Press 20 2 to define Xmax using an
expression.
4. Press . The expression is evaluated, and
10 is stored in Xmax. Press to accept
Xscl as 1.
5. Press 0 500 100 1
to define the remaining window variables.
Setting the Viewing Window: Box with Lid
Getting Started 13
82STAT~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/27/05 1:33 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:30
PM Page 13 of 18
Now that you have defined the function to be graphed and the window in which to
graph it, you can display and explore the graph. You can trace along a function using
the TRACE feature.
1. Press s to graph the selected function in
the viewing window.
The graph of Y1=(20N2X)(252NX)X is
displayed.
2. Press ~ to activate the free-moving graph
cursor.
The X and Y coordinate values for the position
of the graph cursor are displayed on the
bottom line.
3. Press |, ~, }, and to move the free-
moving cursor to the apparent maximum of the
function.
As you move the cursor, the X and Y
coordinate values are updated continually.
Displaying and Tracing the Graph: Box with Lid
14 Getting Started
82STAT~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/27/05 1:33 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:30
PM Page 14 of 18
4. Press r. The trace cursor is displayed on
the Y1 function.
The function that you are tracing is displayed
in the top-left corner.
5. Press | and ~ to trace along Y1, one X dot at
a time, evaluating Y1 at each X.
You also can enter your estimate for the
maximum value of X.
6. Press 3 8. When you press a number key
while in TRACE, the X= prompt is displayed in
the bottom-left corner.
7. Press .
The trace cursor jumps to the point on the Y1
function evaluated at X=3.8.
8. Press | and ~ until you are on the maximum
Y value.
This is the maximum of Y1(X) for the X pixel
values. The actual, precise maximum may lie
between pixel values.
Displaying and Tracing the Graph: Box with Lid (cont.)
Getting Started 15
82STAT~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/27/05 1:33 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:30
PM Page 15 of 18
To help identify maximums, minimums, roots, and intersections of functions, you can
magnify the viewing window at a specific location using the ZOOM instructions.
1. Press q to display the ZOOM menu.
This menu is a typical TI-82 STATS menu. To
select an item, you can either press the number
or letter next to the item, or you can press
until the item number or letter is highlighted,
and then press .
2. Press 2 to select 2:Zoom In.
The graph is displayed again. The cursor has
changed to indicate that you are using a ZOOM
instruction.
3. With the cursor near the maximum value of
the function (as in step 8 on page 14), press
.
The new viewing window is displayed. Both
XmaxNXmin and YmaxNYmin have been
adjusted by factors of 4, the default values for
the zoom factors.
4. Press p to display the new window
settings.
Zooming In on the Graph: Box with Lid
16 Getting Started
82STAT~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/27/05 1:33 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:30
PM Page 16 of 18
You can use a CALCULATE menu operation to calculate a local maximum of a
function.
1. Press y [CALC] (above r) to display the
CALCULATE menu. Press 4 to select
4:maximum.
The graph is displayed again with a
Left Bound? prompt.
2. Press | to trace along the curve to a point to
the left of the maximum, and then press
.
A 4 at the top of the screen indicates the
selected bound.
A Right Bound? prompt is displayed.
3. Press ~ to trace along the curve to a point to
the right of the maximum, and then press
.
A 3 at the top of the screen indicates the
selected bound.
A Guess? prompt is displayed.
4. Press | to trace to a point near the maximum,
and then press .
Or, press 3 8, and then press to enter
a guess for the maximum.
When you press a number key in TRACE, the
X= prompt is displayed in the bottom-left
corner.
Notice how the values for the calculated
maximum compare with the maximums found
with the free-moving cursor, the trace cursor,
and the table.
Note: In steps 2 and 3 above, you can enter values
directly for Left Bound and Right Bound, in the same
way as described in step 4.
Finding the Calculated Maximum: Box with Lid
Getting Started 17
82STAT~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/27/05 1:33 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:30
PM Page 17 of 18
Getting Started has introduced you to basic TI-82 STATS operation. This guidebook
describes in detail the features you used in Getting Started. It also covers the other
features and capabilities of the TI-82 STATS.
You can store, graph, and analyze up to 10 functions (Chapter
3), up to six parametric functions (Chapter 4), up to six polar
functions (Chapter 5), and up to three sequences (Chapter 6).
You can use DRAW operations to annotate graphs (Chapter 8).
You can generate sequences and graph them over time. Or, you
can graph them as web plots or as phase plots (Chapter 6).
You can create function evaluation tables to analyze many
functions simultaneously (Chapter 7).
You can split the screen horizontally to display both a graph and
a related editor (such as the Y= editor), the table, the stat list
editor, or the home screen. Also, you can split the screen
vertically to display a graph and its table simultaneously
(Chapter 9).
You can enter and save up to 10 matrices and perform standard
matrix operations on them (Chapter 10).
You can enter and save as many lists as memory allows for use
in statistical analyses. You can attach formulas to lists for
automatic computation. You can use lists to evaluate
expressions at multiple values simultaneously and to graph a
family of curves (Chapter 11).
You can perform one- and two-variable, list-based statistical
analyses, including logistic and sine regression analysis. You
can plot the data as a histogram, xyLine, scatter plot, modified
or regular box-and-whisker plot, or normal probability plot. You
can define and store up to three stat plot definitions (Chapter
12).
Other TI-82 STATS Features
Graphing
Sequences
Tables
Split Screen
Matrices
Lists
Statistics
18 Getting Started
82STAT~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/27/05 1:33 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:30
PM Page 18 of 18
You can perform 16 hypothesis tests and confidence intervals
and 15 distribution functions. You can display hypothesis test
results graphically or numerically (Chapter 13).
You can use time-value-of-money (TVM) functions to analyze
financial instruments such as annuities, loans, mortgages, leases,
and savings. You can analyze the value of money over equal
time periods using cash flow functions. You can amortize loans
with the amortization functions (Chapter 14).
The CATALOG is a convenient, alphabetical list of all functions
and instructions on the TI-82 STATS. You can paste any
function or instruction from the CATALOG to the current cursor
location (Chapter 15).
You can enter and store programs that include extensive control
and input/output instructions (Chapter 16).
You can connect your TI-82 STATS to a personal computer
using TI Connect software and a TI Connectivity cable. The
software is included on the CD in the TI-82 STATS package.
When you connect to the TI Connect software, the TI-82
STATS calculator will be identified by TI Connect as a TI-83
calculator. Everything else should function as expected.
For more information, consult the TI Connect Help.
The TI-82 STATS has a port to connect and communicate with
another TI-82 STATS, a TI.82, the Calculator-Based
Laboratory (CBL) System, a Calculator-Based Ranger
(CBR), or a personal computer. The unit-to-unit link cable is
included with the TI-82 STATS (Chapter 19).
Other TI-82 STATS Features (continued)
Inferential
Statistics
Financial
Functions
CATALOG
Programming
Linking to a PC
or Macintosh
Operating the TI-82 STATS 1-1
82STAT~3.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 12:11 PM Printed: 10/28/05 12:11
PM Page 1 of 24
1
Operating
the TI-82 STATS
Turning On and Turning Off the TI-82 STATS................................. 2
Setting the Display Contrast ............................................................................ 3
The Display ................................................................................................................ 4
Entering Expressions and Instructions...................................................... 6
TI-82 STATS Edit Keys..................................................................................... 8
Setting Modes ........................................................................................................... 9
Using TI-82 STATS Variable Names ....................................................... 13
Storing Variable Values ..................................................................................... 14
Recalling Variable Values ................................................................................ 15
ENTRY (Last Entry) Storage Area.............................................................. 16
Ans (Last Answer) Storage Area................................................................. 18
TI-82 STATS Menus............................................................................................ 19
VARS and VARS Y.VARS Menus.............................................................. 21
Equation Operating System (EOS)......................................................... 22
Error Conditions...................................................................................................... 24
Contents
1-2 Operating the TI-82 STATS
82STAT~3.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 12:11 PM Printed: 10/28/05 12:11
PM Page 2 of 24
To turn on the TI-82 STATS, press .
If you previously had turned off the calculator by pressing
y [OFF], the TI-82 STATS displays the home screen as it
was when you last used it and clears any error.
If Automatic Power Down (APD) had previously turned
off the calculator, the TI-82 STATS will return exactly as you
left it, including the display, cursor, and any error.
To prolong the life of the batteries, APD turns off the
TI-82 STATS automatically after about five minutes without any
activity.
To turn off the TI-82 STATS manually, press y [OFF].
All settings and memory contents are retained by Constant
Memory.
Any error condition is cleared.
The TI-82 STATS uses four AAA alkaline batteries and has a
user-replaceable backup lithium battery (CR1616 or CR1620).
To replace batteries without losing any information stored in
memory, follow the steps in Appendix B.
Turning On and Turning Off the TI-82 STATS
Turning On the
Calculator
Turning Off the
Calculator
Batteries
Operating the TI-82 STATS 1-3
82STAT~3.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 12:11 PM Printed: 10/28/05 12:11
PM Page 3 of 24
You can adjust the display contrast to suit your viewing angle and
lighting conditions. As you change the contrast setting, a number
from 0 (lightest) to 9 (darkest) in the top-right corner indicates the
current level. You may not be able to see the number if contrast is
too light or too dark.
Note: The TI-82 STATS has 40 contrast settings, so each number 0
through 9 represents four settings.
The TI-82 STATS retains the contrast setting in memory when
it is turned off.
To adjust the contrast, follow these steps.
1. Press and release the y key.
2. Press and hold or }, which are below and above the
contrast symbol (yellow, half-shaded circle).
lightens the screen.
} darkens the screen.
Note: If you adjust the contrast setting to 0, the display may become
completely blank. To restore the screen, press and release y, and
then press and hold } until the display reappears.
When the batteries are low, a low-battery message is displayed
when you turn on the calculator.
To replace the batteries without losing any information in
memory, follow the steps in Appendix B.
Generally, the calculator will continue to operate for one or two
weeks after the low-battery message is first displayed. After this
period, the TI-82 STATS will turn off automatically and the unit
will not operate. Batteries must be replaced. All memory is
retained.
Note: The operating period following the first low-battery message
could be longer than two weeks if you use the calculator infrequently.
Setting the Display Contrast
Adjusting the
Display Contrast
When to Replace
Batteries
1-4 Operating the TI-82 STATS
82STAT~3.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 12:11 PM Printed: 10/28/05 12:11
PM Page 4 of 24
The TI-82 STATS displays both text and graphs. Chapter 3
describes graphs. Chapter 9 describes how the TI-82 STATS can
display a horizontally or vertically split screen to show graphs
and text simultaneously.
The home screen is the primary screen of the TI-82 STATS. On
this screen, enter instructions to execute and expressions to
evaluate. The answers are displayed on the same screen.
When text is displayed, the TI-82 STATS screen can display a
maximum of eight lines with a maximum of 16 characters per
line. If all lines of the display are full, text scrolls off the top of
the display. If an expression on the home screen, the Y= editor
(Chapter 3), or the program editor (Chapter 16) is longer than
one line, it wraps to the beginning of the next line. In numeric
editors such as the window screen (Chapter 3), a long
expression scrolls to the right and left.
When an entry is executed on the home screen, the answer is
displayed on the right side of the next line.
Entry
Answer
The mode settings control the way the TI-82 STATS interprets
expressions and displays answers (page 1.9).
If an answer, such as a list or matrix, is too long to display
entirely on one line, an ellipsis (...) is displayed to the right or
left. Press ~ and | to scroll the answer.
Entry
Answer
To return to the home screen from any other screen, press y
[QUIT].
When the TI-82 STATS is calculating or graphing, a vertical
moving line is displayed as a busy indicator in the top-right
corner of the screen. When you pause a graph or a program, the
busy indicator becomes a vertical moving dotted line.
The Display
Types of
Displays
Home Screen
Displaying
Entries and
Answers
Returning to the
Home Screen
Busy Indicator
Operating the TI-82 STATS 1-5
82STAT~3.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 12:11 PM Printed: 10/28/05 12:11
PM Page 5 of 24
In most cases, the appearance of the cursor indicates what will
happen when you press the next key or select the next menu
item to be pasted as a character.
Cursor Appearance Effect of Next Keystroke
Entry Solid rectangle
$
A character is entered at the cursor;
any existing character is overwritten
Insert Underline
__
A character is inserted in front of the
cursor location
Second Reverse arrow
y [ENTRY]
The TI-82 STATS retains as many previous entries as possible
in ENTRY, up to a capacity of 128 bytes. To scroll those entries,
press y [ENTRY] repeatedly. If a single entry is more than 128
bytes, it is retained for ENTRY, but it cannot be placed in the
ENTRY storage area.
1 A
2 B
y [ENTRY]
If you press y [ENTRY] after displaying the oldest stored
entry, the newest stored entry is displayed again, then the next-
newest entry, and so on.
y [ENTRY]
ENTRY (Last Entry) Storage Area
Using ENTRY
(Last Entry)
Accessing a
Previous Entry
Operating the TI-82 STATS 1-17
82STAT~3.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 12:11 PM Printed: 10/28/05 12:11
PM Page 17 of 24
After you have pasted the last entry to the home screen and
edited it (if you chose to edit it), you can execute the entry. To
execute the last entry, press .
To reexecute the displayed entry, press again. Each
reexecution displays an answer on the right side of the next line;
the entry itself is not redisplayed.
0 N
N 1 N
: N
147 y[ANS]
You can use Ans as the first entry in the next expression without
entering the value again or pressing y [ANS]. On a blank line
on the home screen, enter the function. The TI-82 STATS pastes
the variable name Ans to the screen, then the function.
5 2
9 9
3 3
27
You can leave a menu without making a selection in any of four
ways.
Press y [QUIT] to return to the home screen.
Press to return to the previous screen.
Press a key or key combination for a different menu, such as
or y [LIST].
Press a key or key combination for a different screen, such
as o or y [TABLE].
TI-82 STATS Menus (continued)
Selecting an Item
from a Menu
Leaving a Menu
without Making a
Selection
Operating the TI-82 STATS 1-21
82STAT~3.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 12:11 PM Printed: 10/28/05 12:11
PM Page 21 of 24
You can enter the names of functions and system variables in an
expression or store to them directly.
To display the VARS menu, press . All VARS menu items
display secondary menus, which show the names of the system
variables. 1:Window, 2:Zoom, and 5:Statistics each access
more than one secondary menu.
VARS Y-VARS
1: Window... X/Y, T/q, and U/V/W variables
2: Zoom... ZX/ZY, ZT/Zq, and ZU variables
3: GDB... Graph database variables
4: Picture... Picture variables
5: Statistics... XY, G, EQ, TEST, and PTS variables
6: Table... TABLE variables
7: String... String variables
To display the VARS Y.VARS menu, press ~.
1:Function, 2:Parametric, and 3:Polar display secondary menus
of the Y= function variables.
VARS Y-VARS
1: Function... Yn functions
2: Parametric... XnT, YnT functions
3: Polar... rn functions
4: On/Off... Lets you select/deselect functions
Note: The sequence variables (u, v, w) are located on the keyboard
as the second functions of , , and .
To select a variable from the VARS or VARS Y.VARS menu,
follow these steps.
1. Display the VARS or VARS Y.VARS menu.
Press to display the VARS menu.
Press ~ to display the VARS Y.VARS menu.
2. Select the type of variable, such as 2:Zoom from the VARS
menu or 3:Polar from the VARS Y.VARS menu. A secondary
menu is displayed.
3. If you selected 1:Window, 2:Zoom, or 5:Statistics from the
VARS menu, you can press ~ or | to display other
secondary menus.
4. Select a variable name from the menu. It is pasted to the
cursor location.
VARS and VARS Y.VARS Menus
VARS Menu
Selecting a
Variable from the
VARS Menu or
VARS Y.VARS
Menu
1-22 Operating the TI-82 STATS
82STAT~3.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 12:11 PM Printed: 10/28/05 12:11
PM Page 22 of 24
The Equation Operating System (EOS) defines the order in
which functions in expressions are entered and evaluated on the
TI-82 STATS. EOS lets you enter numbers and functions in a
simple, straightforward sequence.
EOS evaluates the functions in an expression in this order:
1 Single-argument functions that precede the argument,
such as (, sin(, or log(
2 Functions that are entered after the argument, such as
2
,
M1
, !, ,
r
, and conversions
3 Powers and roots, such as 2^5 or 5
x
32
4 Permutations (nPr) and combinations (nCr)
5 Multiplication, implied multiplication, and division
6 Addition and subtraction
7 Relational functions, such as > or
8 Logic operator and
9 Logic operators or and xor
Within a priority level, EOS evaluates functions from left to
right.
Calculations within parentheses are evaluated first.
Multiargument functions, such as nDeriv(A
2
,A,6), are evaluated
as they are encountered.
Equation Operating System (EOS)
Order of
Evaluation
Operating the TI-82 STATS 1-23
82STAT~3.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 12:11 PM Printed: 10/28/05 12:11
PM Page 23 of 24
The TI-82 STATS recognizes implied multiplication, so you
need not press to express multiplication in all cases. For
example, the TI-82 STATS interprets 2p, 4sin(46), 5(1+2), and
(2 5)7 as implied multiplication.
Note: TI-82 STATS implied multiplication rules differ from those of the
TI.82. For example, the TI-82 STATS evaluates 12X as (12) X,
while the TI.82 evaluates 12X as 1/(2 X) (Chapter 2).
All calculations inside a pair of parentheses are completed first.
For example, in the expression 4(1+2), EOS first evaluates the
portion inside the parentheses, 1+2, and then multiplies the
answer, 3, by 4.
You can omit the close parenthesis ( ) ) at the end of an
expression. All open parenthetical elements are closed
automatically at the end of an expression. This is also true for
open parenthetical elements that precede the store or display-
conversion instructions.
Note: An open parenthesis following a list name, matrix name, or Y=
function name does not indicate implied multiplication. It specifies
elements in the list (Chapter 11) or matrix (Chapter 10) and specifies
a value for which to solve the Y= function.
To enter a negative number, use the negation key. Press and
then enter the number. On the TI-82 STATS, negation is in the
third level in the EOS hierarchy. Functions in the first level,
such as squaring, are evaluated before negation.
For example, MX
2
, evaluates to a negative number (or 0). Use
parentheses to square a negative number.
Note: Use the key for subtraction and the key for negation. If
you press to enter a negative number, as in 9 7, or if you
press to indicate subtraction, as in 9 7, an error occurs. If you
press A B, it is interpreted as implied multiplication
(A MB).
Implied
Multiplication
Parentheses
Negation
1-24 Operating the TI-82 STATS
82STAT~3.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 12:11 PM Printed: 10/28/05 12:11
PM Page 24 of 24
The TI-82 STATS detects errors while performing these tasks.
Evaluating an expression
Executing an instruction
Plotting a graph
Storing a value
When the TI-82 STATS detects an error, it returns an error
message as a menu title, such as ERR:SYNTAX or
ERR:DOMAIN. Appendix B describes each error type and
possible reasons for the error.
If you select 1:Quit (or press y [QUIT] or ), then the
home screen is displayed.
If you select 2:Goto, then the previous screen is displayed
with the cursor at or near the error location.
Note: If a syntax error occurs in the contents of a Y= function during
program execution, then the Goto option returns to the Y= editor, not
to the program.
To correct an error, follow these steps.
1. Note the error type (ERR:error type).
2. Select 2:Goto, if it is available. The previous screen is
displayed with the cursor at or near the error location.
3. Determine the error. If you cannot recognize the error, refer
to Appendix B.
4. Correct the expression.
Error Conditions
Diagnosing an
Error
Correcting an
Error
Math, Angle, and Test Operations 2.1
82STAT~4.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 12:19 PM Printed: 10/28/05 12:20
PM Page 1 of 26
2
Math, Angle, and Test
Operations
Getting Started: Coin Flip................................................................................. 2
Keyboard Math Operations.............................................................................. 3
MATH Operations................................................................................................... 5
Using the Equation Solver ................................................................................ 8
MATH NUM (Number) Operations.............................................................. 13
Entering and Using Complex Numbers.................................................... 16
MATH CPX (Complex) Operations ............................................................ 18
MATH PRB (Probability) Operations........................................................ 20
ANGLE Operations................................................................................................ 23
TEST (Relational) Operations........................................................................ 24
TEST LOGIC (Boolean) Operations .......................................................... 26
Contents
2.2 Math, Angle, and Test Operations
82STAT~4.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 12:19 PM Printed: 10/28/05 12:20
PM Page 2 of 26
82STAT~4.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 12:19 PM Printed: 10/28/05 12:20
PM Page 2 of 26
Getting Started is a fast-paced introduction. Read the chapter for details.
Suppose you want to model flipping a fair coin 10 times. You want to track how
many of those 10 coin flips result in heads. You want to perform this simulation 40
times. With a fair coin, the probability of a coin flip resulting in heads is 0.5 and the
probability of a coin flip resulting in tails is 0.5.
1. Begin on the home screen. Press |to
display the MATH PRB menu. Press 7 to select
7:randBin( (random Binomial). randBin( is
pasted to the home screen. Press 10 to enter the
number of coin flips. Press . Press 5 to
enter the probability of heads. Press . Press
40 to enter the number of simulations. Press .
2. Press to evaluate the expression. A list of
40 elements is displayed. The list contains the
count of heads resulting from each set of 10
coin flips. The list has 40 elements because this
simulation was performed 40 times. In this
example, the coin came up heads five times in
the first set of 10 coin flips, five times in the
second set of 10 coin flips, and so on.
3. Press y L1 to store the data to
the list name L1. You then can use the data for
another activity, such as plotting a histogram
(Chapter 12).
4. Press ~ or | to view the additional counts in
the list. Ellipses (...) indicate that the list
continues beyond the screen.
Note: Since randBin( generates random
numbers, your list elements may differ from those
in the example.
Getting Started: Coin Flip
Math, Angle, and Test Operations 2.3
82STAT~4.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 12:19 PM Printed: 10/28/05 12:20
PM Page 3 of 26
Math operations that are valid for lists return a list calculated
element by element. If you use two lists in the same expression,
they must be the same length.
You can use + (addition, ), N (subtraction, ),
(multiplication, ), and (division, ) with real and complex
numbers, expressions, lists, and matrices. You cannot use with
matrices.
valueA+valueB valueA N valueB
valueA valueB valueA valueB
You can use the trigonometric (trig) functions (sine, ;
cosine, ; and tangent, ) with real numbers, expressions,
and lists. The current angle mode setting affects interpretation.
For example, sin(30) in Radian mode returns L.9880316241; in
Degree mode it returns .5.
sin(value) cos(value) tan(value)
You can use the inverse trig functions (arcsine, y [SIN
L1
];
arccosine, y [COS
L1
]; and arctangent, y [TAN
L1
]) with real
numbers, expressions, and lists. The current angle mode setting
affects interpretation.
sin
L1
(value) cos
L1
(value) tan
L1
(value)
Note: The trig functions do not operate on complex numbers.
You can use ^ (power, ),
2
(square, ), and ( (square root,
y []) with real and complex numbers, expressions, lists, and
matrices. You cannot use ( with matrices.
value^power value
2
(value)
You can use
L1
(inverse, ) with real and complex numbers,
expressions, lists, and matrices. The multiplicative inverse is
equivalent to the reciprocal, 1x.
value
L1
Keyboard Math Operations
Using Lists with
Math Operations
+ (Addition),
N (Subtraction),
(Multiplication),
(Division)
Trigonometric
Functions
^ (Power),
2
(Square),
( (Square Root)
L1
(Inverse)
2.4 Math, Angle, and Test Operations
82STAT~4.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 12:19 PM Printed: 10/28/05 12:20
PM Page 4 of 26
82STAT~4.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 12:19 PM Printed: 10/28/05 12:20
PM Page 4 of 26
You can use log( (logarithm, ), 10^( (power of 10, y
[10
x
]), and ln( (natural log, ) with real or complex numbers,
expressions, and lists.
log(value) 10^(power) ln(value)
e^( (exponential, y e
x
]) returns the constant e raised to a
power. You can use e^( with real or complex numbers,
expressions, and lists.
e^(power)
e (constant, y [e]) is stored as a constant on the TI-82 STATS
. Press y [e] to copy e to the cursor location. In calculations,
the TI-82 STATS uses 2.718281828459 for e.
M (negation, ) returns the negative of value. You can use M
with real or complex numbers, expressions, lists, and matrices.
Mvalue
EOS rules (Chapter 1) determine when negation is evaluated.
For example, LA
2
returns a negative number, because squaring is
evaluated before negation. Use parentheses to square a negated
number, as in (LA)
2
.
Note: On the TI-82 STATS, the negation symbol (M) is shorter and
higher than the subtraction sign ( N), which is displayed when you
press .
p (Pi, y [p]) is stored as a constant in the TI-82 STATS. In
calculations, the TI-82 STATS uses 3.1415926535898 for p.
Keyboard Math Operations (continued)
log(,
10^(,
ln(
e^( (Exponential)
e (Constant)
L (Negation)
p (Pi)
Math, Angle, and Test Operations 2.5
82STAT~4.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 12:19 PM Printed: 10/28/05 12:20
PM Page 5 of 26
To display the MATH menu, press .
MAT
H
NUM CPX PRB
1: 4Frac Displays the answer as a fraction.
2: 4Dec Displays the answer as a decimal.
3:
3
Calculates the cube.
4:
3
( Calculates the cube root.
5:
x
Calculates the x
th
root.
6: fMin( Finds the minimum of a function.
7: fMax( Finds the maximum of a function.
8: nDeriv( Computes the numerical derivative.
9: fnInt( Computes the function integral.
0: Solver... Displays the equation solver.
4Frac (display as a fraction) displays an answer as its rational
equivalent. You can use 4Frac with real or complex numbers,
expressions, lists, and matrices. If the answer cannot be
simplified or the resulting denominator is more than three digits,
the decimal equivalent is returned. You can only use 4Frac
following value.
value 4Frac
4Dec (display as a decimal) displays an answer in decimal form.
You can use 4Dec with real or complex numbers, expressions,
lists, and matrices. You can only use 4Dec following value.
value 4Dec
MATH Operations
MATH Menu
4Frac,
4Dec
2.6 Math, Angle, and Test Operations
82STAT~4.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 12:19 PM Printed: 10/28/05 12:20
PM Page 6 of 26
82STAT~4.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 12:19 PM Printed: 10/28/05 12:20
PM Page 6 of 26
3
(cube) returns the cube of value. You can use
3
with real or
complex numbers, expressions, lists, and square matrices.
value
3
3
( (cube root) returns the cube root of value. You can use
3
(
with real or complex numbers, expressions, and lists.
3
(value)
x
(x
th
root) returns the x
th
root of value. You can use
x
with
real or complex numbers, expressions, and lists.
x
th
root
x
value
fMin( (function minimum) and fMax( (function maximum) return
the value at which the local minimum or local maximum value
of expression with respect to variable occurs, between lower
and upper values for variable. fMin( and fMax( are not valid in
expression. The accuracy is controlled by tolerance (if not
specified, the default is 1L5).
fMin(expression,variable,lower,upper[,tolerance])
fMax(expression,variable,lower,upper[,tolerance])
Note: In this guidebook, optional arguments and the commas that
accompany them are enclosed in brackets ([ ]).
MATH Operations (continued)
3
(Cube),
3
( (Cube Root)
x
(Root)
fMin(,
fMax(
Math, Angle, and Test Operations 2.7
82STAT~4.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 12:19 PM Printed: 10/28/05 12:20
PM Page 7 of 26
nDeriv( (numerical derivative) returns an approximate derivative
of expression with respect to variable, given the value at which
to calculate the derivative and H (if not specified, the default is
1L3). nDeriv( is valid only for real numbers.
nDeriv(expression,variable,value[,H])
nDeriv( uses the symmetric difference quotient method, which
approximates the numerical derivative value as the slope of the
secant line through these points.
f
(
x+H)Nf(xNH)
f(x) =
2H
As H becomes smaller, the approximation usually becomes more
accurate.
You can use nDeriv( once in expression. Because of the method
used to calculate nDeriv(, the TI-82 STATS can return a false
derivative value at a nondifferentiable point.
fnInt( (function integral) returns the numerical integral (Gauss-
Kronrod method) of expression with respect to variable, given
lower limit, upper limit, and a tolerance (if not specified, the
default is 1L5). fnInt( is valid only for real numbers.
fnInt(expression,variable,lower,upper[,tolerance])
Tip: To speed the drawing of integration graphs (when fnInt( is used
in a Y= equation), increase the value of the Xres window variable
before you press s.
nDeriv(
fnInt(
2.8 Math, Angle, and Test Operations
82STAT~4.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 12:19 PM Printed: 10/28/05 12:20
PM Page 8 of 26
82STAT~4.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 12:19 PM Printed: 10/28/05 12:20
PM Page 8 of 26
Solver displays the equation solver, in which you can solve for
any variable in an equation. The equation is assumed to be equal
to zero. Solver is valid only for real numbers.
When you select Solver, one of two screens is displayed.
The equation editor (see step 1 picture below) is displayed
when the equation variable eqn is empty.
The interactive solver editor (see step 3 picture on page 2.9)
is displayed when an equation is stored in eqn.
To enter an expression in the equation solver, assuming that the
variable eqn is empty, follow these steps.
1. Select 0:Solver from the MATH menu to display the equation
editor.
2. Enter the expression in any of three ways.
Enter the expression directly into the equation solver.
Paste a Y= variable name from the VARS Y.VARS menu
to the equation solver.
Press y [RCL], paste a Y= variable name from the
VARS Y.VARS menu, and press . The expression is
pasted to the equation solver.
The expression is stored to the variable eqn as you enter it.
Using the Equation Solver
Solver
Entering an
Expression in the
Equation Solver
Math, Angle, and Test Operations 2.9
82STAT~4.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 12:19 PM Printed: 10/28/05 12:20
PM Page 9 of 26
3. Press or . The interactive solver editor is displayed.
The equation stored in eqn is set equal to zero and
displayed on the top line.
Variables in the equation are listed in the order in which
they appear in the equation. Any values stored to the
listed variables also are displayed.
The default lower and upper bounds appear in the last
line of the editor (bound={L1 99,1 99}).
A $ is displayed in the first column of the bottom line if
the editor continues beyond the screen.
Tip: To use the solver to solve an equation such as K=.5MV
2
, enter
eqn:0=KN.5MV
2
in the equation editor.
When you enter or edit a value for a variable in the interactive
solver editor, the new value is stored in memory to that variable.
You can enter an expression for a variable value. It is evaluated
when you move to the next variable. Expressions must resolve
to real numbers at each step during the iteration.
You can store equations to any VARS Y.VARS variables, such as
Y1 or r6, and then reference the variables in the equation. The
interactive solver editor displays all variables of all Y= functions
referenced in the equation.
Entering an
Expression in the
Equation Solver
(continued)
Entering and
Editing Variable
Values
2.10 Math, Angle, and Test Operations
82STAT~4.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 12:19 PM Printed: 10/28/05 12:20
PM Page 10 of 26
82STAT~4.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 12:19 PM Printed: 10/28/05 12:20
PM Page 10 of 26
To solve for a variable using the equation solver after an
equation has been stored to eqn, follow these steps.
1. Select 0:Solver from the MATH menu to display the
interactive solver editor, if not already displayed.
2. Enter or edit the value of each known variable. All variables,
except the unknown variable, must contain a value. To move
the cursor to the next variable, press or .
3. Enter an initial guess for the variable for which you are
solving. This is optional, but it may help find the solution
more quickly. Also, for equations with multiple roots, the
TI-82 STATS will attempt to display the solution that is
closest to your guess.
The default guess is calculated as
(upper+lower)
2
.
Using the Equation Solver (continued)
Solving for a
Variable in the
Equation Solver
Math, Angle, and Test Operations 2.11
82STAT~4.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 12:19 PM Printed: 10/28/05 12:20
PM Page 11 of 26
4. Edit bound={lower,upper}. lower and upper are the bounds
between which the TI-82 STATS searches for a solution. This is
optional, but it may help find the solution more quickly. The
default is bound={L1 99,1 99}.
5. Move the cursor to the variable for which you want to solve
and press [SOLVE] (above the key).
The solution is displayed next to the variable for which
you solved. A solid square in the first column marks the
variable for which you solved and indicates that the
equation is balanced. An ellipsis shows that the value
continues beyond the screen.
Note: When a number continues beyond the screen, be sure
to press ~ to scroll to the end of the number to see whether it
ends with a negative or positive exponent. A very small
number may appear to be a large number until you scroll right
to see the exponent.
The values of the variables are updated in memory.
leftNrt=diff is displayed in the last line of the editor. diff is
the difference between the left and right sides of the
equation. A solid square in the first column next to
leftNrt= indicates that the equation has been evaluated at
the new value of the variable for which you solved.
Solving for a
Variable in the
Equation Solver
(continued)
2.12 Math, Angle, and Test Operations
82STAT~4.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 12:19 PM Printed: 10/28/05 12:20
PM Page 12 of 26
82STAT~4.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 12:19 PM Printed: 10/28/05 12:20
PM Page 12 of 26
To edit or replace an equation stored to eqn when the interactive
equation solver is displayed, press } until the equation editor is
displayed. Then edit the equation.
Some equations have more than one solution. You can enter a
new initial guess (page 2.10) or new bounds (page 2.11) to look
for additional solutions.
After you solve for a variable, you can continue to explore
solutions from the interactive solver editor. Edit the values of
one or more variables. When you edit any variable value, the
solid squares next to the previous solution and leftNrt=diff
disappear. Move the cursor to the variable for which you now
want to solve and press [SOLVE].
The TI-82 STATS solves equations through an iterative process.
To control that process, enter bounds that are relatively close to
the solution and enter an initial guess within those bounds. This
will help to find a solution more quickly. Also, it will define
which solution you want for equations with multiple solutions.
The function solve( is available only from CATALOG or from
within a program. It returns a solution (root) of expression for
variable, given an initial guess, and lower and upper bounds
within which the solution is sought. The default for lower is
L199. The default for upper is 199. solve( is valid only for real
numbers.
solve(expression,variable,guess[,{lower,upper}])
expression is assumed equal to zero. The value of variable will
not be updated in memory. guess may be a value or a list of two
values. Values must be stored for every variable in expression,
except variable, before expression is evaluated. lower and upper
must be entered in list format.
Using the Equation Solver (continued)
Editing an
Equation Stored
to eqn
Equations with
Multiple Roots
Further Solutions
Controlling the
Solution for
Solver or solve(
Using solve( on
the Home Screen
or from a
Program
Math, Angle, and Test Operations 2.13
82STAT~4.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 12:19 PM Printed: 10/28/05 12:20
PM Page 13 of 26
To display the MATH NUM menu, press ~.
MATH NU
M
CPX PRB
1: abs( Absolute value
2: round( Round
3: iPart( Integer part
4: fPart( Fractional part
5: int( Greatest integer
6: min( Minimum value
7: max( Maximum value
8: lcm( Least common multiple
9: gcd( Greatest common divisor
abs( (absolute value) returns the absolute value of real or
complex (modulus) numbers, expressions, lists, and matrices.
abs(value)
Note: abs( is also available on the MATH CPX menu.
round( returns a number, expression, list, or matrix rounded to
#decimals (9). If #decimals is omitted, value is rounded to the
digits that are displayed, up to 10 digits.
round(value[,#decimals])
MATH NUM (Number) Operations
MATH NUM Menu
abs(
round(
2.14 Math, Angle, and Test Operations
82STAT~4.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 12:19 PM Printed: 10/28/05 12:20
PM Page 14 of 26
82STAT~4.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 12:19 PM Printed: 10/28/05 12:20
PM Page 14 of 26
iPart( (integer part) returns the integer part or parts of real or
complex numbers, expressions, lists, and matrices.
iPart(value)
fPart( (fractional part) returns the fractional part or parts of real or
complex numbers, expressions, lists, and matrices.
fPart(value)
int( (greatest integer) returns the largest integer real or
complex numbers, expressions, lists, and matrices.
int(value)
Note: For a given value, the result of int( is the same as the result of
iPart( for nonnegative numbers and negative integers, but one
integer less than the result of iPart( for negative noninteger numbers.
MATH NUM (Number) Operations (continued)
iPart(,
fPart(
int(
Math, Angle, and Test Operations 2.15
82STAT~4.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 12:19 PM Printed: 10/28/05 12:20
PM Page 15 of 26
min( (minimum value) returns the smaller of valueA and valueB
or the smallest element in list. If listA and listB are compared,
min( returns a list of the smaller of each pair of elements. If list
and value are compared, min( compares each element in list
with value.
max( (maximum value) returns the larger of valueA and valueB
or the largest element in list. If listA and listB are compared,
max( returns a list of the larger of each pair of elements. If list
and value are compared, max( compares each element in list
with value.
min(valueA,valueB) max(valueA,valueB)
min(list) max(list)
min(listA,listB) max(listA,listB)
min(list,value) max(list,value)
Note: min( and max( also are available on the LIST MATH menu.
lcm( returns the least common multiple of valueA and valueB,
both of which must be nonnegative integers. When listA and
listB are specified, lcm( returns a list of the lcm of each pair of
elements. If list and value are specified, lcm( finds the lcm of
each element in list and value.
gcd( returns the greatest common divisor of valueA and valueB,
both of which must be nonnegative integers. When listA and
listB are specified, gcd( returns a list of the gcd of each pair of
elements. If list and value are specified, gcd( finds the gcd of
each element in list and value.
lcm(valueA,valueB) gcd(valueA,valueB)
lcm(listA,listB) gcd(listA,listB)
lcm(list,value) gcd(list,value)
min(,
max(
lcm(,
gcd(
2.16 Math, Angle, and Test Operations
82STAT~4.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 12:19 PM Printed: 10/28/05 12:20
PM Page 16 of 26
82STAT~4.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 12:19 PM Printed: 10/28/05 12:20
PM Page 16 of 26
The TI-82 STATS displays complex numbers in rectangular
form and polar form. To select a complex-number mode, press
z, and then select either of the two modes.
a+bi (rectangular-complex mode)
re^qi (polar-complex mode)
On the TI-82 STATS, complex numbers can be stored to
variables. Also, complex numbers are valid list elements.
In Real mode, complex-number results return an error, unless
you entered a complex number as input. For example, in Real
mode ln(L1) returns an error; in a+bi mode ln(L1) returns an
answer.
Real mode a+bi mode
$ $
Complex numbers are stored in rectangular form, but you can
enter a complex number in rectangular form or polar form,
regardless of the mode setting. The components of complex
numbers can be real numbers or expressions that evaluate to real
numbers; expressions are evaluated when the command is
executed.
Radian mode is recommended for complex number calculations.
Internally, the TI-82 STATS converts all entered trig values to
radians, but it does not convert values for exponential,
logarithmic, or hyperbolic functions.
In degree mode, complex identities such as e^(iq) = cos(q) + i
sin(q) are not generally true because the values for cos and sin
are converted to radians, while those for e^( ) are not. For
example, e^(i45) = cos(45) + i sin(45) is treated internally as
e^(i45) = cos(p/4) + i sin(p/4). Complex identities are always
true in radian mode.
Entering and Using Complex Numbers
Complex-Number
Modes
Entering
Complex
Numbers
Note about
Radian versus
Degree Mode
Math, Angle, and Test Operations 2.17
82STAT~4.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 12:19 PM Printed: 10/28/05 12:20
PM Page 17 of 26
Complex numbers in results, including list elements, are
displayed in either rectangular or polar form, as specified by the
mode setting or by a display conversion instruction (page 2.19).
In the example below, re^qi and Radian modes are set.
Rectangular-complex mode recognizes and displays a complex
number in the form a+bi, where a is the real component, b is the
imaginary component, and i is a constant equal to -1.
To enter a complex number in rectangular form, enter the value
of a (real component), press or , enter the value of b
(imaginary component), and press y [i] (constant).
real component(+ or N)imaginary componenti
Polar-complex mode recognizes and displays a complex number in
the form re^qi, where r is the magnitude, e is the base of the natural
log, q is the angle, and i is a constant equal to -1.
To enter a complex number in polar form, enter the value of r
(magnitude), press y [e
x
] (exponential function), enter the
value of q (angle), press y [i] (constant), and then press .
magnitudee^(anglei)
Interpreting
Complex Results
Rectangular-
Complex Mode
Polar-Complex
Mode
2.18 Math, Angle, and Test Operations
82STAT~4.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 12:19 PM Printed: 10/28/05 12:20
PM Page 18 of 26
82STAT~4.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 12:19 PM Printed: 10/28/05 12:20
PM Page 18 of 26
To display the MATH CPX menu, press ~ ~.
MATH NU
M
CPX PRB
1: conj( Returns the complex conjugate.
2: real( Returns the real part.
3: imag( Returns the imaginary part.
4: angle( Returns the polar angle.
5: abs( Returns the magnitude (modulus).
6: 4Rect Displays the result in rectangular form.
7: 4Polar Displays the result in polar form.
conj( (conjugate) returns the complex conjugate of a complex
number or list of complex numbers.
conj(a+bi) returns aNbi in a+bi mode.
conj(re^(qi)) returns re^(Lqi) in re^qi mode.
real( (real part) returns the real part of a complex number or list
of complex numbers.
real(a+bi) returns a.
real(re^(qi)) returns r cos(q).
imag( (imaginary part) returns the imaginary (nonreal) part of a
complex number or list of complex numbers.
imag(a+bi) returns b.
imag(re^(qi)) returns r sin(q).
MATH CPX (Complex) Operations
MATH CPX Menu
conj(
real(
imag(
Math, Angle, and Test Operations 2.19
82STAT~4.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 12:19 PM Printed: 10/28/05 12:20
PM Page 19 of 26
angle( returns the polar angle of a complex number or list of
complex numbers, calculated as tan
L1
(b/a), where b is the
imaginary part and a is the real part. The calculation is adjusted
by +p in the second quadrant or Np in the third quadrant.
angle(a+bi) returns tan
L1
(b/a).
angle(re^(qi)) returns q, where Lp<q<p.
abs( (absolute value) returns the magnitude (modulus),
(real2+imag2)
, of a complex number or list of complex
numbers.
abs(a+bi) returns (a2+b2)
.
abs(re^(qi)) returns r (magnitude).
4Rect (display as rectangular) displays a complex result in
rectangular form. It is valid only at the end of an expression. It
is not valid if the result is real.
complex result8Rect returns a+bi.
4Polar (display as polar) displays a complex result in polar form.
It is valid only at the end of an expression. It is not valid if the
result is real.
complex result8Polar returns re^(qi).
angle(
abs(
4Rect
4Polar
2.20 Math, Angle, and Test Operations
82STAT~4.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 12:19 PM Printed: 10/28/05 12:20
PM Page 20 of 26
82STAT~4.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 12:19 PM Printed: 10/28/05 12:20
PM Page 20 of 26
To display the MATH PRB menu, press |.
MATH NUM CPXPRB
1: rand Random-number generator
2: nPr Number of permutations
3: nCr Number of combinations
4: ! Factorial
5: randInt( Random-integer generator
6: randNorm( Random # from Normal distribution
7: randBin( Random # from Binomial distribution
rand (random number) generates and returns one or more
random numbers > 0 and < 1. To generate a list of random-
numbers, specify an integer > 1 for numtrials (number of trials).
The default for numtrials is 1.
rand[(numtrials)]
Tip: To generate random numbers beyond the range of 0 to 1, you
can include rand in an expression. For example, rand 5 generates a
random number > 0 and < 5.
With each rand execution, the TI-82 STATS generates the same
random-number sequence for a given seed value. The
TI-82 STATS factory-set seed value for rand is 0. To generate a
different random-number sequence, store any nonzero seed
value to rand. To restore the factory-set seed value, store 0 to
rand or reset the defaults (Chapter 18).
Note: The seed value also affects randInt(, randNorm(, and
randBin( instructions (page 2.22).
MATH PRB (Probability) Operations
MATH PRB Menu
rand
Math, Angle, and Test Operations 2.21
82STAT~4.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 12:19 PM Printed: 10/28/05 12:20
PM Page 21 of 26
nPr (number of permutations) returns the number of
permutations of items taken number at a time. items and number
must be nonnegative integers. Both items and number can be
lists.
items nPr number
nCr (number of combinations) returns the number of
combinations of items taken number at a time. items and number
must be nonnegative integers. Both items and number can be
lists.
items nCr number
! (factorial) returns the factorial of either an integer or a multiple
of .5. For a list, it returns factorials for each integer or multiple
of .5. value must be L.5 and 69.
value!
Note: The factorial is computed recursively using the relationship
(n+1)! = nn!, until n is reduced to either 0 or L1/2. At that point, the
definition 0!=1 or the definition (L12)!=p is used to complete the
calculation. Hence:
n!=n(nN1)(nN2) ... 21, if n is an integer 0
n!= n(nN1)(nN2) ... 12p, if n+12 is an integer 0
n! is an error, if neither n nor n+12 is an integer 0.
(The variable n equals value in the syntax description above.)
nPr,
nCr
! (Factorial)
2.22 Math, Angle, and Test Operations
82STAT~4.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 12:19 PM Printed: 10/28/05 12:20
PM Page 22 of 26
82STAT~4.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 12:19 PM Printed: 10/28/05 12:20
PM Page 22 of 26
randInt( (random integer) generates and displays a random
integer within a range specified by lower and upper integer
bounds. To generate a list of random numbers, specify an
integer >1 for numtrials (number of trials); if not specified, the
default is 1.
randInt(lower,upper[,numtrials])
randNorm( (random Normal) generates and displays a random
real number from a specified Normal distribution. Each
generated value could be any real number, but most will be
within the interval [mN3(s), m+3(s)]. To generate a list of
random numbers, specify an integer > 1 for numtrials (number
of trials); if not specified, the default is 1.
randNorm(m,s[,numtrials])
randBin( (random Binomial) generates and displays a random
integer from a specified Binomial distribution. numtrials
(number of trials) must be 1. prob (probability of success)
must be 0 and 1. To generate a list of random numbers,
specify an integer > 1 for numsimulations (number of
simulations); if not specified, the default is 1.
randBin(numtrials,prob[,numsimulations])
Note: The seed value stored to rand also affects randInt(,
randNorm(, and randBin( instructions (page 2-20).
MATH PRB (Probability) Operations (continued)
randInt(
randNorm(
randBin(
Math, Angle, and Test Operations 2.23
82STAT~4.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 12:19 PM Printed: 10/28/05 12:20
PM Page 23 of 26
To display the ANGLE menu, press y [ANGLE]. The ANGLE
menu displays angle indicators and instructions. The
Radian/Degree mode setting affects the TI-82 STATS
interpretation of ANGLE menu entries.
ANGLE
1: Degree notation
2: ' DMS minute notation
3:
r
Radian notation
4: 8DMS Displays as degree/minute/second
5: R8Pr( Returns r, given X and Y
6: R8Pq( Returns q, given X and Y
7: P8Rx( Returns x, given R and q
8: P8Ry( Returns y, given R and q
DMS (degrees/minutes/seconds) entry notation comprises the
degree symbol (), the minute symbol ('), and the second symbol
("). degrees must be a real number; minutes and seconds must
be real numbers 0.
degreesminutes'seconds"
For example, enter for 30 degrees, 1 minute, 23 seconds. If the
angle mode is not set to Degree, you must use so that the
TI-82 STATS can interpret the argument as degrees, minutes,
and seconds.
Degree mode Radian mode
(degree) designates an angle or list of angles as degrees,
regardless of the current angle mode setting. In Radian mode,
you can use to convert degrees to radians.
value
{value1,value2,value3,value4,...,value n}
also designates degrees (D) in DMS format.
' (minutes) designates minutes (M) in DMS format.
" (seconds) designates seconds (S) in DMS format.
Note: " is not on the ANGLE menu. To enter ", press [].
ANGLE Operations
ANGLE Menu
DMS Entry
Notation
(Degree)
2.24 Math, Angle, and Test Operations
82STAT~4.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 12:19 PM Printed: 10/28/05 12:20
PM Page 24 of 26
82STAT~4.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 12:19 PM Printed: 10/28/05 12:20
PM Page 24 of 26
r
(radians) designates an angle or list of angles as radians,
regardless of the current angle mode setting. In Degree mode,
you can use
r
to convert radians to degrees.
value
r
Degree mode
8DMS (degree/minute/second) displays answer in DMS format
(page 2.23). The mode setting must be Degree for answer to be
interpreted as degrees, minutes, and seconds. 8DMS is valid
only at the end of a line.
answer8DMS
R8Pr( converts rectangular coordinates to polar coordinates and
returns r. R8Pq( converts rectangular coordinates to polar
coordinates and returns q. x and y can be lists.
R8Pr(x,y), R8Pq(x,y)
Note: Radian mode is set.
P8Rx( converts polar coordinates to rectangular coordinates and
returns x. P8Ry( converts polar coordinates to rectangular
coordinates and returns y. r and q can be lists.
P8Rx(r,q), P8Ry(r,q)
Note: Radian mode is set.
ANGLE Operations (continued)
r
(Radians)
8DMS
R8Pr (,
R8Pq( ,
P8Rx(,
P8Ry(
Math, Angle, and Test Operations 2.25
82STAT~4.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 12:19 PM Printed: 10/28/05 12:20
PM Page 25 of 26
To display the TEST menu, press y [TEST].
This operator... Returns 1 (true) if...
TEST LOGIC
1: = Equal
2: Not equal to
3: > Greater than
4: Greater than or equal to
5: < Less than
6: Less than or equal to
Relational operators compare valueA and valueB and return 1 if
the test is true or 0 if the test is false. valueA and valueB can be
real numbers, expressions, or lists. For = and only, valueA and
valueB also can be matrices or complex numbers. If valueA and
valueB are matrices, both must have the same dimensions.
Relational operators are often used in programs to control
program flow and in graphing to control the graph of a function
over specific values.
valueA=valueB valueAvalueB
valueA>valueB valueAvalueB
valueA<valueB valueAvalueB
Relational operators are evaluated after mathematical functions
according to EOS rules (Chapter 1).
The expression 2+2=2+3 returns 0. The TI-82 STATS
performs the addition first because of EOS rules, and then it
compares 4 to 5.
The expression 2+(2=2)+3 returns 6. The TI-82 STATS
performs the relational test first because it is in parentheses,
and then it adds 2, 1, and 3.
TEST (Relational) Operations
TEST Menu
=, ,
>, ,
<,
Using Tests
2.26 Math, Angle, and Test Operations
82STAT~4.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 12:19 PM Printed: 10/28/05 12:20
PM Page 26 of 26
82STAT~4.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 12:19 PM Printed: 10/28/05 12:20
PM Page 26 of 26
To display the TEST LOGIC menu, press y TEST ~.
This operator... Returns a 1 (true) if...
TEST LOGIC
1: and Both values are nonzero (true).
2: or At least one value is nonzero (true).
3: xor Only one value is zero (false).
4: not( The value is zero (false).
Boolean operators are often used in programs to control
program flow and in graphing to control the graph of the
function over specific values. Values are interpreted as zero
(false) or nonzero (true).
and, or, and xor (exclusive or) return a value of 1 if an
expression is true or 0 if an expression is false, according to the
table below. valueA and valueB can be real numbers,
expressions, or lists.
valueA and valueB
valueA or valueB
valueA xor valueB
valueA valueB and or xor
0 0 returns 1 1 0
0 0 returns 0 1 1
0 0 returns 0 1 1
0 0 returns 0 0 0
not( returns 1 if value (which can be an expression) is 0.
not(value)
Boolean logic is often used with relational tests. In the following
program, the instructions store 4 into C.
TEST LOGIC (Boolean) Operations
TEST LOGIC
Menu
Boolean
Operators
and,
or,
xor
not(
Using Boolean
Operations
Function Graphing 3.1
82533F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 1:55
PM Page 1 of 28
3
Function
Graphing
Getting Started: Graphing a Circle.............................................................. 2
Defining Graphs ...................................................................................................... 3
Setting the Graph Modes ................................................................................... 4
Defining Functions ................................................................................................ 5
Selecting and Deselecting Functions.......................................................... 7
Setting Graph Styles for Functions.............................................................. 9
Setting the Viewing Window Variables................................................... 11
Setting the Graph Format .................................................................................. 13
Displaying Graphs.................................................................................................. 15
Exploring Graphs with the Free-Moving Cursor................................ 17
Exploring Graphs with TRACE..................................................................... 18
Exploring Graphs with the ZOOM Instructions .................................. 20
Using ZOOM MEMORY.................................................................................... 23
Using the CALC (Calculate) Operations.................................................. 25
Contents
3.2 Function Graphing
82533F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 1:55
PM Page 2 of 28
82533F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 1:55
PM Page 2 of 28
Getting Started is a fast-paced introduction. Read the chapter for details.
Graph a circle of radius 10, centered on the origin in the standard viewing window.
To graph this circle, you must enter separate formulas for the upper and lower
portions of the circle. Then use ZSquare (zoom square) to adjust the display and
make the functions appear as a circle.
1. In Func mode, press oto display the
Y= editor. Press y 100
to enter the expression Y=(100NX
2
),
which defines the top half of the circle.
The expression Y=L(100NX
2
) defines the
bottom half of the circle. On the TI-82 STATS,
you can define one function in terms of another.
To define Y2=LY1, press to enter the negation
sign. Press ~ to display the
VARS Y.VARS menu. Then press to
select 1:Function. The FUNCTION secondary
menu is displayed. Press 1 to select 1:Y1.
2. Press q 6 to select 6:ZStandard. This is a
quick way to reset the window variables to the
standard values. It also graphs the functions;
you do not need to press s.
Notice that the functions appear as an ellipse in
the standard viewing window.
3. To adjust the display so that each pixel
represents an equal width and height, press
q 5 to select 5:ZSquare. The functions are
replotted and now appear as a circle on the
display.
4. To see the ZSquare window variables, press
p and notice the new values for Xmin,
Xmax, Ymin, and Ymax.
Getting Started: Graphing a Circle
Function Graphing 3.3
82533F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 1:55
PM Page 3 of 28
Chapter 3 specifically describes function graphing, but the steps
shown here are similar for each TI-82 STATS graphing mode.
Chapters 4, 5, and 6 describe aspects that are unique to
parametric graphing, polar graphing, and sequence graphing.
To define a graph in any graphing mode, follow these steps.
Some steps are not always necessary.
1. Press z and set the appropriate graph mode (page 3.4).
2. Press o and enter, edit, or select one or more functions in
the Y= editor (page 3.5 and 3.7).
3. Deselect stat plots, if necessary (page 3.7).
4. Set the graph style for each function (page 3.9).
5. Press p and define the viewing window variables
(page 3.11).
6. Press y [FORMAT] and select the graph format settings
(page 3.13).
After you have defined a graph, press s to display it.
Explore the behavior of the function or functions using the
TI-82 STATS tools described in this chapter.
You can store the elements that define the current graph to any
of 10 graph database variables (GDB1 through GDB9, and
GDB0; Chapter 8). To recreate the current graph later, simply
recall the graph database to which you stored the original graph.
These types of information are stored in a GDB.
Y= functions
Graph style settings
Window settings
Format settings
You can store a picture of the current graph display to any of 10
graph picture variables (Pic1 through Pic9, and Pic0; Chapter
8). Then you can superimpose one or more stored pictures onto
the current graph.
Defining Graphs
TI-82 STATS
Graphing Mode
Similarities
Defining a Graph
Displaying and
Exploring a
Graph
Saving a Graph
for Later Use
3.4 Function Graphing
82533F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 1:55
PM Page 4 of 28
82533F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 1:55
PM Page 4 of 28
To display the mode screen, press z. The default settings are
highlighted below. To graph functions, you must select Func
mode before you enter values for the window variables and
before you enter the functions.
The TI-82 STATS has four graphing modes.
Func (function graphing)
Par (parametric graphing; Chapter 4)
Pol (polar graphing; Chapter 5)
Seq (sequence graphing; Chapter 6)
Other mode settings affect graphing results. Chapter 1 describes
each mode setting.
Float or 0123456789 (fixed) decimal mode affects displayed
graph coordinates.
Radian or Degree angle mode affects interpretation of some
functions.
Connected or Dot plotting mode affects plotting of selected
functions.
Sequential or Simul graphing-order mode affects function
plotting when more than one function is selected.
To set the graphing mode and other modes from a program,
begin on a blank line in the program editor and follow these
steps.
1. Press z to display the mode settings.
2. Press , ~, |, and } to place the cursor on the mode that
you want to select.
3. Press to paste the mode name to the cursor location.
The mode is changed when the program is executed.
Setting the Graph Modes
Checking and
Changing the
Graphing Mode
Setting Modes
from a Program
Function Graphing 3.5
82533F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 1:55
PM Page 5 of 28
To display the Y= editor, press o. You can store up to 10
functions to the function variables Y1 through Y9, and Y0. You
can graph one or more defined functions at once. In this
example, functions Y1 and Y2 are defined and selected.
To define or edit a function, follow these steps.
1. Press o to display the Y= editor.
2. Press to move the cursor to the function you want to
define or edit. To erase a function, press .
3. Enter or edit the expression to define the function.
You may use functions and variables (including matrices
and lists) in the expression. When the expression
evaluates to a nonreal number, the value is not plotted; no
error is returned.
The independent variable in the function is X. Func mode
defines as X. To enter X, press or press
[X].
When you enter the first character, the = is highlighted,
indicating that the function is selected.
As you enter the expression, it is stored to the variable Yn as
a user-defined function in the Y= editor.
4. Press or to move the cursor to the next function.
Defining Functions
Displaying
Functions in the
Y= Editor
Defining or
Editing a
Function
3.6 Function Graphing
82533F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 1:55
PM Page 6 of 28
82533F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 1:55
PM Page 6 of 28
To define a function from the home screen or a program, begin
on a blank line and follow these steps.
1. Press [], enter the expression, and then press
[] again.
2. Press .
3. Press ~ 1 to select 1:Function from the
VARS Y.VARS menu.
4. Select the function name, which pastes the name to the
cursor location on the home screen or program editor.
5. Press to complete the instruction.
"expression"! !! !Yn
When the instruction is executed, the TI-82 STATS stores the
expression to the designated variable Yn, selects the function,
and displays the message Done.
You can calculate the value of a Y= function Yn at a specified
value of X. A list of values returns a list.
Yn(value)
Yn({value1,value2,value3, . . .,value n})
Defining Functions (continued)
Defining a
Function from
the Home Screen
or a Program
Evaluating Y=
Functions in
Expressions
Function Graphing 3.7
82533F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 1:55
PM Page 7 of 28
You can select and deselect (turn on and turn off) a function in
the Y= editor. A function is selected when the = sign is
highlighted. The TI-82 STATS graphs only the selected
functions. You can select any or all functions Y1 through Y9, and
Y0.
To select or deselect a function in the Y= editor, follow these
steps.
1. Press o to display the Y= editor.
2. Move the cursor to the function you want to select or
deselect.
3. Press | to place the cursor on the functions = sign.
4. Press to change the selection status.
When you enter or edit a function, it is selected automatically.
When you clear a function, it is deselected.
To view and change the on/off status of a stat plot in the
Y= editor, use Plot1 Plot2 Plot3 (the top line of the Y= editor).
When a plot is on, its name is highlighted on this line.
To change the on/off status of a stat plot from the Y= editor,
press } and ~ to place the cursor on Plot1, Plot2, or Plot3, and
then press .
Selecting and Deselecting Functions
Selecting and
Deselecting a
Function
Turning On or
Turning Off a Stat
Plot in the Y=
Editor
Plot1 is turned on.
Plot2 and Plot3 are turned off.
3.8 Function Graphing
82533F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 1:55
PM Page 8 of 28
82533F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 1:55
PM Page 8 of 28
To select or deselect a function from the home screen or a
program, begin on a blank line and follow these steps.
1. Press ~ to display the VARS Y.VARS menu.
2. Select 4:On/Off to display the ON/OFF secondary menu.
3. Select 1:FnOn to turn on one or more functions or 2:FnOff to
turn off one or more functions. The instruction you select is
copied to the cursor location.
4. Enter the number (1 through 9, or 0; not the variable Yn) of
each function you want to turn on or turn off.
If you enter two or more numbers, separate them with
commas.
To turn on or turn off all functions, do not enter a number
after FnOn or FnOff.
FnOn[function#,function#, . . .,function n]
FnOff[function#,function#, . . .,function n]
5. Press . When the instruction is executed, the status of
each function in the current mode is set and Done is
displayed.
For example, in Func mode, FnOff :FnOn 1,3 turns off all
functions in the Y= editor, and then turns on Y1 and Y3.
Selecting and Deselecting Functions (continued)
Selecting and
Deselecting
Functions from
the Home Screen
or a Program
Function Graphing 3.9
82533F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 1:55
PM Page 9 of 28
This table describes the graph styles available for function
graphing. Use the styles to visually differentiate functions to be
graphed together. For example, you can set Y1 as a solid line, Y2
as a dotted line, and Y3 as a thick line.
Icon Style Description
Line A solid line connects plotted points; this is the
default in Connected mode
Thick A thick solid line connects plotted points
Above Shading covers the area a*bove the graph
Below Shading covers the area below the graph
Path A circular cursor traces the leading edge of the
graph and draws a path
Animate A circular cursor traces the leading edge of the
graph without drawing a path
Dot A small dot represents each plotted point; this
is the default in Dot mode
Note: Some graph styles are not available in all graphing modes.
Chapters 4, 5, and 6 list the styles for Par, Pol, and Seq modes.
To set the graph style for a function, follow these steps.
1. Press o to display the Y= editor.
2. Press and } to move the cursor to the function.
3. Press | | to move the cursor left, past the = sign, to the
graph style icon in the first column. The insert cursor is
displayed. (Steps 2 and 3 are interchangeable.)
4. Press repeatedly to rotate through the graph styles.
The seven styles rotate in the same order in which they are
listed in the table above.
5. Press ~, }, or when you have selected a style.
Setting Graph Styles for Functions
Graph Style
Icons in the Y=
Editor
Setting the Graph
Style
3.10 Function Graphing
82533F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 1:55
PM Page 10 of 28
82533F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 1:55
PM Page 10 of 28
When you select or for two or more functions, the
TI-82 STATS rotates through four shading patterns.
Vertical lines shade the first function with a or graph
style.
Horizontal lines shade the second.
Negatively sloping diagonal lines shade the third.
Positively sloping diagonal lines shade the fourth.
The rotation returns to vertical lines for the fifth or
function, repeating the order described above.
When shaded areas intersect, the patterns overlap.
Note: When or is selected for a Y= function that graphs a family
of curves, such as Y1={1,2,3}X, the four shading patterns rotate for
each member of the family of curves.
To set the graph style from a program, select H:GraphStyle(
from the PRGM CTL menu. To display this menu, press
while in the program editor. function# is the number of the Y=
function name in the current graphing mode. graphstyle# is an
integer from 1 to 7 that corresponds to the graph style, as shown
below.
1 = (line) 2 = (thick) 3 = (above)
4 = (below) 5 = (path) 6 = (animate) 7 = (dot)
GraphStyle(function#,graphstyle#)
For example, when this program is executed in Func mode,
GraphStyle(1,3) sets Y1 to (above).
Setting Graph Styles for Functions (continued)
Shading Above
and Below
Setting a Graph
Style from a
Program
Function Graphing 3.11
82533F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 1:55
PM Page 11 of 28
The viewing window is the portion of the coordinate plane
defined by Xmin, Xmax, Ymin, and Ymax. Xscl (X scale)
defines the distance between tick marks on the x-axis. Yscl (Y
scale) defines the distance between tick marks on the y-axis. To
turn off tick marks, set Xscl=0 and Yscl=0.
Xmax
Ymin
Ymax
Xscl
Yscl
Xmin
To display the current window variable values, press p.
The window editor above and to the right shows the default
values in Func graphing mode and Radian angle mode. The
window variables differ from one graphing mode to another.
Xres sets pixel resolution (1 through 8) for function graphs only.
The default is 1.
At Xres=1, functions are evaluated and graphed at each pixel
on the x-axis.
At Xres=8, functions are evaluated and graphed at every
eighth pixel along the x-axis.
Tip: Small Xres values improve graph resolution but may cause the
TI-82 STATS to draw graphs more slowly.
To change a window variable value from the window editor,
follow these steps.
1. Press or } to move the cursor to the window variable you
want to change.
2. Edit the value, which can be an expression.
Enter a new value, which clears the original value.
Move the cursor to a specific digit, and then edit it.
3. Press , , or }. If you entered an expression, the
TI-82 STATS evaluates it. The new value is stored.
Note: Xmin<Xmax and Ymin<Ymax must be true in order to graph.
Setting the Viewing Window Variables
The TI-82 STATS
Viewing Window
Displaying the
Window
Variables
Changing a
Window Variable
Value
3.12 Function Graphing
82533F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 1:55
PM Page 12 of 28
82533F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 1:55
PM Page 12 of 28
To store a value, which can be an expression, to a window
variable, begin on a blank line and follow these steps.
1. Enter the value you want to store.
2. Press .
3. Press to display the VARS menu.
4. Select 1:Window to display the Func window variables (X/Y
secondary menu).
Press ~ to display the Par and Pol window variables (T/q
secondary menu).
Press ~ ~ to display the Seq window variables (U/V/W
secondary menu).
5. Select the window variable to which you want to store a
value. The name of the variable is pasted to the current
cursor location.
6. Press to complete the instruction.
When the instruction is executed, the TI-82 STATS stores the
value to the window variable and displays the value.
The variables @X and @Y (items 8 and 9 on the VARS
(1:Window) X/Y secondary menu) define the distance from the
center of one pixel to the center of any adjacent pixel on a graph
(graphing accuracy). @X and @Y are calculated from Xmin,
Xmax, Ymin, and Ymax when you display a graph.
@X =
(Xmax N Xmin)
94
@Y =
(Ymax N Ymin)
62
You can store values to @X and @Y. If you do, Xmax and Ymax
are calculated from @X, Xmin, @Y, and Ymin.
Setting the Viewing Window Variables (continued)
Storing to a
Window Variable
from the Home
Screen or a
Program
@X and @Y
Function Graphing 3.13
82533F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 1:55
PM Page 13 of 28
To display the format settings, press y [FORMAT]. The default
settings are highlighted below.
RectGC PolarGC Sets cursor coordinates.
CoordOn CoordOff Sets coordinates display on or off.
GridOff GridOn Sets grid off or on.
AxesOn AxesOff Sets axes on or off.
LabelOff LabelOn Sets axes label off or on.
ExprOn ExprOff Sets expression display on or off.
Format settings define a graphs appearance on the display.
Format settings apply to all graphing modes. Seq graphing
mode has an additional mode setting (Chapter 6).
To change a format setting, follow these steps.
1. Press , ~, }, and | as necessary to move the cursor to
the setting you want to select.
2. Press to select the highlighted setting.
RectGC (rectangular graphing coordinates) displays the cursor
location as rectangular coordinates X and Y.
PolarGC (polar graphing coordinates) displays the cursor
location as polar coordinates R and q.
The RectGC/PolarGC setting determines which variables are
updated when you plot the graph, move the free-moving cursor,
or trace.
RectGC updates X and Y; if CoordOn format is selected, X
and Y are displayed.
PolarGC updates X, Y, R, and q; if CoordOn format is
selected, R and q are displayed.
Setting the Graph Format
Displaying the
Format Settings
Changing a
Format Setting
RectGC, PolarGC
3.14 Function Graphing
82533F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 1:55
PM Page 14 of 28
82533F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 1:55
PM Page 14 of 28
CoordOn (coordinates on) displays the cursor coordinates at the
bottom of the graph. If ExprOff format is selected, the function
number is displayed in the top-right corner.
CoordOff (coordinates off) does not display the function number
or coordinates.
Grid points cover the viewing window in rows that correspond
to the tick marks (page 3.11) on each axis.
GridOff does not display grid points.
GridOn displays grid points.
AxesOn displays the axes.
AxesOff does not display the axes.
This overrides the LabelOff/ LabelOn format setting.
LabelOff and LabelOn determine whether to display labels for
the axes (X and Y), if AxesOn format is also selected.
ExprOn and ExprOff determine whether to display the
Y= expression when the trace cursor is active. This format
setting also applies to stat plots.
When ExprOn is selected, the expression is displayed in the top-
left corner of the graph screen.
When ExprOff and CoordOn both are selected, the number in
the top-right corner specifies which function is being traced.
Setting the Graph Format (continued)
CoordOn,
CoordOff
GridOff, GridOn
AxesOn, AxesOff
LabelOff,
LabelOn
ExprOn, ExprOff
Function Graphing 3.15
82533F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 1:55
PM Page 15 of 28
To display the graph of the selected function or functions, press
s. TRACE, ZOOM instructions, and CALC operations
display the graph automatically. As the TI-82 STATS plots the
graph, the busy indicator is on. As the graph is plotted, X and Y
are updated.
While plotting a graph, you can pause or stop graphing.
Press to pause; then press to resume.
Press to stop; then press s to redraw.
Smart Graph is a TI-82 STATS feature that redisplays the last
graph immediately when you press s, but only if all
graphing factors that would cause replotting have remained the
same since the graph was last displayed.
If you performed any of these actions since the graph was last
displayed, the TI-82 STATS will replot the graph based on new
values when you press s.
Changed a mode setting that affects graphs
Changed a function in the current picture
Selected or deselected a function or stat plot
Changed the value of a variable in a selected function
Changed a window variable or graph format setting
Cleared drawings by selecting ClrDraw
Changed a stat plot definition
Displaying Graphs
Displaying a New
Graph
Pausing or
Stopping a Graph
Smart Graph
3.16 Function Graphing
82533F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 1:55
PM Page 16 of 28
82533F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 1:55
PM Page 16 of 28
On the TI-82 STATS, you can graph one or more new functions
without replotting existing functions. For example, store sin(X)
to Y1 in the Y= editor and press s. Then store cos(X) to Y2
and press s again. The function Y2 is graphed on top of Y1,
the original function.
If you enter a list (Chapter 11) as an element in an expression,
the TI-82 STATS plots the function for each value in the list,
thereby graphing a family of curves. In Simul graphing-order
mode, it graphs all functions sequentially for the first element in
each list, and then for the second, and so on.
{2,4,6}sin(X) graphs three functions: 2 sin(X), 4 sin(X), and
6 sin(X).
{2,4,6}sin({1,2,3}X) graphs 2 sin(X), 4 sin(2X), and 6 sin(3X).
Note: When using more than one list, the lists must have the same
dimensions.
Displaying Graphs (continued)
Overlaying
Functions on a
Graph
Graphing a
Family of Curves
Function Graphing 3.17
82533F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 1:55
PM Page 17 of 28
When a graph is displayed, press |, ~, }, or to move the
cursor around the graph. When you first display the graph, no
cursor is visible. When you press |, ~, }, or , the cursor
moves from the center of the viewing window.
As you move the cursor around the graph, the coordinate values
of the cursor location are displayed at the bottom of the screen if
CoordOn format is selected. The Float/Fix decimal mode setting
determines the number of decimal digits displayed for the
coordinate values.
To display the graph with no cursor and no coordinate values,
press or . When you press |, ~, }, or , the
cursor moves from the same position.
The free-moving cursor moves from pixel to pixel on the screen.
When you move the cursor to a pixel that appears to be on the
function, the cursor may be near, but not actually on, the
function. The coordinate value displayed at the bottom of the
screen actually may not be a point on the function. To move the
cursor along a function, use r (page 3.18).
The coordinate values displayed as you move the cursor
approximate actual math coordinates, *accurate to within the
width and height of the pixel. As Xmin, Xmax, Ymin, and Ymax
get closer together (as in a ZoomIn) graphing accuracy
increases, and the coordinate values more closely approximate
the math coordinates.
Exploring Graphs with the Free-Moving Cursor
Free-Moving
Cursor
Graphing
Accuracy
Free-moving cursor on the curve
3.18 Function Graphing
82533F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 1:55
PM Page 18 of 28
82533F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 1:55
PM Page 18 of 28
Use TRACE to move the cursor from one plotted point to the
next along a function. To begin a trace, press r. If the
graph is not displayed already, press r to display it. The
trace cursor is on the first selected function in the Y= editor, at
the middle X value on the screen. The cursor coordinates are
displayed at the bottom of the screen if CoordOn format is
selected. The Y= expression is displayed in the top-left corner of
the screen, if ExprOn format is selected.
To move the TRACE cursor . . . do this:
. . . to the previous or next plotted point, press | or ~.
. . . five plotted points on a function (Xres
affects this),
press y|or y
~.
. . . to any valid X value on a function, enter a value, and
then press .
. . . from one function to another, press } or .
When the trace cursor moves along a function, the Y value is
calculated from the X value; that is, Y=Yn(X). If the function is
undefined at an X value, the Y value is blank.
If you move the trace cursor beyond the top or bottom of the
screen, the coordinate values at the bottom of the screen
continue to change appropriately.
To move the trace cursor from function to function, press and
}. The cursor follows the order of the selected functions in the
Y= editor. The trace cursor moves to each function at the same X
value. If ExprOn format is selected, the expression is updated.
Exploring Graphs with TRACE
Beginning a
Trace
Moving the Trace
Cursor
Moving the Trace
Cursor from
Function to
Function
Trace cursor on the curve
Function Graphing 3.19
82533F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 1:55
PM Page 19 of 28
To move the trace cursor to any valid X value on the current
function, enter the value. When you enter the first digit, an X=
prompt and the number you entered are displayed in the bottom-
left corner of the screen. You can enter an expression at the X=
prompt. The value must be valid for the current viewing
window. When you have completed the entry, press to
move the cursor.
Note: This feature does not apply to stat plots.
If you trace a function beyond the left or right side of the screen,
the viewing window automatically pans to the left or right.
Xmin and Xmax are updated to correspond to the new viewing
window.
While tracing, you can press to adjust the viewing
window so that the cursor location becomes the center of the
new viewing window, even if the cursor is above or below the
display. This allows panning up and down. After Quick Zoom,
the cursor remains in TRACE.
When you leave and return to TRACE, the trace cursor is
displayed in the same location it was in when you left TRACE,
unless Smart Graph has replotted the graph (page 3.15).
On a blank line in the program editor, press r. The
instruction Trace is pasted to the cursor location. When the
instruction is encountered during program execution, the graph
is displayed with the trace cursor on the first selected function.
As you trace, the cursor coordinate values are updated. When
you finish tracing the functions, press to resume program
execution.
Moving the Trace
Cursor to Any
Valid X Value
Panning to the
Left or Right
Quick Zoom
Leaving and
Returning to
TRACE
Using TRACE in
a Program
3.20 Function Graphing
82533F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 1:55
PM Page 20 of 28
82533F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 1:55
PM Page 20 of 28
To display the ZOOM menu, press q. You can adjust the
viewing window of the graph quickly in several ways. All
ZOOM instructions are accessible from programs.
ZOO
M
MEMORY
1: ZBox Draws a box to define the viewing window.
2: Zoom In Magnifies the graph around the cursor.
3: Zoom Out Views more of a graph around the cursor.
4: ZDecimal Sets @X and @Y to 0.1.
5: ZSquare Sets equal-size pixels on the X and Y axes.
6: ZStandard Sets the standard window variables.
7: ZTrig Sets the built-in trig window variables.
8: ZInteger Sets integer values on the X and Y axes.
9: ZoomStat Sets the values for current stat lists.
0: ZoomFit Fits YMin and YMax between XMin and XMax.
When you select 1:ZBox, 2:Zoom In, or 3:Zoom Out, the cursor
on the graph becomes the zoom cursor (+), a smaller version of
the free-moving cursor (+).
To define a new viewing window using ZBox, follow these
steps.
1. Select 1:ZBox from the ZOOM menu. The zoom cursor is
displayed at the center of the screen.
2. Move the zoom cursor to any spot you want to define as a
corner of the box, and then press . When you move the
cursor away from the first defined corner, a small, square dot
indicates the spot.
3. Press |, }, ~, or . As you move the cursor, the sides of
the box lengthen or shorten proportionately on the screen.
Note: To cancel ZBox before you press , press .
4. When you have defined the box, press to replot the
graph.
To use ZBox to define another box within the new graph, repeat
steps 2 through 4. To cancel ZBox, press .
Exploring Graphs with the ZOOM Instructions
ZOOM Menu
Zoom Cursor
ZBox
Function Graphing 3.21
82533F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 1:55
PM Page 21 of 28
Zoom In magnifies the part of the graph that surrounds the
cursor location. Zoom Out displays a greater portion of the
graph, centered on the cursor location. The XFact and YFact
settings determine the extent of the zoom.
To zoom in on a graph, follow these steps.
1. Check XFact and YFact (page 3.24); change as needed.
2. Select 2:Zoom In from the ZOOM menu. The zoom cursor is
displayed.
3. Move the zoom cursor to the point that is to be the center of
the new viewing window.
4. Press . The TI-82 STATS adjusts the viewing window
by XFact and YFact; updates the window variables; and
replots the selected functions, centered on the cursor
location.
5. Zoom in on the graph again in either of two ways.
To zoom in at the same point, press .
To zoom in at a new point, move the cursor to the point
that you want as the center of the new viewing window,
and then press .
To zoom out on a graph, select 3:Zoom Out and repeat steps 3
through 5.
To cancel Zoom In or Zoom Out, press .
ZDecimal replots the functions immediately. It updates the
window variables to preset values, as shown below. These
values set @X and @Y equal to 0.1 and set the X and Y value of
each pixel to one decimal place.
Xmin=L4.7 Ymin=L3.1
Xmax=4.7 Ymax=3.1
Xscl=1 Yscl=1
ZSquare replots the functions immediately. It redefines the
viewing window based on the current values of the window
variables. It adjusts in only one direction so that @X=@Y, which
makes the graph of a circle look like a circle. Xscl and Yscl
remain unchanged. The midpoint of the current graph (not the
intersection of the axes) becomes the midpoint of the new graph.
Zoom In,
Zoom Out
ZDecimal
ZSquare
3.22 Function Graphing
82533F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 1:55
PM Page 22 of 28
82533F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 1:55
PM Page 22 of 28
ZStandard replots the functions immediately. It updates the
window variables to the standard values shown below.
Xmin=L10 Ymin=L10 Xres=1
Xmax=10 Ymax=10
Xscl=1 Yscl=1
ZTrig replots the functions immediately. It updates the window
variables to preset values that are appropriate for plotting trig
functions. Those preset values in Radian mode are shown
below.
Xmin=L(4724)p Ymin=L4
Xmax=(4724)p Ymax=4
Xscl=p/2 Yscl=1
ZInteger redefines the viewing window to the dimensions
shown below. To use ZInteger, move the cursor to the point that
you want to be the center of the new window, and then press
; ZInteger replots the functions.
@X=1 Xscl=10
@Y=1 Yscl=10
ZoomStat redefines the viewing window so that all statistical
data points are displayed. For regular and modified box plots,
only Xmin and Xmax are adjusted.
ZoomFit replots the functions immediately. ZoomFit
recalculates YMin and YMax to include the minimum and
maximum Y values of the selected functions between the current
XMin and XMax. XMin and XMax are not changed.
Exploring Graphs with the ZOOM Instructions (cont.)
ZStandard
ZTrig
ZInteger
ZoomStat
ZoomFit
Function Graphing 3.23
82533F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 1:55
PM Page 23 of 28
To display the ZOOM MEMORY menu, press q ~.
ZOOMMEMOR
Y
1: ZPrevious Uses the previous viewing window.
2: ZoomSto Stores the user-defined window.
3: ZoomRcl Recalls the user-defined window.
4: SetFactors... Changes Zoom In and Zoom Out factors.
ZPrevious replots the graph using the window variables of the
graph that was displayed before you executed the last ZOOM
instruction.
ZoomSto immediately stores the current viewing window. The
graph is displayed, and the values of the current window
variables are stored in the user-defined ZOOM variables ZXmin,
ZXmax, ZXscl, ZYmin, ZYmax, ZYscl, and ZXres.
These variables apply to all graphing modes. For example,
changing the value of ZXmin in Func mode also changes it in
Par mode.
ZoomRcl graphs the selected functions in a user-defined
viewing window. The user-defined viewing window is
determined by the values stored with the ZoomSto instruction.
The window variables are updated with the user-defined values,
and the graph is plotted.
Using ZOOM MEMORY
ZOOM MEMORY
Menu
ZPrevious
ZoomSto
ZoomRcl
3.24 Function Graphing
82533F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 1:55
PM Page 24 of 28
82533F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 1:55
PM Page 24 of 28
The zoom factors, XFact and YFact, are positive numbers (not
necessarily integers) greater than or equal to 1. They define the
magnification or reduction factor used to Zoom In or Zoom Out
around a point.
To display the ZOOM FACTORS screen, where you can review
the current values for XFact and YFact, select 4:SetFactors
from the ZOOM MEMORY menu. The values shown are the
defaults.
You can change XFact and YFact in either of two ways.
Enter a new value. The original value is cleared
automatically when you enter the first digit.
Place the cursor on the digit you want to change, and then
enter a value or press { to delete it.
From the home screen or a program, you can store directly to
any of the user-defined ZOOM variables.
From a program, you can select the ZoomSto and ZoomRcl
instructions from the ZOOM MEMORY menu.
Using ZOOM MEMORY (continued)
ZOOM FACTORS
Checking XFact
and YFact
Changing XFact
and YFact
Using ZOOM
MEMORY Menu
Items from the
Home Screen or
a Program
Function Graphing 3.25
82533F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 1:55
PM Page 25 of 28
To display the CALCULATE menu, press y CALC. Use the
items on this menu to analyze the current graph functions.
CALCULAT
E
1: value Calculates a function Y value for a given X.
2: zero Finds a zero (x-intercept) of a function.
3: minimum Finds a minimum of a function.
4: maximum Finds a maximum of a function.
5: intersect Finds an intersection of two functions.
6: dy/dx Finds a numeric derivative of a function.
7: f(x)dx Finds a numeric integral of a function.
value evaluates one or more currently selected functions for a
specified value of X.
Note: When a value is displayed for X, press to clear the
value. When no value is displayed, press to cancel the value
operation.
To evaluate a selected function at X, follow these steps.
1. Select 1:value from the CALCULATE menu. The graph is
displayed with X= in the bottom-left corner.
2. Enter a real value, which can be an expression, for X
between Xmin and Xmax.
3. Press .
The cursor is on the first selected function in the Y= editor at the
X value you entered, and the coordinates are displayed, even if
CoordOff format is selected.
To move the cursor from function to function at the entered X
value, press } or . To restore the free-moving cursor, press
| or ~.
Using the CALC (Calculate) Operations
CALCULATE
Menu
value
3.26 Function Graphing
82533F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 1:55
PM Page 26 of 28
82533F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 1:55
PM Page 26 of 28
zero finds a zero (x-intercept or root) of a function using solve(.
Functions can have more than one x-intercept value; zero finds
the zero closest to your guess.
The time zero spends to find the correct zero value depends on
the accuracy of the values you specify for the left and right
bounds and the accuracy of your guess.
To find a zero of a function, follow these steps.
1. Select 2:zero from the CALCULATE menu. The current graph
is displayed with Left Bound? in the bottom-left corner.
2. Press } or to move the cursor onto the function for which
you want to find a zero.
3. Press | or ~ (or enter a value) to select the x-value for the
left bound of the interval, and then press . A 4
indicator on the graph screen shows the left bound. Right
Bound? is displayed in the bottom-left corner. Press | or ~
(or enter a value) to select the x-value for the right bound,
and then press . A 3 indicator on the graph screen
shows the right bound. Guess? is then displayed in the
bottom-left corner.
4. Press | or ~ (or enter a value) to select a point near the
zero of the function, between the bounds, and then press
.
The cursor is on the solution and the coordinates are displayed,
even if CoordOff format is selected. To move to the same
x-value for other selected functions, press } or . To restore
the free-moving cursor, press | or ~.
Using the CALC (Calculate) Operations (continued)
zero
Function Graphing 3.27
82533F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 1:55
PM Page 27 of 28
minimum and maximum find a minimum or maximum of a
function within a specified interval to a tolerance of 1L5.
To find a minimum or maximum, follow these steps.
1. Select 3:minimum or 4:maximum from the CALCULATE
menu. The current graph is displayed.
2. Select the function and set left bound, right bound, and guess
as described for zero (steps 2 through 4; page 3.26).
The cursor is on the solution, and the coordinates are displayed,
even if you have selected CoordOff format; Minimum or
Maximum is displayed in the bottom-left corner.
To move to the same x-value for other selected functions, press
} or . To restore the free-moving cursor, press | or ~.
intersect finds the coordinates of a point at which two or more
functions intersect using solve(. The intersection must appear on
the display to use intersect.
To find an intersection, follow these steps.
1. Select 5:intersect from the CALCULATE menu. The current
graph is displayed with First curve? in the bottom-left corner.
2. Press or }, if necessary, to move the cursor to the first
function, and then press . Second curve? is displayed
in the bottom-left corner.
3. Press or }, if necessary, to move the cursor to the second
function, and then press .
4. Press ~ or | to move the cursor to the point that is your
guess as to location of the intersection, and then press .
The cursor is on the solution and the coordinates are displayed,
even if CoordOff format is selected. Intersection is displayed in
the bottom-left corner. To restore the free-moving cursor, press
|, }, ~, or .
minimum,
maximum
intersect
3.28 Function Graphing
82533F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 1:55
PM Page 28 of 28
82533F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 1:55
PM Page 28 of 28
dy/dx (numerical derivative) finds the numerical derivative
(slope) of a function at a point, with H=1L3.
To find a functions slope at a point, follow these steps.
1. Select 6:dy/dx from the CALCULATE menu. The current
graph is displayed.
2. Press } or to select the function for which you want to
find the numerical derivative.
3. Press | or ~ (or enter a value) to select the X value at
which to calculate the derivative, and then press .
The cursor is on the solution and the numerical derivative is
displayed.
To move to the same x-value for other selected functions, press
} or . To restore the free-moving cursor, press | or ~.
f(x)dx (numerical integral) finds the numerical integral of a
function in a specified interval. It uses the fnInt( function, with a
tolerance of H=1L3.
To find the numerical derivative of a function, follow these
steps.
1. Select 7:f(x)dx from the CALCULATE menu. The current
graph is displayed with Lower Limit? in the bottom-left
corner.
2. Press } or to move the cursor to the function for which
you want to calculate the integral.
3. Set lower and upper limits as you would set left and right
bounds for zero (step 3; page 3.26). The integral value is
displayed, and the integrated area is shaded.
Note: The shaded area is a drawing. Use ClrDraw (Chapter 8) or
any action that invokes Smart Graph to clear the shaded area.
Using the CALC (Calculate) Operations (continued)
dy/dx
f(x)dx
Parametric Graphing 4-1
82EB1A~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 1:58
PM Page 1 of 8
4
Parametric
Graphing
Getting Started: Path of a Ball........................................................................ 4-2
Defining and Displaying Parametric Graphs ........................................ 4-4
Exploring Parametric Graphs.......................................................................... 4-7
Contents
4-2 Parametric Graphing
82EB1A~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 1:58
PM Page 2 of 8
Getting Started is a fast-paced introduction. Read the chapter for details.
Graph the parametric equation that describes the path of a ball hit at an initial speed
of 30 meters per second, at an initial angle of 25 degrees with the horizontal from
ground level. How far does the ball travel? When does it hit the ground? How high
does it go? Ignore all forces except gravity.
For initial velocity v
0
and angle q, the position of the ball as a function of time has
horizontal and vertical components.
Horizontal: X1(t)=tv
0
cos(q)
Vertical: Y1(t)=tv
0
sin(q)N
1
2
gt
2
The vertical and horizontal vectors of the balls motion also will be graphed.
Vertical vector: X2(t)=0 Y2(t)=Y1(t)
Horizontal vector: X3(t)=X1(t) Y3(t)=0
Gravity constant: g=9.8 m/sec
2
1. Press z. Press ~to select
Par mode. Press ~to select
Simul for simultaneous graphing of all three
parametric equations in this example.
2. Press o. Press 30 25 y
[ANGLE] 1 (to select ) to define X1T
in terms of T.
3. Press 30 25 y[ANGLE] 1
9.8 2 to define Y1T.
The vertical component vector is defined by
X2T and Y2T.
4. Press 0 to define X2T.
5. Press ~ to display the VARS Y.VARS
menu. Press 2 to display the PARAMETRIC
secondary menu. Press 2 to define Y2T.
Getting Started: Path of a Ball
Parametric Graphing 4-3
82EB1A~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 1:58
PM Page 3 of 8
The horizontal component vector is defined by
X3T and Y3T.
6. Press ~ 2, and then press 1 to
define X3T. Press 0 to define Y3T.
7. Press | | } to change the graph
style to for X3T and Y3T. Press }
to change the graph style to for X2T
and Y2T. Press } to change the
graph style to for X1T and Y1T. (These
keystrokes assume that all graph styles were
set to originally.)
8. Press p. Enter these values for the
window variables.
Tmin=0 Xmin=L10 Ymin=L5
Tmax=5 Xmax=100 Ymax=15
Tstep=.1 Xscl=50 Yscl=10
9. Press y [FORMAT] ~to set
AxesOff, which turns off the axes.
10. Press s. The plotting action
simultaneously shows the ball in flight and the
vertical and horizontal component vectors of
the motion.
Tip: To simulate the ball flying through the air, set
graph style to (animate) for X1T and Y1T.
11. Press r to obtain numerical results and
answer the questions at the beginning of this
section.
Tracing begins at Tmin on the first parametric
equation (X1T and Y1T). As you press ~to
trace the curve, the cursor follows the path of
the ball over time. The values for X (distance),
Y (height), and T (time) are displayed at the
bottom of the screen.
4-4 Parametric Graphing
82EB1A~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 1:58
PM Page 4 of 8
The steps for defining a parametric graph are similar to the steps
for defining a function graph. Chapter 4 assumes that you are
familiar with Chapter 3: Function Graphing. Chapter 4 details
aspects of parametric graphing that differ from function
graphing.
To display the mode screen, press z. To graph parametric
equations, you must select Par graphing mode before you enter
window variables and before you enter the components of
parametric equations.
After selecting Par graphing mode, press o to display the
parametric Y= editor.
In this editor, you can display and enter both the X and Y
components of up to six equations, X1T and Y1T through X6T and
Y6T. Each is defined in terms of the independent variable T. A
common application of parametric graphs is graphing equations
over time.
The icons to the left of X1T through X6T represent the graph style
of each parametric equation (Chapter 3). The default in Par
mode is (line), which connects plotted points. Line, (thick),
(path), (animate), and (dot) styles are available for
parametric graphing.
Defining and Displaying Parametric Graphs
TI-82 STATS
Graphing Mode
Similarities
Setting
Parametric
Graphing Mode
Displaying the
Parametric Y=
Editor
Selecting a
Graph Style
Parametric Graphing 4-5
82EB1A~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 1:58
PM Page 5 of 8
To define or edit a parametric equation, follow the steps in
Chapter 3 for defining a function or editing a function. The
independent variable in a parametric equation is T. In Par
graphing mode, you can enter the parametric variable T in either
of two ways.
Press .
Press T.
Two components, X and Y, define a single parametric equation.
You must define both of them.
The TI-82 STATS graphs only the selected parametric
equations. In the Y= editor, a parametric equation is selected
when the = signs of both the X and Y components are
highlighted. You may select any or all of the equations X1T and
Y1T through X6T and Y6T.
To change the selection status, move the cursor onto the = sign
of either the X or Y component and press . The status of
both the X and Y components is changed.
To display the window variable values, press p. These
variables define the viewing window. The values below are
defaults for Par graphing in Radian angle mode.
Tmin=0 Smallest T value to evaluate
Tmax=6.2831853... Largest T value to evaluate (2p)
Tstep=.1308996... T value increment (p24)
Xmin=L10 Smallest X value to be displayed
Xmax=10 Largest X value to be displayed
Xscl=1 Spacing between the X tick marks
Ymin=L10 Smallest Y value to be displayed
Ymax=10 Largest Y value to be displayed
Yscl=1 Spacing between the Y tick marks
Note: To ensure that sufficient points are plotted, you may want to
change the T window variables.
Defining and
Editing
Parametric
Equations
Selecting and
Deselecting
Parametric
Equations
Setting Window
Variables
4-6 Parametric Graphing
82EB1A~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 1:58
PM Page 6 of 8
To display the current graph format settings, press y
[FORMAT]. Chapter 3 describes the format settings in detail. The
other graphing modes share these format settings; Seq graphing
mode has an additional axes format setting.
When you press s, the TI-82 STATS plots the selected
parametric equations. It evaluates the X and Y components for
each value of T (from Tmin to Tmax in intervals of Tstep), and
then plots each point defined by X and Y. The window variables
define the viewing window.
As the graph is plotted, X, Y, and T are updated.
Smart Graph applies to parametric graphs (Chapter 3).
You can perform these actions from the home screen or a
program.
Access functions by using the name of the X or Y component
of the equation as a variable.
Store parametric equations.
Select or deselect parametric equations.
Store values directly to window variables.
Defining and Displaying Parametric Graphs (continued)
Setting the Graph
Format
Displaying a
Graph
Window
Variables and
Y.VARS Menus
Parametric Graphing 4-7
82EB1A~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 1:58
PM Page 7 of 8
The free-moving cursor in Par graphing works the same as in
Func graphing.
In RectGC format, moving the cursor updates the values of X
and Y; if CoordOn format is selected, X and Y are displayed.
In PolarGC format, X, Y, R, and q are updated; if CoordOn
format is selected, R and q are displayed.
To activate TRACE, press r. When TRACE is active, you
can move the trace cursor along the graph of the equation one
Tstep at a time. When you begin a trace, the trace cursor is on
the first selected function at Tmin. If ExprOn is selected, then
the function is displayed.
In RectGC format, TRACE updates and displays the values of X,
Y, and T if CoordOn format is on.
In PolarGC format, X, Y, R, q and T are updated; if CoordOn
format is selected, R, q, and T are displayed. The X and Y (or R
and q) values are calculated from T.
To move five plotted points at a time on a function, press y
| or y ~. If you move the cursor beyond the top or bottom
of the screen, the coordinate values at the bottom of the screen
continue to change appropriately.
Quick Zoom is available in Par graphing; panning is not
(Chapter 3).
Exploring Parametric Graphs
Free-Moving
Cursor
TRACE
4-8 Parametric Graphing
82EB1A~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 1:58
PM Page 8 of 8
To move the trace cursor to any valid T value on the current
function, enter the number. When you enter the first digit, a T=
prompt and the number you entered are displayed in the bottom-
left corner of the screen. You can enter an expression at the T=
prompt. The value must be valid for the current viewing
window. When you have completed the entry, press to
move the cursor.
ZOOM operations in Par graphing work the same as in Func
graphing. Only the X (Xmin, Xmax, and Xscl) and Y (Ymin,
Ymax, and Yscl) window variables are affected.
The T window variables (Tmin, Tmax, and Tstep) are only
affected when you select ZStandard. The VARS ZOOM
secondary menu ZT/Zq items 1:ZTmin, 2:ZTmax, and 3:ZTstep
are the zoom memory variables for Par graphing.
CALC operations in Par graphing work the same as in Func
graphing. The CALCULATE menu items available in Par
graphing are 1:value, 2:dy/dx, 3:dy/dt, and 4:dx/dt.
Exploring Parametric Graphs (continued)
Moving the Trace
Cursor to Any
Valid T Value
ZOOM
CALC
Polar Graphing 51
825C44~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:00
PM Page 1 of 6
5
Polar
Graphing
Getting Started: Polar Rose.............................................................................. 2
Defining and Displaying Polar Graphs..................................................... 3
Exploring Polar Graphs ...................................................................................... 6
Contents
52 Polar Graphing
825C44~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:00
PM Page 2 of 6
Getting Started is a fast-paced introduction. Read the chapter for details.
The polar equation R=Asin(Bq) graphs a rose. Graph the rose for A=8 and B=2.5, and
then explore the appearance of the rose for other values of A and B.
1. Press z to display the mode screen. Press
~ ~ to select Pol graphing
mode. Select the defaults (the options on the
left) for the other mode settings.
2. Press o to display the polar Y= editor. Press 8
2.5 to define r1.
3. Press q 6 to select 6:ZStandard and graph
the equation in the standard viewing window.
The graph shows only five petals of the rose,
and the rose does not appear to be
symmetrical. This is because the standard
window sets qmax=2p and defines the
window, rather than the pixels, as square.
4. Press p to display the window
variables. Press 4 y[p] to increase the
value of qmax to 4p.
5. Press q 5 to select 5:ZSquare and plot the
graph.
6. Repeat steps 2 through 5 with new values for
the variables A and B in the polar equation
r1=Asin(Bq). Observe how the new values
affect the graph.
Getting Started: Polar Rose
Polar Graphing 53
825C44~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:00
PM Page 3 of 6
The steps for defining a polar graph are similar to the steps for
defining a function graph. Chapter 5 assumes that you are
familiar with Chapter 3: Function Graphing. Chapter 5 details
aspects of polar graphing that differ from function graphing.
To display the mode screen, press z. To graph polar
equations, you must select Pol graphing mode before you enter
values for the window variables and before you enter polar
equations.
After selecting Pol graphing mode, press o to display the polar
Y= editor.
In this editor, you can enter and display up to six polar
equations, r1 through r6. Each is defined in terms of the
independent variable q (page 5.4).
The icons to the left of r1 through r6 represent the graph style of
each polar equation (Chapter 3). The default in Pol graphing
mode is (line), which connects plotted points. Line, (thick),
(path), (animate), and (dot) styles are available for polar
graphing.
Defining and Displaying Polar Graphs
TI-82 STATS
Graphing Mode
Similarities
Setting Polar
Graphing Mode
Displaying the
Polar Y= Editor
Selecting Graph
Styles
54 Polar Graphing
825C44~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:00
PM Page 4 of 6
To define or edit a polar equation, follow the steps in Chapter 3
for defining a function or editing a function. The independent
variable in a polar equation is q. In Pol graphing mode, you can
enter the polar variable q in either of two ways.
Press .
Press q.
The TI-82 STATS graphs only the selected polar equations. In
the Y= editor, a polar equation is selected when the = sign is
highlighted. You may select any or all of the equations.
To change the selection status, move the cursor onto the = sign,
and then press .
To display the window variable values, press p. These
variables define the viewing window. The values below are
defaults for Pol graphing in Radian angle mode.
qmin=0 Smallest q value to evaluate
qmax=6.2831853... Largest q value to evaluate (2p)
qstep=.1308996... Increment between q values (p24)
Xmin=L10 Smallest X value to be displayed
Xmax=10 Largest X value to be displayed
Xscl=1 Spacing between the X tick marks
Ymin=L10 Smallest Y value to be displayed
Ymax=10 Largest Y value to be displayed
Yscl=1 Spacing between the Y tick marks
Note: To ensure that sufficient points are plotted, you may want to
change the q window variables.
Defining and Displaying Polar Graphs (continued)
Defining and
Editing Polar
Equations
Selecting and
Deselecting Polar
Equations
Setting Window
Variables
Polar Graphing 55
825C44~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:00
PM Page 5 of 6
To display the current graph format settings, press y
[FORMAT]. Chapter 3 describes the format settings in detail. The
other graphing modes share these format settings.
When you press s, the TI-82 STATS plots the selected
polar equations. It evaluates R for each value of q (from qmin to
qmax in intervals of qstep) and then plots each point. The
window variables define the viewing window.
As the graph is plotted, X, Y, R, and q are updated.
Smart Graph applies to polar graphs (Chapter 3).
You can perform these actions from the home screen or a
program.
Access functions by using the name of the equation as a
variable.
Store polar equations.
Select or deselect polar equations.
Store values directly to window variables.
Setting the Graph
Format
Displaying a
Graph
Window
Variables and
Y.VARS Menus
56 Polar Graphing
825C44~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:00
PM Page 6 of 6
The free-moving cursor in Pol graphing works the same as in
Func graphing. In RectGC format, moving the cursor updates
the values of X and Y; if CoordOn format is selected, X and Y
are displayed. In PolarGC format, X, Y, R, and q are updated; if
CoordOn format is selected, R and q are displayed.
To activate TRACE, press r. When TRACE is active, you
can move the trace cursor along the graph of the equation one
qstep at a time. When you begin a trace, the trace cursor is on
the first selected function at qmin. If ExprOn format is selected,
then the equation is displayed.
In RectGC format, TRACE updates the values of X, Y, and q; if
CoordOn format is selected, X, Y, and q are displayed. In
PolarGC format, TRACE updates X, Y, R, and q; if CoordOn
format is selected, R and q are displayed.
To move five plotted points at a time on a function, press y
| or y ~. If you move the trace cursor beyond the top or
bottom of the screen, the coordinate values at the bottom of the
screen continue to change appropriately.
Quick Zoom is available in Pol graphing mode; panning is not
(Chapter 3).
To move the trace cursor to any valid q value on the current
function, enter the number. When you enter the first digit, a q=
prompt and the number you entered are displayed in the bottom-
left corner of the screen. You can enter an expression at the q=
prompt. The value must be valid for the current viewing
window. When you complete the entry, press to move
the cursor.
ZOOM operations in Pol graphing work the same as in Func
graphing. Only the X (Xmin, Xmax, and Xscl) and Y (Ymin,
Ymax, and Yscl) window variables are affected.
The q window variables (qmin, qmax, and qstep) are not affected,
except when you select ZStandard. The VARS ZOOM secondary
menu ZT/Zq items 4:Zqmin, 5:Zqmax, and 6:Zqstep are zoom
memory variables for Pol graphing.
CALC operations in Pol graphing work the same as in Func
graphing. The CALCULATE menu items available in Pol
graphing are 1:value, 2:dy/dx, and 3:dr/dq.
Exploring Polar Graphs
Free-Moving
Cursor
TRACE
Moving the Trace
Cursor to Any
Valid q Value
ZOOM
CALC
Sequence Graphing 61
82EAB9~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 9:28 AM Printed: 10/28/05 9:28
AM Page 1 of 16
6
Sequence
Graphing
Getting Started: Forest and Trees................................................................. 2
Defining and Displaying Sequence Graphs........................................... 3
Selecting Axes Combinations......................................................................... 8
Exploring Sequence Graphs............................................................................. 9
Graphing Web Plots.............................................................................................. 11
Using Web Plots to Illustrate Convergence........................................... 12
Graphing Phase Plots ........................................................................................... 13
Comparing TI-82 STATS and TI.82 Sequence Variables........... 15
Keystroke Differences Between TI-82 STATS and TI-82.......... 16
Contents
62 Sequence Graphing
82EAB9~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 9:28 AM Printed: 10/28/05 9:28
AM Page 2 of 16
Getting Started is a fast-paced introduction. Read the chapter for details.
A small forest of 4,000 trees is under a new forestry plan. Each year 20 percent of the
trees will be harvested and 1,000 new trees will be planted. Will the forest eventually
disappear? Will the forest size stabilize? If so, in how many years and with how many
trees?
1. Press z. Press ~~~to
select Seq graphing mode.
2. Press y [FORMAT] and select Time axes
format and ExprOn format if necessary.
3. Press o. If the graph-style icon is not (dot),
press | |, press until is displayed,
and then press ~ ~.
4. Press ~ 3 to select iPart( (integer part)
because only whole trees are harvested. After
each annual harvest, 80 percent (.80) of the
trees remain. Press 8 y[u]
1 to define the number of trees after each
harvest. Press 1000 to define the new
trees. Press 4000 to define the number of
trees at the beginning of the program.
5. Press p 0 to set nMin=0. Press 50 to
set nMax=50. nMin and nMax evaluate forest
size over 50 years. Set the other window
variables.
PlotStart=1 Xmin=0 Ymin=0
PlotStep=1 Xmax=50 Ymax=6000
Xscl=10 Yscl=1000
6. Press r. Tracing begins at nMin (the start
of the forestry plan). Press ~to trace the
sequence year by year. The sequence is
displayed at the top of the screen. The values
for n (number of years), X (X=n, because n is
plotted on the x-axis), and Y (tree count) are
displayed at the bottom. When will the forest
stabilize? With how many trees?
Getting Started: Forest and Trees
Sequence Graphing 63
82EAB9~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 9:28 AM Printed: 10/28/05 9:28
AM Page 3 of 16
The steps for defining a sequence graph are similar to the steps
for defining a function graph. Chapter 6 assumes that you are
familiar with Chapter 3: Function Graphing. Chapter 6 details
aspects of sequence graphing that differ from function graphing.
To display the mode screen, press z. To graph sequence
functions, you must select Seq graphing mode before you enter
window variables and before you enter sequence functions.
Sequence graphs automatically plot in Simul mode, regardless
of the current plotting-order mode setting.
The TI-82 STATS has three sequence functions that you can
enter from the keyboard: u, v, and w. They are above the , ,
and keys.
You can define sequence functions in terms of:
The independent variable n
The previous term in the sequence function, such as u(nN1)
The term that precedes the previous term in the sequence
function, such as u(nN2)
The previous term or the term that precedes the previous
term in another sequence function, such as u(nN1) or u(nN2)
referenced in the sequence v(n).
Note: Statements in this chapter about u(n) are also true for v(n) and
w(n); statements about u(nN1) are also true for v(nN1) and w(nN1);
statements about u(nN2) are also true for v(nN2) and w(nN2).
Defining and Displaying Sequence Graphs
TI-82 STATS
Graphing Mode
Similarities
Setting Sequence
Graphing Mode
TI-82 STATS
Sequence
Functions u, v,
and w
64 Sequence Graphing
82EAB9~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 9:28 AM Printed: 10/28/05 9:28
AM Page 4 of 16
After selecting Seq mode, press o to display the sequence
Y= editor.
In this editor, you can display and enter sequences for u(n), v(n),
and w(n). Also, you can edit the value for nMin, which is the
sequence window variable that defines the minimum n value to
evaluate.
The sequence Y= editor displays the nMin value because of its
relevance to u(nMin), v(nMin), and w(nMin), which are the
initial values for the sequence equations u(n), v(n), and w(n),
respectively.
nMin in the Y= editor is the same as nMin in the window editor.
If you enter a new value for nMin in one editor, the new value
for nMin is updated in both editors.
Note: Use u(nMin), v(nMin), or w(nMin) only with a recursive
sequence, which requires an initial value.
The icons to the left of u(n), v(n), and w(n) represent the graph
style of each sequence (Chapter 3). The default in Seq mode is
(dot), which shows discrete values. Dot, (line), and (thick)
styles are available for sequence graphing. Graph styles are
ignored in Web format.
The TI-82 STATS graphs only the selected sequence functions.
In the Y= editor, a sequence function is selected when the =
signs of both u(n)= and u(nMin)= are highlighted.
To change the selection status of a sequence function, move the
cursor onto the = sign of the function name, and then press
. The status is changed for both the sequence function
u(n) and its initial value u(nMin).
Defining and Displaying Sequence Graphs (continued)
Displaying the
Sequence Y=
Editor
Selecting Graph
Styles
Selecting and
Deselecting
Sequence
Functions
Sequence Graphing 65
82EAB9~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 9:28 AM Printed: 10/28/05 9:28
AM Page 5 of 16
To define or edit a sequence function, follow the steps in
Chapter 3 for defining a function. The independent variable in a
sequence is n.
In Seq graphing mode, you can enter the sequence variable in
either of two ways.
Press .
Press y [CATALOG] [N].
You can enter the function name from the keyboard.
To enter the function name u, press y [u] (above ).
To enter the function name v, press y [v] (above ).
To enter the function name w, press y [w] (above ).
Generally, sequences are either nonrecursive or recursive.
Sequences are evaluated only at consecutive integer values. n is
always a series of consecutive integers, starting at zero or any
positive integer.
In a nonrecursive sequence, the nth term is a function of the
independent variable n. Each term is independent of all other
terms.
For example, in the nonrecursive sequence below, you can
calculate u(5) directly, without first calculating u(1) or any
previous term.
The sequence equation above returns the sequence
2, 4, 6, 8, 10, . . . for n = 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, . . . .
Note: You may leave blank the initial value u(nMin) when calculating
nonrecursive sequences.
Defining and
Editing a
Sequence
Function
Nonrecursive
Sequences
66 Sequence Graphing
82EAB9~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 9:28 AM Printed: 10/28/05 9:28
AM Page 6 of 16
In a recursive sequence, the nth term in the sequence is defined
in relation to the previous term or the term that precedes the
previous term, represented by u(nN1) and u(nN2). A recursive
sequence may also be defined in relation to n, as in
u(n)=u(nN1)+n.
For example, in the sequence below you cannot calculate u(5)
without first calculating u(1), u(2), u(3), and u(4).
Using an initial value u(nMin) = 1, the sequence above returns
1, 2, 4, 8, 16, . . .
Tip: On the TI-82 STATS, you must type each character of the terms.
For example, to enter u(nN1), press y [u] .
Recursive sequences require an initial value or values, since
they reference undefined terms.
If each term in the sequence is defined in relation to the
previous term, as in u(nN1), you must specify an initial value
for the first term.
If each term in the sequence is defined in relation to the term
that precedes the previous term, as in u(nN2), you must
specify initial values for the first two terms. Enter the initial
values as a list enclosed in braces ({ }) with commas
separating the values.
The value of the first term is 0 and the value of the second term
is 1 for the sequence u(n).
Defining and Displaying Sequence Graphs (continued)
Recursive
Sequences
Sequence Graphing 67
82EAB9~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 9:28 AM Printed: 10/28/05 9:28
AM Page 7 of 16
To display the window variables, press p. These
variables define the viewing window. The values below are
defaults for Seq graphing in both Radian and Degree angle
modes.
nMin=1 Smallest n value to evaluate
nMax=10 Largest n value to evaluate
PlotStart=1 First term number to be plotted
PlotStep=1 Incremental n value (for graphing only)
Xmin=L10 Smallest X value to be displayed
Xmax=10 Largest X value to be displayed
Xscl=1 Spacing between the X tick marks
Ymin=L10 Smallest Y value to be displayed
Ymax=10 Largest Y value to be displayed
Yscl=1 Spacing between the Y tick marks
nMin must be an integer 0. nMax, PlotStart, and PlotStep
must be integers 1.
nMin is the smallest n value to evaluate. nMin also is displayed
in the sequence Y= editor. nMax is the largest n value to
evaluate. Sequences are evaluated at u(nMin), u(nMin+1),
u(nMin+2) , . . . , u(nMax).
PlotStart is the first term to be plotted. PlotStart=1 begins
plotting on the first term in the sequence. If you want plotting to
begin with the fifth term in a sequence, for example, set
PlotStart=5. The first four terms are evaluated but are not
plotted on the graph.
PlotStep is the incremental n value for graphing only. PlotStep
does not affect sequence evaluation; it only designates which
points are plotted on the graph. If you specify PlotStep=2, the
sequence is evaluated at each consecutive integer, but it is
plotted on the graph only at every other integer.
Setting Window
Variables
68 Sequence Graphing
82EAB9~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 9:28 AM Printed: 10/28/05 9:28
AM Page 8 of 16
To display the current graph format settings, press y
[FORMAT]. Chapter 3 describes the format settings in detail. The
other graphing modes share these format settings. The axes
setting on the top line of the screen is available only in Seq
mode.
Time Web uv vw uw Type of sequence plot (axes)
RectGC PolarGC Rectangular or polar output
CoordOn CoordOff Cursor coordinate display on/off
GridOff GridOn Grid display off or on
AxesOn AxesOff Axes display on or off
LabelOff LabelOn Axes label display off or on
ExprOn ExprOff Expression display on or off
For sequence graphing, you can select from five axes formats.
The table below shows the values that are plotted on the x-axis
and y-axis for each axes setting.
Axes Setting x-axis y-axis
Time n u(n), v(n), w(n)
Web u(nN1), v(nN1), w(nN1) u(n), v(n), w(n)
uv u(n) v(n)
vw v(n) w(n)
uw u(n) w(n)
See pages 6.11 and 6.12 for more information on Web plots.
See page 6.13 for more information on phase plots (uv, vw, and
uw axes settings).
To plot the selected sequence functions, press s. As a
graph is plotted, the TI-82 STATS updates X, Y, and n.
Smart Graph applies to sequence graphs (Chapter 3).
Selecting Axes Combinations
Setting the Graph
Format
Setting Axes
Format
Displaying a
Sequence Graph
Sequence Graphing 69
82EAB9~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 9:28 AM Printed: 10/28/05 9:28
AM Page 9 of 16
The free-moving cursor in Seq graphing works the same as in
Func graphing. In RectGC format, moving the cursor updates
the values of X and Y; if CoordOn format is selected, X and Y
are displayed. In PolarGC format, X, Y, R, and q are updated; if
CoordOn format is selected, R and q are displayed.
The axes format setting affects TRACE.
When Time, uv, vw, or uw axes format is selected, TRACE
moves the cursor along the sequence one PlotStep increment at
a time. To move five plotted points at once, press y ~ or y
|.
When you begin a trace, the trace cursor is on the first
selected sequence at the term number specified by PlotStart,
even if it is outside the viewing window.
Quick Zoom applies to all directions. To center the viewing
window on the current cursor location after you have moved
the trace cursor, press . The trace cursor returns to
nMin.
In Web format, the trail of the cursor helps identify points with
attracting and repelling behavior in the sequence. When you
begin a trace, the cursor is on the x-axis at the initial value of
the first selected function.
Tip: To move the cursor to a specified n during a trace, enter a value
for n, and press . For example, to quickly return the cursor to
the beginning of the sequence, paste nMin to the n= prompt and
press .
To move the trace cursor to any valid n value on the current
function, enter the number. When you enter the first digit, an n
= prompt and the number you entered are displayed in the
bottom-left corner of the screen. You can enter an expression at
the n = prompt. The value must be valid for the current viewing
window. When you have completed the entry, press to
move the cursor.
Exploring Sequence Graphs
Free-Moving
Cursor
TRACE
Moving the Trace
Cursor to Any
Valid n Value
610 Sequence Graphing
82EAB9~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 9:28 AM Printed: 10/28/05 9:28
AM Page 10 of 16
ZOOM operations in Seq graphing work the same as in Func
graphing. Only the X (Xmin, Xmax, and Xscl) and Y (Ymin,
Ymax, and Yscl) window variables are affected.
PlotStart, PlotStep, nMin, and nMax are only affected when
you select ZStandard. The VARS Zoom secondary menu ZU
items 1 through 7 are the ZOOM MEMORY variables for Seq
graphing.
The only CALC operation available in Seq graphing is value.
When Time axes format is selected, value displays Y (the
u(n) value) for a specified n value.
When Web axes format is selected, value draws the web and
displays Y (the u(n) value) for a specified n value.
When uv, vw, or uw axes format is selected, value displays
X and Y according to the axes format setting. For example,
for uv axes format, X represents u(n) and Y represents v(n).
To enter the sequence names u, v, or w, press y [u], [v], or
[w]. You can evaluate these names in any of three ways.
Calculate the nth value in a sequence.
Calculate a list of values in a sequence.
Generate a sequence with u(nstart,nstop[,nstep]). nstep is
optional; default is 1.
Exploring Sequence Graphs (continued)
ZOOM
CALC
Evaluating u, v,
and w
Sequence Graphing 611
82EAB9~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 9:28 AM Printed: 10/28/05 9:28
AM Page 11 of 16
To select Web axes format, press y [FORMAT] ~ . A
web plot graphs u(n) versus u(nN1), which you can use to study
long-term behavior (convergence, divergence, or oscillation) of
a recursive sequence. You can see how the sequence may
change behavior as its initial value changes.
When Web axes format is selected, a sequence will not graph
properly or will generate an error.
It must be recursive with only one recursion level (u(nN1)
but not u(nN2)).
It cannot reference n directly.
It cannot reference any defined sequence except itself.
In Web format, press s to display the graph screen. The
TI-82 STATS:
Draws a y=x reference line in AxesOn format.
Plots the selected sequences with u(nN1) as the independent
variable.
Note: A potential convergence point occurs whenever a sequence
intersects the y=x reference line. However, the sequence may or may
not actually converge at that point, depending on the sequences
initial value.
To activate the trace cursor, press r. The screen displays
the sequence and the current n, X, and Y values (X represents
u(nN1) and Y represents u(n)). Press ~ repeatedly to draw the
web step by step, starting at nMin. In Web format, the trace
cursor follows this course.
1. It starts on the x-axis at the initial value u(nMin) (when
PlotStart=1).
2. It moves vertically (up or down) to the sequence.
3. It moves horizontally to the y=x reference line.
4. It repeats this vertical and horizontal movement as you
continue to press ~.
Graphing Web Plots
Graphing a Web
Plot
Valid Functions
for Web Plots
Displaying the
Graph Screen
Drawing the Web
612 Sequence Graphing
82EAB9~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 9:28 AM Printed: 10/28/05 9:28
AM Page 12 of 16
1. Press o in Seq mode to display the sequence Y= editor. Make
sure the graph style is set to (dot), and then define nMin, u(n)
and u(nMin) as shown below.
2. Press y [FORMAT] to set Time axes format.
3. Press p and set the variables as shown below.
nMin=1 Xmin=0 Ymin=L10
nMax=25 Xmax=25 Ymax=10
PlotStart=1 Xscl=1 Yscl=1
PlotStep=1
4. Press s to graph the sequence.
5. Press y [FORMAT] and select the Web axes setting.
6. Press p and change the variables below.
Xmin=L10 Xmax=10
7. Press s to graph the sequence.
8. Press r, and then press ~ to draw the web. The
displayed cursor coordinates n, X (u(nN1)), and
Y (u(n)) change accordingly. When you press ~, a new n
value is displayed, and the trace cursor is on the sequence.
When you press ~ again, the n value remains the same, and
the cursor moves to the y=x reference line. This pattern repeats
as you trace the web.
Using Web Plots to Illustrate Convergence
Example:
Convergence
Sequence Graphing 613
82EAB9~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 9:28 AM Printed: 10/28/05 9:28
AM Page 13 of 16
The phase-plot axes settings uv, vw, and uw show relationships
between two sequences. To select a phase-plot axes setting,
press y [FORMAT], press ~ until the cursor is on uv, vw, or
uw, and then press .
Axes Setting x-axis y-axis
uv u(n) v(n)
vw v(n) w(n)
uw u(n) w(n)
Use the predator-prey model to determine the regional
populations of a predator and its prey that would maintain
population equilibrium for the two species.
This example uses the model to determine the equilibrium
populations of wolves and rabbits, with initial populations of
200 rabbits (u(nMin)) and 50 wolves (v(nMin)).
These are the variables (given values are in parentheses):
R = number of rabbits
M = rabbit population growth rate without wolves (.05)
K = rabbit population death rate with wolves (.001)
W = number of wolves
G = wolf population growth rate with rabbits (.0002)
D = wolf population death rate without rabbits (.03)
n = time (in months)
R
n
= R
nN1
(1+MNKW
nN1
)
W
n
= W
nN1
(1+GR
nN1
ND)
1. Press o in Seq mode to display the sequence Y= editor.
Define the sequences and initial values for R
n
and W
n
as
shown below. Enter the sequence R
n
as u(n) and enter the
sequence W
n
as v(n).
Graphing Phase Plots
Graphing with uv,
vw, and uw
Example:
Predator-Prey
Model
614 Sequence Graphing
82EAB9~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 9:28 AM Printed: 10/28/05 9:28
AM Page 14 of 16
2. Press y [FORMAT] to select Time axes format.
3. Press p and set the variables as shown below.
nMin=0 Xmin=0 Ymin=0
nMax=400 Xmax=400 Ymax=300
PlotStart=1 Xscl=100 Yscl=100
PlotStep=1
4. Press s to graph the sequence.
5. Press r ~ to individually trace the number of rabbits
(u(n)) and wolves (v(n)) over time (n).
Tip: Press a number, and then press to jump to a specific n
value (month) while in TRACE.
6. Press y [FORMAT] ~ ~ to select uv axes format.
7. Press p and change these variables as shown below.
Xmin=84 Ymin=25
Xmax=237 Ymax=75
Xscl=50 Yscl=10
8. Press r. Trace both the number of rabbits (X) and the
number of wolves (Y) through 400 generations.
Note: When you press r, the
equation for u is displayed in the
top-left corner. Press } or to
see the equation for v.
Graphing Phase Plots (continued)
Example:
Predator-Prey
Model
(continued)
Sequence Graphing 615
82EAB9~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 9:28 AM Printed: 10/28/05 9:28
AM Page 15 of 16
Refer to the table if you are familiar with the TI-82. It shows
TI-82 STATS sequences and sequence window variables, as
well as their TI-82 counterparts.
TI-82 STATS TI.82
In the Y= editor:
u(n) Un
u(nMin) UnStart (window variable)
v(n) Vn
v(nMin) VnStart (window variable)
w(n) not available
w(nMin) not available
In the window editor:
nMin nStart
nMax nMax
PlotStart nMin
PlotStep not available
Comparing TI-82 STATS and TI-82 Sequence Variables
Sequences and
Window
Variables
616 Sequence Graphing
82EAB9~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 9:28 AM Printed: 10/28/05 9:28
AM Page 16 of 16
Refer to the table if you are familiar with the TI-82. It compares
TI-82 STATS sequence-name syntax and variable syntax with
TI.82 sequence-name syntax and variable syntax.
TI-82 STATS /
TI.82
On TI-82 STATS,
press:
On TI.82, press:
n / n y [n]
u(n) / Un y[u]
y [Y.VARS]
v(n) / Vn y[v]
y [Y.VARS]
w(n) y[w]
not available
u(nN1) / UnN1 y[u]
y [U
nN1
]
v(nN1) / VnN1 y[v]
y [V
nN1
]
w(nN1) y[w]
not available
Keystroke Differences Between TI-82 STATS and TI-82
Sequence
Keystroke
Changes
Tables 71
82533C~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:24 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:20
PM Page 1 of 6
7
Tables
Getting Started: Roots of a Function.......................................................... 2
Setting Up the Table............................................................................................. 3
Defining the Dependent Variables............................................................... 4
Displaying the Table............................................................................................. 5
Contents
72 Tables
82533C~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:24 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:20
PM Page 2 of 6
Getting Started is a fast-paced introduction. Read the chapter for details.
Evaluate the function Y = X
3
N 2X at each integer between L10 and 10. How many
sign changes occur, and at what X values?
1. Press z to set Func
graphing mode.
2. Press o. Press 3 to select
3
.
Then press 2 to enter the function
Y1=X
3
N2X.
3. Press y [TBLSET] to display the TABLE
SETUP screen. Press 10 to set
TblStart=L10. Press 1 to set @Tbl=1.
Press to select Indpnt: Auto
(automatically generated independent values).
Press to select Depend: Auto
(automatically generated dependent values).
4. Press y [TABLE] to display the table screen.
5. Press until you see the sign changes in the
value of Y1. How many sign changes occur,
and at what X values?
Getting Started: Roots of a Function
Tables 73
82533C~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:24 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:20
PM Page 3 of 6
To display the TABLE SETUP screen, press y [TBLSET].
TblStart (table start) defines the initial value for the independent
variable. TblStart applies only when the independent variable is
generated automatically (when Indpnt: Auto is selected).
@Tbl (table step) defines the increment for the independent
variable.
Note: In Seq mode, both TblStart and @Tbl must be integers.
Selections Table Characteristics
Indpnt: Auto
Depend: Auto
Values are displayed automatically in both the
independent-variable column and in all
dependent-variable columns.
Indpnt: Ask
Depend: Auto
The table is empty; when you enter a value for
the independent variable, all corresponding
dependent-variable values are calculated and
displayed automatically.
Indpnt: Auto
Depend: Ask
Values are displayed automatically for the
independent variable; to generate a value for a
dependent variable, move the cursor to that
cell and press .
Indpnt: Ask
Depend: Ask
The table is empty; enter values for the
independent variable; to generate a value for a
dependent variable, move the cursor to that
cell and press .
To store a value to TblStart, @Tbl, or TblZnput from the home
screen or a program, select the variable name from the VARS
TABLE secondary menu. TblZnput is a list of independent-
variable values in the current table.
When you press y [TBLSET] in the program editor, you can
select IndpntAuto, IndpntAsk, DependAuto, and DependAsk.
Setting Up the Table
TABLE SETUP
Screen
TblStart, @Tbl
Indpnt: Auto,
Indpnt: Ask,
Depend: Auto,
Depend: Ask
Setting Up the
Table from the
Home Screen or
a Program
74 Tables
82533C~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:24 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:20
PM Page 4 of 6
In the Y= editor, enter the functions that define the dependent
variables. Only functions that are selected in the Y= editor are
displayed in the table. The current graphing mode is used. In
Par mode, you must define both components of each parametric
equation (Chapter 4).
To edit a selected Y= function from the table editor, follow these
steps.
1. Press y [TABLE] to display the table, then press ~ or | to
move the cursor to a dependent-variable column.
2. Press } until the cursor is on the function name at the top of
the column. The function is displayed on the bottom line.
3. Press . The cursor moves to the bottom line. Edit the
function.
4. Press or . The new values are calculated. The table
and the Y= function are updated automatically.
Note: You also can use this feature to view the function that
defines a dependent variable without having to leave the table.
Defining the Dependent Variables
Defining
Dependent
Variables from
the Y= Editor
Editing
Dependent
Variables from
the Table Editor
Tables 75
82533C~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:24 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:20
PM Page 5 of 6
To display the table, press y [TABLE].
Current cell
Independent-
variable values
in the first
column
Dependent-
variable values in
the second and
third columns
Current cells full value
Note: The table abbreviates the values, if necessary.
The current graphing mode determines which independent and
dependent variables are displayed in the table (Chapter 1). In the
table above, for example, the independent variable X and the
dependent variables Y1 and Y2 are displayed because Func
graphing mode is set.
Graphing Mode Independent
Variable
Dependent
Variable
Func (function) X Y1 through Y9, and
Y0
Par (parametric) T X1T/Y1T through
X6T/Y6T
Pol (polar) q r1 through r6
Seq (sequence) n u(n), v(n), and w(n)
From the home screen, select the ClrTable instruction from the
CATALOG. To clear the table, press .
From a program, select 9:ClrTable from the PRGM I/O menu or
from the CATALOG. The table is cleared upon execution. If
IndpntAsk is selected, all independent and dependent variable
values on the table are cleared. If DependAsk is selected, all
dependent variable values on the table are cleared.
Displaying the Table
The Table
Independent and
Dependent
Variables
Clearing the
Table from the
Home Screen or
a Program
76 Tables
82533C~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:24 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:20
PM Page 6 of 6
If Indpnt: Auto is selected, you can press } and in the
independent-variable column to display more values. As you
scroll the column, the corresponding dependent-variable values
also are displayed. All dependent-variable values may not be
displayed if Depend: Ask is selected.
Note: You can scroll back from the value entered for TblStart. As
you scroll, TblStart is updated automatically to the value shown on
the top line of the table. In the example above, TblStart=0 and
@Tbl=1 generates and displays values of X=0, . . . , 6; but you can
press } to scroll back and display the table for X=M1, . . ., 5.
If you have defined more than two dependent variables, the first
two selected Y= functions are displayed initially. Press ~ or |
to display dependent variables defined by other selected Y=
functions. The independent variable always remains in the left
column, except during a trace with Par graphing mode and G.T
split-screen mode set.
Tip: To simultaneously display on the table two dependent variables
that are not defined as consecutive Y= functions, go to the Y= editor
and deselect the Y= functions between the two you want to display.
For example, to simultaneously display Y4 and Y7 on the table, go to
the Y= editor and deselect Y5 and Y6.
Displaying the Table (continued)
Scrolling
Independent-
Variable Values
Displaying Other
Dependent
Variables
DRAW Instructions 81
82CA5D~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:27 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:36
PM Page 1 of 20
8
Draw
Instructions
Getting Started: Drawing a Tangent Line............................................... 2
Using the DRAW Menu...................................................................................... 3
Clearing Drawings ................................................................................................. 4
Drawing Line Segments..................................................................................... 5
Drawing Horizontal and Vertical Lines ................................................... 6
Drawing Tangent Lines ...................................................................................... 8
Drawing Functions and Inverses................................................................... 9
Shading Areas on a Graph ................................................................................ 10
Drawing Circles....................................................................................................... 11
Placing Text on a Graph..................................................................................... 12
Using Pen to Draw on a Graph...................................................................... 13
Drawing Points on a Graph.............................................................................. 14
Drawing Pixels......................................................................................................... 16
Storing Graph Pictures (Pics) ......................................................................... 17
Recalling Graph Pictures (Pics) .................................................................... 18
Storing Graph Databases (GDBs)................................................................. 19
Recalling Graph Databases (GDBs)............................................................ 20
Contents
82 DRAW Instructions
82CA5D~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:27 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:36
PM Page 2 of 20
Getting Started is a fast-paced introduction. Read the chapter for details.
Suppose you want to find the equation of the tangent line at X = 2/2 for the function
Y = sinX.
Before you begin, select Radian and Func mode
from the mode screen, if necessary.
1. Press o to display the Y= editor. Press
to store sin(X) in Y1.
2. Press q 7 to select 7:ZTrig, which graphs
the equation in the Zoom Trig window.
3. Press y [DRAW] 5 to select 5:Tangent(. The
tangent instruction is initiated.
4. Press y [] 2 2.
5. Press . The tangent line is drawn; the X
value and the tangent-line equation are
displayed on the graph.
Getting Started: Drawing a Tangent Line
DRAW Instructions 83
82CA5D~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:27 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:36
PM Page 3 of 20
To display the DRAW menu, press y [DRAW]. The
TI-82 STATS interpretation of these instructions depends on
whether you accessed the menu from the home screen or the
program editor or directly from a graph.
DRA
W
POINTS STO
1: ClrDraw Clears all drawn elements.
2: Line( Draws a line segment between 2 points.
3: Horizontal Draws a horizontal line.
4: Vertical Draws a vertical line.
5: Tangent( Draws a line segment tangent to a function.
6: DrawF Draws a function.
7: Shade( Shades an area between two functions.
8: DrawInv Draws the inverse of a function.
9: Circle( Draws a circle.
0: Text( Draws text on a graph screen.
A: Pen Activates the free-form drawing tool.
The DRAW instructions draw on top of graphs. Therefore,
before you use the DRAW instructions, consider whether you
want to perform one or more of the following actions.
Change the mode settings on the mode screen.
Change the format settings on the format screen.
Enter or edit functions in the Y= editor.
Select or deselect functions in the Y= editor.
Change the window variable values.
Turn stat plots on or off.
Clear existing drawings with ClrDraw (page 8.4).
Note: If you draw on a graph and then perform any of the actions
listed above, the graph is replotted without the drawings when you
display the graph again.
You can use any DRAW menu instructions except DrawInv to
draw on Func, Par, Pol, and Seq graphs. DrawInv is valid only
in Func graphing. The coordinates for all DRAW instructions are
the displays x-coordinate and y-coordinate values.
You can use most DRAW menu and DRAW POINTS menu
instructions to draw directly on a graph, using the cursor to
identify the coordinates. You also can execute these instructions
from the home screen or from within a program. If a graph is not
displayed when you select a DRAW menu instruction, the home
screen is displayed.
Using the DRAW Menu
DRAW Menu
Before Drawing
on a Graph
Drawing on a
Graph
84 DRAW Instructions
82CA5D~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:27 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:36
PM Page 4 of 20
All points, lines, and shading drawn on a graph with DRAW
instructions are temporary.
To clear drawings from the currently displayed graph, select
1:ClrDraw from the DRAW menu. The current graph is replotted
and displayed with no drawn elements.
To clear drawings on a graph from the home screen or a
program, begin on a blank line on the home screen or in the
program editor. Select 1:ClrDraw from the DRAW menu. The
instruction is copied to the cursor location. Press .
When ClrDraw is executed, it clears all drawings from the
current graph and displays the message Done. When you
display the graph again, all drawn points, lines, circles, and
shaded areas will be gone.
Note: Before you clear drawings, you can store them with StorePic
(page 8.17).
Clearing Drawings
Clearing
Drawings When
a Graph Is
Displayed
Clearing
Drawings from
the Home Screen
or a Program
DRAW Instructions 85
82CA5D~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:27 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:36
PM Page 5 of 20
To draw a line segment when a graph is displayed, follow these
steps.
1. Select 2:Line( from the DRAW menu.
2. Place the cursor on the point where you want the line
segment to begin, and then press .
3. Move the cursor to the point where you want the line
segment to end. The line is displayed as you move the
cursor. Press .
To continue drawing line segments, repeat steps 2 and 3. To
cancel Line(, press .
Line( also draws a line segment between the coordinates (X1,Y1)
and (X2,Y2). The values may be entered as expressions.
Line(X1,Y1,X2,Y2)
To erase a line segment, enter Line(X1,Y1,X2,Y2,0)
Drawing Line Segments
Drawing a Line
Segment Directly
on a Graph
Drawing a Line
Segment from
the Home Screen
or a Program
86 DRAW Instructions
82CA5D~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:27 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:36
PM Page 6 of 20
To draw a horizontal or vertical line when a graph is displayed,
follow these steps.
1. Select 3:Horizontal or 4:Vertical from the DRAW menu. A
line is displayed that moves as you move the cursor.
2. Place the cursor on the y-coordinate (for horizontal lines) or
x-coordinate (for vertical lines) through which you want the
drawn line to pass.
3. Press to draw the line on the graph.
To continue drawing lines, repeat steps 2 and 3.
To cancel Horizontal or Vertical, press .
Drawing Horizontal and Vertical Lines
Drawing a Line
Directly on a
Graph
DRAW Instructions 87
82CA5D~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:27 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:36
PM Page 7 of 20
Horizontal (horizontal line) draws a horizontal line at Y=y. y can
be an expression but not a list.
Horizontal y
Vertical (vertical line) draws a vertical line at X=x. x can be an
expression but not a list.
Vertical x
To instruct the TI-82 STATS to draw more than one horizontal
or vertical line, separate each instruction with a colon ( : ).
Drawing a Line
from the Home
Screen or a
Program
88 DRAW Instructions
82CA5D~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:27 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:36
PM Page 8 of 20
To draw a tangent line when a graph is displayed, follow these
steps.
1. Select 5:Tangent( from the DRAW menu.
2. Press and } to move the cursor to the function for which
you want to draw the tangent line. The current graphs Y=
function is displayed in the top-left corner, if ExprOn is
selected.
3. Press ~ and | or enter a number to select the point on the
function at which you want to draw the tangent line.
4. Press . In Func mode, the X value at which the tangent
line was drawn is displayed on the bottom of the screen,
along with the equation of the tangent line. In all other
modes, the dy/dx value is displayed.
Tip: Change the fixed decimal setting on the mode screen if you want
to see fewer digits displayed for X and the equation for Y.
Tangent( (tangent line) draws a line tangent to expression in
terms of X, such as Y1 or X
2
, at point X=value. X can be an
expression. expression is interpreted as being in Func mode.
Tangent(expression,value)
Drawing Tangent Lines
Drawing
a Tangent Line
Directly
on a Graph
Drawing
a Tangent Line
from the Home
Screen or
a Program
DRAW Instructions 89
82CA5D~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:27 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:36
PM Page 9 of 20
DrawF (draw function) draws expression as a function in terms
of X on the current graph. When you select 6:DrawF from the
DRAW menu, the TI-82 STATS returns to the home screen or
the program editor. DrawF is not interactive.
DrawF expression
Note: You cannot use a list in expression to draw a family of curves.
DrawInv (draw inverse) draws the inverse of expression by
plotting X values on the y-axis and Y values on the x-axis. When
you select 8:DrawInv from the DRAW menu, the TI-82 STATS
returns to the home screen or the program editor. DrawInv is not
interactive. DrawInv works in Func mode only.
DrawInv expression
Note: You cannot use a list in expression to draw a family of curves.
Drawing Functions and Inverses
Drawing a
Function
Drawing an
Inverse of a
Function
810 DRAW Instructions
82CA5D~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:27 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:36
PM Page 10 of 20
To shade an area on a graph, select 7:Shade( from the DRAW
menu. The instruction is pasted to the home screen or to the
program editor.
Shade( draws lowerfunc and upperfunc in terms of X on the
current graph and shades the area that is specifically above
lowerfunc and below upperfunc. Only the areas where lowerfunc
< upperfunc are shaded.
Xleft and Xright, if included, specify left and right boundaries
for the shading. Xleft and Xright must be numbers between
Xmin and Xmax, which are the defaults.
pattern specifies one of four shading patterns.
pattern=1 vertical (default)
pattern=2 horizontal
pattern=3 negativeslope 45
pattern=4 positiveslope 45
patres specifies one of eight shading resolutions.
patres=1 shades every pixel (default)
patres=2 shades every second pixel
patres=3 shades every third pixel
patres=4 shades every fourth pixel
patres=5 shades every fifth pixel
patres=6 shades every sixth pixel
patres=7 shades every seventh pixel
patres=8 shades every eighth pixel
Shade(lowerfunc,upperfunc[,Xleft,Xright,pattern,patres])
Shading Areas on a Graph
Shading a Graph
DRAW Instructions 811
82CA5D~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:27 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:36
PM Page 11 of 20
To draw a circle directly on a displayed graph using the cursor,
follow these steps.
1. Select 9:Circle( from the DRAW menu.
2. Place the cursor at the center of the circle you want to draw.
Press .
3. Move the cursor to a point on the circumference. Press
to draw the circle on the graph.
Note: This circle is displayed as circular, regardless of the window
variable values, because you drew it directly on the display. When
you use the Circle( instruction from the home screen or a
program, the current window variables may distort the shape.
To continue drawing circles, repeat steps 2 and 3. To cancel
Circle(, press .
Circle( draws a circle with center (X,Y) and radius. These
values can be expressions.
Circle(X,Y,radius)
Tip: When you use Circle( on the home screen or from a program,
the current window values may distort the drawn circle. Use ZSquare
(Chapter 3) before drawing the circle to adjust the window variables
and make the circle circular.
Drawing Circles
Drawing a Circle
Directly on a
Graph
Drawing a Circle
from the Home
Screen or a
Program
812 DRAW Instructions
82CA5D~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:27 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:36
PM Page 12 of 20
To place text on a graph when the graph is displayed, follow
these steps.
1. Select 0:Text( from the DRAW menu.
2. Place the cursor where you want the text to begin.
3. Enter the characters. Press or y [A.LOCK] to enter
letters and q. You may enter TI-82 STATS functions,
variables, and instructions. The font is proportional, so the
exact number of characters you can place on the graph
varies. As you type, the characters are placed on top of the
graph.
To cancel Text(, press .
Text( places on the current graph the characters comprising
value, which can include TI-82 STATS functions and
instructions. The top-left corner of the first character is at pixel
(row,column), where row is an integer between
0 and 57 and column is an integer between 0 and 94. Both row
and column can be expressions.
Text(row,column,value,value . . .)
value can be text enclosed in quotation marks ( " ), or it can be
an expression. The TI-82 STATS will evaluate an expression
and display the result with up to 10 characters.
On a Horiz split screen, the maximum value for row is 25. On a
G.T split screen, the maximum value for row is 45, and the
maximum value for column is 46.
Placing Text on a Graph
Placing Text
Directly on a
Graph
Placing Text on a
Graph from the
Home Screen or
a Program
Split Screen
DRAW Instructions 813
82CA5D~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:27 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:36
PM Page 13 of 20
Pen draws directly on a graph only. You cannot execute Pen
from the home screen or a program.
To draw on a displayed graph, follow these steps.
1. Select A:Pen from the DRAW menu.
2. Place the cursor on the point where you want to begin
drawing. Press to turn on the pen.
3. Move the cursor. As you move the cursor, you draw on the
graph, shading one pixel at a time.
4. Press to turn off the pen.
For example, Pen was used to create the arrow pointing to the
local minimum of the selected function.
To continue drawing on the graph, move the cursor to a new
position where you want to begin drawing again, and then
repeat steps 2, 3, and 4. To cancel Pen, press .
Using Pen to Draw on a Graph
Using Pen to
Draw on a Graph
814 DRAW Instructions
82CA5D~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:27 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:36
PM Page 14 of 20
To display the DRAW POINTS menu, press y [DRAW] ~. The
TI-82 STATS interpretation of these instructions depends on
whether you accessed this menu from the home screen or the
program editor or directly from a graph.
DRAW POINTS STO
1: Pt-On( Turns on a point.
2: Pt-Off( Turns off a point.
3: Pt-Change( Toggles a point on or off.
4: Pxl-On( Turns on a pixel.
5: Pxl-Off( Turns off a pixel.
6: Pxl-Change( Toggles a pixel on or off.
7: pxl-Test( Returns 1 if pixel on, 0 if pixel off.
To draw a point on a graph, follow these steps.
1. Select 1:Pt.On( from the DRAW POINTS menu.
2. Move the cursor to the position where you want to draw the
point.
3. Press to draw the point.
To continue drawing points, repeat steps 2 and 3. To cancel
Pt.On(, press .
Drawing Points on a Graph
DRAW POINTS
Menu
Drawing Points
Directly on a
Graph with
Pt.On(
DRAW Instructions 815
82CA5D~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:27 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:36
PM Page 15 of 20
To erase (turn off) a drawn point on a graph, follow these steps.
1. Select 2:Pt.Off( (point off) from the DRAW POINTS menu.
2. Move the cursor to the point you want to erase.
3. Press to erase the point.
To continue erasing points, repeat steps 2 and 3. To cancel
Pt.Off(, press .
To change (toggle on or off) a point on a graph, follow these
steps.
1. Select 3:Pt.Change( (point change) from the DRAW POINTS
menu.
2. Move the cursor to the point you want to change.
3. Press to change the points on/off status.
To continue changing points, repeat steps 2 and 3. To cancel
Pt.Change(, press .
Pt.On( (point on) turns on the point at (X=x,Y=y). Pt.Off( turns
the point off. Pt.Change( toggles the point on or off. mark is
optional; it determines the points appearance; specify 1, 2, or 3,
where:
1 = (dot; default) 2 = (box) 3 = + (cross)
Pt.On(x,y[,mark])
Pt.Off(x,y[,mark])
Pt.Change(x,y)
Note: If you specified mark to turn on a point with Pt.On(, you must
specify mark when you turn off the point with Pt.Off(. Pt.Change(
does not have the mark option.
Erasing Points
with Pt.Off(
Changing Points
with Pt.Change(
Drawing Points
from the Home
Screen or a
Program
816 DRAW Instructions
82CA5D~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:27 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:36
PM Page 16 of 20
A pixel is a square dot on the TI-82 STATS display. The Pxl.
(pixel) instructions let you turn on, turn off, or reverse a pixel
(dot) on the graph using the cursor. When you select a pixel
instruction from the DRAW POINTS menu, the TI-82 STATS
returns to the home screen or the program editor. The pixel
instructions are not interactive.
Pxl.On( (pixel on) turns on the pixel at (row,column), where
row is an integer between 0 and 62 and column is an integer
between 0 and 94.
Pxl.Off( turns the pixel off. Pxl.Change( toggles the pixel on
and off.
Pxl.On(row,column)
Pxl.Off(row,column)
Pxl.Change(row,column)
pxl.Test( (pixel test) returns 1 if the pixel at (row,column) is
turned on or 0 if the pixel is turned off on the current graph. row
must be an integer between 0 and 62. column must be an integer
between 0 and 94.
pxl.Test(row,column)
On a Horiz split screen, the maximum value for row is 30 for
Pxl.On(, Pxl.Off(, Pxl.Change(, and pxl.Test(.
On a G.T split screen, the maximum value for row is 50 and the
maximum value for column is 46 for Pxl.On(, Pxl.Off(,
Pxl.Change(, and pxl.Test(.
Drawing Pixels
TI-82 STATS
Pixels
Turning On and
Off Pixels with
Pxl.On( and
Pxl.Off(
Using pxl.Test(
Split Screen
DRAW Instructions 817
82CA5D~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:27 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:36
PM Page 17 of 20
To display the DRAW STO menu, press y [DRAW] |. When
you select an instruction from the DRAW STO menu, the
TI-82 STATS returns to the home screen or the program editor.
The picture and graph database instructions are not interactive.
DRAW POINTS STO
1: StorePic Stores the current picture.
2: RecallPic Recalls a saved picture.
3: StoreGDB Stores the current graph database.
4: RecallGDB Recalls a saved graph database.
You can store up to 10 graph pictures, each of which is an
image of the current graph display, in picture variables Pic1
through Pic9, or Pic0. Later, you can superimpose the stored
picture onto a displayed graph from the home screen or a
program.
A picture includes drawn elements, plotted functions, axes, and
tick marks. The picture does not include axes labels, lower and
upper bound indicators, prompts, or cursor coordinates. Any
parts of the display hidden by these items are stored with the
picture.
To store a graph picture, follow these steps.
1. Select 1:StorePic from the DRAW STO menu. StorePic is
pasted to the current cursor location.
2. Enter the number (from 1 to 9, or 0) of the picture variable to
which you want to store the picture. For example, if you
enter 3, the TI-82 STATS will store the picture to Pic3.
Note: You also can select a variable from the PICTURE
secondary menu ( 4). The variable is pasted next to
StorePic.
3. Press to display the current graph and store the
picture.
Storing Graph Pictures (Pics)
DRAW STO Menu
Storing a Graph
Picture
818 DRAW Instructions
82CA5D~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:27 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:36
PM Page 18 of 20
To recall a graph picture, follow these steps.
1. Select 2:RecallPic from the DRAW STO menu. RecallPic is
pasted to the current cursor location.
2. Enter the number (from 1 to 9, or 0) of the picture variable
from which you want to recall a picture. For example, if you
enter 3, the TI-82 STATS will recall the picture stored to
Pic3.
Note: You also can select a variable from the PICTURE
secondary menu ( 4). The variable is pasted next to
RecallPic.
3. Press to display the current graph with the picture
superimposed on it.
Note: Pictures are drawings. You cannot trace a curve that is part of a
picture.
To delete graph pictures from memory, use the
MEMORY DELETE FROM menu (Chapter 18).
Recalling Graph Pictures (Pics)
Recalling a
Graph Picture
Deleting a Graph
Picture
DRAW Instructions 819
82CA5D~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:27 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:36
PM Page 19 of 20
A graph database (GDB) contains the set of elements that
defines a particular graph. You can recreate the graph from
these elements. You can store up to 10 GDBs in variables GDB1
through GDB9, or GDB0 and recall them to recreate graphs.
A GDB stores five elements of a graph.
Graphing mode
Window variables
Format settings
All functions in the Y= editor and the selection status of each
Graph style for each Y= function
GDBs do not contain drawn items or stat plot definitions.
To store a graph database, follow these steps.
1. Select 3:StoreGDB from the DRAW STO menu. StoreGDB is
pasted to the current cursor location.
2. Enter the number (from 1 to 9, or 0) of the GDB variable to
which you want to store the graph database. For example, if
you enter 7, the TI-82 STATS will store the GDB to GDB7.
Note: You also can select a variable from the GDB secondary
menu ( 3). The variable is pasted next to StoreGDB.
3. Press to store the current database to the specified
GDB variable.
Storing Graph Databases (GDBs)
What Is a Graph
Database?
Storing a Graph
Database
820 DRAW Instructions
82CA5D~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:27 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:36
PM Page 20 of 20
CAUTION: When you recall a GDB, it replaces all existing Y=
functions. Consider storing the current Y= functions to another
database before recalling a stored GDB.
To recall a graph database, follow these steps.
1. Select 4:RecallGDB from the DRAW STO menu. RecallGDB
is pasted to the current cursor location.
2. Enter the number (from 1 to 9, or 0) of the GDB variable
from which you want to recall a GDB. For example, if you
enter 7, the TI-82 STATS will recall the GDB stored to
GDB7.
Note: You also can select a variable from the GDB secondary
menu ( 3). The variable is pasted next to RecallGDB.
3. Press to replace the current GDB with the recalled
GDB. The new graph is not plotted. The TI-82 STATS
changes the graphing mode automatically, if necessary.
To delete a GDB from memory, use the MEMORY DELETE
FROM menu (Chapter 18).
Recalling Graph Databases (GDBs)
Recalling a
Graph Database
Deleting a Graph
Database
Split Screen 91
8253D2~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 9:26 AM Printed: 10/28/05 9:26
AM Page 1 of 6
9
Split
Screen
Getting Started: Exploring the Unit Circle............................................. 2
Using Split Screen.................................................................................................. 3
Horiz (Horizontal) Split Screen..................................................................... 4
G.T (Graph-Table) Split Screen.................................................................... 5
TI-82 STATS Pixels in Horiz and G.T Mode...................................... 6
Contents
92 Split Screen
8253D2~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 9:26 AM Printed: 10/28/05 9:26
AM Page 2 of 6
Getting Started is a fast-paced introduction. Read the chapter for details.
Use G.T (graph-table) split-screen mode to explore the unit circle and its relationship
to the numeric values for the commonly used trigonometric angles of 0, 30, 45,
60, 90, and so on.
1. Press z to display the mode screen. Press
~ to select Degree mode. Press
~ to select Par (parametric)
graphing mode.
Press ~ ~to select G.T
(graph-table) split-screen mode.
2. Press y [FORMAT] to display the format
screen. Press ~to
select ExprOff.
3. Press o to display the Y= editor for Par
graphing mode. Press
to store cos(T) to X1T. Press
to store sin(T) to Y1T.
4. Press p to display the window editor.
Enter these values for the window variables.
Tmin=0 Xmin=L2.3 Ymin=L2.5
Tmax=360 Xmax=2.3 Ymax=2.5
Tstep=15 Xscl=1 Yscl=1
5. Press r. On the left, the unit circle is
graphed parametrically in Degree mode and
the trace cursor is activated. When T=0 (from
the graph trace coordinates), you can see from
the table on the right that the value of X1T
(cos(T)) is 1 and Y1T (sin(T)) is 0. Press ~to
move the cursor to the next 15 angle
increment. As you trace around the circle in
steps of 15, an approximation of the standard
value for each angle is highlighted in the
table.
Getting Started: Exploring the Unit Circle
Split Screen 93
8253D2~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 9:26 AM Printed: 10/28/05 9:26
AM Page 3 of 6
To set a split-screen mode, press z, and then move the
cursor to the bottom line of the mode screen.
Select Horiz (horizontal) to display the graph screen and
another screen split horizontally.
Select G.T (graph-table) to display the graph screen and
table screen split vertically.
$ $
The split screen is activated when you press any key that applies
to either half of the split screen.
Some screens are never displayed as split screens. For example,
if you press z in Horiz or G.T mode, the mode screen is
displayed as a full screen. If you then press a key that displays
either half of a split screen, such as r, the split screen
returns.
When you press a key or key combination in either Horiz or G.T
mode, the cursor is placed in the half of the display for which
that key applies. For example, if you press r, the cursor is
placed in the half in which the graph is displayed. If you press
y [TABLE], the cursor is placed in the half in which the table is
displayed.
The TI-82 STATS will remain in split-screen mode until you
change back to Full screen mode.
Using Split Screen
Setting a Split-
Screen Mode
94 Split Screen
8253D2~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 9:26 AM Printed: 10/28/05 9:26
AM Page 4 of 6
In Horiz (horizontal) split-screen mode, a horizontal line splits
the screen into top and bottom halves.
The top half displays the graph.
The bottom half displays any of these editors.
Home screen (four lines)
Y= editor (four lines)
Stat list editor (two rows)
Window editor (three settings)
Table editor (two rows)
To use the top half of the split screen:
Press s or r.
Select a ZOOM or CALC operation.
To use the bottom half of the split screen:
Press any key or key combination that displays the home
screen.
Press o (Y= editor).
Press (stat list editor).
Press p (window editor).
Press y [TABLE] (table editor).
All other screens are displayed as full screens in Horiz
split-screen mode.
To return to the Horiz split screen from a full screen when in
Horiz mode, press any key or key combination that displays the
graph, home screen, Y= editor, stat list editor, window editor, or
table editor.
Horiz (Horizontal) Split Screen
Horiz Mode
Moving from Half
to Half in Horiz
Mode
Full Screens in
Horiz Mode
Split Screen 95
8253D2~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 9:26 AM Printed: 10/28/05 9:26
AM Page 5 of 6
In G.T (graph-table) split-screen mode, a vertical line splits the
screen into left and right halves.
The left half displays the graph.
The right half displays the table.
To use the left half of the split screen:
Press s or r.
Select a ZOOM or CALC operation.
To use the right half of the split screen, press y [TABLE].
As you move the trace cursor along a graph in the split screens
left half in G.T mode, the table on the right half automatically
scrolls to match the current cursor values.
Note: When you trace in Par graphing mode, both components of an
equation (XnT and YnT) are displayed in the two columns of the table.
As you trace, the current value of the independent variable T is
displayed on the graph.
All screens other than the graph and the table are displayed as
full screens in G.T split-screen mode.
To return to the G.T split screen from a full screen when in G.T
mode, press any key or key combination that displays the graph
or the table.
G.T (Graph-Table) Split Screen
G.T Mode
Moving from Half
to Half in G.T
Mode
Using r rr r in
G.T Mode
Full Screens in
G.T Mode
96 Split Screen
8253D2~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 9:26 AM Printed: 10/28/05 9:26
AM Page 6 of 6
Note: Each set of numbers in parentheses above represents the row
and column of a corner pixel, which is turned on.
For Pxl.On(, Pxl.Off(, Pxl.Change(, and pxl.Test(:
In Horiz mode, row must be {30; column must be {94.
In G.T mode, row must be {50; column must be {46.
Pxl.On(row,column)
For the Text( instruction:
In Horiz mode, row must be {25; column must be {94.
In G.T mode, row must be {45; column must be {46.
Text(row,column,"text")
For the Output( instruction:
In Horiz mode, row must be {4; column must be {16.
In G.T mode, row must be {8; column must be {16.
Output(row,column,"text")
To set Horiz or G.T from a program, follow these steps.
1. Press z while the cursor is on a blank line in the program
editor.
2. Select Horiz or G.T.
The instruction is pasted to the cursor location. The mode is set
when the instruction is encountered during program execution.
It remains in effect after execution.
Note: You also can paste Horiz or G.T to the home screen or
program editor from the CATALOG (Chapter 15).
TI-82 STATS Pixels in Horiz and G.T Modes
TI-82 STATS
Pixels in Horiz
and G.T Modes
DRAW POINTS
Menu Pixel
Instructions
DRAW Menu
Text( Instruction
PRGM I/O Menu
Output(
Instruction
Setting a
Split-Screen
Mode from the
Home Screen or
a Program
Matrices 101
82EA17~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:31 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:47
PM Page 1 of 16
10
Matrices
Getting Started: Systems of Linear Equations ..................................... 2
Defining a Matrix................................................................................................... 2
Viewing and Editing Matrix Elements...................................................... 4
Using Matrices with Expressions................................................................. 7
Displaying and Copying Matrices................................................................ 8
Using Math Functions with Matrices......................................................... 9
Using the MATRX MATH Operations ....................................................... 12
Contents
102 Matrices
82EA17~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:31 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:47
PM Page 2 of 16
Getting Started is a fast-paced introduction. Read the chapter for details.
Find the solution of X + 2Y + 3Z = 3 and 2X + 3Y + 4Z = 3. On the TI-82 STATS,
you can solve a system of linear equations by entering the coefficients as elements in
a matrix, and then using rref( to obtain the reduced row-echelon form.
1. Press . Press ~ ~to display the
MATRX EDIT menu. Press 1 to select 1: [A]
2. Press 2 4 to define a 24 matrix.
The rectangular cursor indicates the current
element. Ellipses (...) indicate additional
columns beyond the screen.
3. Press 1 to enter the first element. The
rectangular cursor moves to the second column
of the first row.
4. Press 2 3 3 to complete
the first row for X + 2Y + 3Z = 3.
5. Press 2 3 4 3 to
enter the second row for 2X + 3Y + 4Z = 3.
6. Press y [QUIT] to return to the home screen.
If necessary, press to clear the home
screen. Press ~to display the MATRX
MATH menu. Press } to wrap to the end of the
menu. Select B:rref( to copy rref( to the home
screen.
7. Press 1 to select 1: [A] from the
MATRX NAMES menu. Press . The
reduced row-echelon form of the matrix is
displayed and stored in Ans.
1X N 1Z = L3 so X = L3 + Z
1Y + 2Z = 3 so Y = 3 N 2Z
Getting Started: Systems of Linear Equations
Matrices 103
82EA17~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:31 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:47
PM Page 3 of 16
A matrix is a two-dimensional array. You can display, define, or
edit a matrix in the matrix editor. The TI-82 STATS has 10
matrix variables, [A] through [J]. You can define a matrix
directly in an expression. A matrix, depending on available
memory, may have up to 99 rows or columns. You can store
only real numbers in TI-82 STATS matrices.
Before you can define or display a matrix in the editor, you first
must select the matrix name. To do so, follow these steps.
1. Press | to display the MATRX EDIT menu. The
dimensions of any previously defined matrices are displayed.
2. Select the matrix you want to define. The MATRX EDIT
screen is displayed.
The dimensions of the matrix (row column) are displayed on
the top line. The dimensions of a new matrix are 1 1. You must
accept or change the dimensions each time you edit a matrix.
When you select a matrix to define, the cursor highlights the
row dimension.
To accept the row dimension, press .
To change the row dimension, enter the number of rows (up
to 99), and then press .
The cursor moves to the column dimension, which you must
accept or change the same way you accepted or changed the row
dimension. When you press , the rectangular cursor
moves to the first matrix element.
Defining a Matrix
What Is a Matrix?
Selecting a
Matrix
Accepting or
Changing Matrix
Dimensions
104 Matrices
82EA17~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:31 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:47
PM Page 4 of 16
After you have set the dimensions of the matrix, you can view
the matrix and enter values for the matrix elements. In a new
matrix, all values are zero.
Select the matrix from the MATRX EDIT menu and enter or
accept the dimensions. The center portion of the matrix editor
displays up to seven rows and three columns of a matrix,
showing the values of the elements in abbreviated form if
necessary. The full value of the current element, which is
indicated by the rectangular cursor, is displayed on the bottom
line.
This is an 8 4 matrix. Ellipses in the left or right column
indicate additional columns. # or $ in the right column indicate
additional rows.
To delete matrices from memory, use the MEMORY DELETE
FROM secondary menu (Chapter 18).
Viewing and Editing Matrix Elements
Displaying Matrix
Elements
Deleting a Matrix
Matrices 105
82EA17~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:31 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:47
PM Page 5 of 16
The matrix editor has two contexts, viewing and editing. In
viewing context, you can use the cursor keys to move quickly
from one matrix element to the next. The full value of the
highlighted element is displayed on the bottom line.
Select the matrix from the MATRX EDIT menu, and then enter or
accept the dimensions.
Key Function
| or ~ Moves the rectangular cursor within the
current row.
or } Moves the rectangular cursor within the
current column; on the top row, }moves the
cursor to the column dimension; on the column
dimension, }moves the cursor to the row
dimension.
Switches to editing context; activates the edit
cursor on the bottom line.
Switches to editing context; clears the value on
the bottom line.
Any entry
character
Switches to editing context; clears the value on
the bottom line; copies the character to the
bottom line.
y [INS] Nothing
{ Nothing
Viewing a Matrix
Viewing-Context
Keys
106 Matrices
82EA17~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:31 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:47
PM Page 6 of 16
In editing context, an edit cursor is active on the bottom line. To
edit a matrix element value, follow these steps.
1. Select the matrix from the MATRX EDIT menu, and then
enter or accept the dimensions.
2. Press |, }, ~, and to move the cursor to the matrix
element you want to change.
3. Switch to editing context by pressing , , or an
entry key.
4. Change the value of the matrix element using the editing-
context keys described below. You may enter an expression,
which is evaluated when you leave editing context.
Note: You can press to restore the value at the
rectangular cursor if you make a mistake.
5. Press , }, or to move to another element.
Key Function
| or ~ Moves the edit cursor within the value.
or } Stores the value displayed on the bottom line to
the matrix element; switches to viewing
context and moves the rectangular cursor
within the column.
Stores the value displayed on the bottom line to
the matrix element; switches to viewing
context and moves the rectangular cursor to the
next row element.
Clears the value on the bottom line.
Any entry
character
Copies the character to the location of the edit
cursor on the bottom line.
y [INS] Activates the insert cursor.
{ Deletes the character under the edit cursor on
the bottom line.
Viewing and Editing Matrix Elements (continued)
Editing a Matrix
Element
Editing-Context
Keys
Matrices 107
82EA17~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:31 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:47
PM Page 7 of 16
To use a matrix in an expression, you can do any of the
following.
Copy the name from the MATRX NAMES menu.
Recall the contents of the matrix into the expression with
y [RCL] (Chapter 1).
Enter the matrix directly (see below).
You can enter, edit, and store a matrix in the matrix editor. You
also can enter a matrix directly in an expression.
To enter a matrix in an expression, follow these steps.
1. Press y [ [ ] to indicate the beginning of the matrix.
2. Press y [ [ ] to indicate the beginning of a row.
3. Enter a value, which can be an expression, for each element
in the row. Separate the values with commas.
4. Press y [ ] ] to indicate the end of a row.
5. Repeat steps 2 through 4 to enter all of the rows.
6. Press y [ ] ] to indicate the end of the matrix.
Note: The closing ]] are not necessary at the end of an
expression or preceding ! !! !.
The resulting matrix is displayed in the form:
[[element
1,1
,...,element
1,n
],...,[element
m,1
,...,element
m,n
]]
Any expressions are evaluated when the entry is executed.
Note: The commas that you must enter to separate elements are
not displayed on output.
Using Matrices with Expressions
Using a Matrix in
an Expression
Entering a Matrix
in an Expression
108 Matrices
82EA17~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:31 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:47
PM Page 8 of 16
To display the contents of a matrix on the home screen, select
the matrix from the MATRX NAMES menu, and then press
.
Ellipses in the left or right column indicate additional columns.
# or $ in the right column indicate additional rows. Press ~, |,
, and } to scroll the matrix.
To copy a matrix, follow these steps.
1. Press to display the MATRX NAMES menu.
2. Select the name of the matrix you want to copy.
3. Press .
4. Press again and select the name of the new matrix to
which you want to copy the existing matrix.
5. Press to copy the matrix to the new matrix name.
On the home screen or from within a program, you can store a
value to, or recall a value from, a matrix element. The element
must be within the currently defined matrix dimensions. Select
matrix from the MATRX NAMES menu.
[matrix](row,column)
Displaying and Copying Matrices
Displaying a
Matrix
Copying One
Matrix to Another
Accessing a
Matrix Element
Matrices 109
82EA17~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:31 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:47
PM Page 9 of 16
You can use many of the math functions on the TI-82 STATS
keyboard, the MATH menu, the MATH NUM menu, and the MATH
TEST menu with matrices. However, the dimensions must be
appropriate. Each of the functions below creates a new matrix; the
original matrix remains the same.
To add () or subtract () matrices, the dimensions must be
the same. The answer is a matrix in which the elements are the
sum or difference of the individual corresponding elements.
matrixA+matrixB
matrixANmatrixB
To multiply () two matrices together, the column dimension
of matrixA must match the row dimension of matrixB.
matrixA matrixB
Multiplying a matrix by a value or a value by a matrix returns a
matrix in which each element of matrix is multiplied by value.
matrix value
value matrix
Negating a matrix () returns a matrix in which the sign of
every element is changed (reversed).
Lmatrix
Using Math Functions with Matrices
Using Math
Functions with
Matrices
+ (Add),
(Subtract),
(Multiply)
L (Negation)
1010 Matrices
82EA17~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:31 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:47
PM Page 10 of 16
abs( (absolute value, MATH NUM menu) returns a matrix
containing the absolute value of each element of matrix.
abs(matrix)
round( (MATH NUM menu) returns a matrix. It rounds every
element in matrix to #decimals ( 9). If #decimals is omitted,
the elements are rounded to 10 digits.
round(matrix[,#decimals])
Use the
L1
function () to invert a matrix (^L1 is not valid).
matrix must be square. The determinant cannot equal zero.
matrix
L1
To raise a matrix to a power, matrix must be square. You can
use
2
(),
3
(MATH menu), or ^power () for integer power
between 0 and 255.
matrix
2
matrix
3
matrix^power
Using Math Functions with Matrices (continued)
abs(
round(
M1
(Inverse)
Powers
Matrices 1011
82EA17~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:31 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:47
PM Page 11 of 16
To compare two matrices using the relational operations = and
(TEST menu), they must have the same dimensions. = and
compare matrixA and matrixB on an element-by-element basis.
The other relational operations are not valid with matrices.
matrixA=matrixB returns 1 if every comparison is true; it returns
0 if any comparison is false.
matrixAmatrixB returns 1 if at least one comparison is false; it
returns 0 if no comparison is false.
iPart( (integer part), fPart( (fractional part), and int( (greatest
integer) are on the MATH NUM menu.
iPart( returns a matrix containing the integer part of each
element of matrix.
fPart( returns a matrix containing the fractional part of each
element of matrix.
int( returns a matrix containing the greatest integer of each
element of matrix.
iPart(matrix)
fPart(matrix)
int(matrix)
Relational
Operations
iPart(, fPart(, int(
1012 Matrices
82EA17~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:31 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:47
PM Page 12 of 16
To display the MATRX MATH menu, press ~.
NAMES MAT
H
EDIT
1: det( Calculates the determinant.
2:
T
Transposes the matrix.
3: dim( Returns the matrix dimensions.
4: Fill( Fills all elements with a constant.
5: identity( Returns the identity matrix.
6: randM( Returns a random matrix.
7: augment( Appends two matrices.
8: Matr4list( Stores a matrix to a list.
9: List4matr( Stores a list to a matrix.
0: cumSum( Returns the cumulative sums of a matrix.
A: ref( Returns the row-echelon form of a matrix.
B: rref( Returns the reduced row-echelon form.
C: rowSwap( Swaps two rows of a matrix.
D: row+( Adds two rows; stores in the second row.
E: row( Multiplies the row by a number.
F: row+( Multiplies the row, adds to the second row.
det( (determinant) returns the determinant (a real number) of a
square matrix.
det(matrix)
T
(transpose) returns a matrix in which each element (row,
column) is swapped with the corresponding element (column,
row) of matrix.
matrix
T
dim( (dimension) returns a list containing the dimensions
({rows columns}) of matrix.
dim(matrix)
Note: dim(matrix)! !! !Ln:Ln(1) returns the number of rows.
dim(matrix)! !! !Ln:Ln(2) returns the number of columns.
Using the MATRX MATH Operations
MATRX MATH
Menu
det(
T
(Transpose)
Accessing Matrix
Dimensions with
dim(
Matrices 1013
82EA17~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:31 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:47
PM Page 13 of 16
Use dim( with to create a new matrixname of dimensions
rows columns with 0 as each element.
{rows,columns}! !! !dim(matrixname)
Use dim( with to redimension an existing matrixname to
dimensions rows columns. The elements in the old
matrixname that are within the new dimensions are not changed.
Additional created elements are zeros. Matrix elements that are
outside the new dimensions are deleted.
{rows,columns}! !! !dim(matrixname)
Fill( stores value to every element in matrixname.
Fill(value,matrixname)
identity( returns the identity matrix of dimension rows
dimension columns.
identity(dimension)
randM( (create random matrix) returns a rows columns
random matrix of integers
L
9 and 9. The seed value stored to
the rand function controls the values (Chapter 2).
randM(rows,columns)
Creating a Matrix
with dim(
Redimensioning a
Matrix with dim(
Fill(
identity(
randM(
1014 Matrices
82EA17~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:31 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:47
PM Page 14 of 16
augment( appends matrixA to matrixB as new columns. matrixA
and matrixB both must have the same number of rows.
augment(matrixA,matrixB)
Matr4list( (matrix stored to list) fills each listname with elements
from each column in matrix. Matr4list( ignores extra listname
arguments. Likewise, Matr4list( ignores extra matrix columns.
Matr4list(matrix,listnameA,...,listname n)
&
Matr4list( also fills a listname with elements from a specified
column# in matrix. To fill a list with a specific column from matrix,
you must enter column# after matrix.
Matr4list(matrix,column#,listname)
&
List4matr( (lists stored to matrix) fills matrixname column by
column with the elements from each list. If dimensions of all lists
are not equal, List4matr( fills each extra matrixname row with 0.
Complex lists are not valid.
List4matr(listA,...,list n,matrixname)
&
Using the MATRX MATH Operations (continued)
augment(
Matr4list(
List4matr(
Matrices 1015
82EA17~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:31 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:47
PM Page 15 of 16
cumSum( returns cumulative sums of the elements in matrix,
starting with the first element. Each element is the cumulative
sum of the column from top to bottom.
cumSum(matrix)
MATRX MATH menu items A through F are row operations. You
can use a row operation in an expression. Row operations do not
change matrix in memory. You can enter all row numbers and
values as expressions. You can select the matrix from the
MATRX NAMES menu.
ref( (row-echelon form) returns the row-echelon form of a real
matrix. The number of columns must be greater than or equal to
the number of rows.
ref(matrix)
rref( (reduced row-echelon form) returns the reduced row-echelon
form of a real matrix. The number of columns must be greater than
or equal to the number of rows.
rref(matrix)
cumSum(
Row Operations
ref(, rref(
1016 Matrices
82EA17~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:31 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:47
PM Page 16 of 16
rowSwap( returns a matrix. It swaps rowA and rowB of matrix.
rowSwap(matrix,rowA,rowB)
row+( (row addition) returns a matrix. It adds rowA and rowB of
matrix and stores the results in rowB.
row+(matrix,rowA,rowB)
row( (row multiplication) returns a matrix. It multiplies row of
matrix by value and stores the results in row.
row(value,matrix,row)
row+( (row multiplication and addition) returns a matrix. It
multiplies rowA of matrix by value, adds it to rowB, and stores
the results in rowB.
row+(value,matrix,rowA,rowB)
Using the MATRX MATH Operations (continued)
rowSwap(
row+(
row(
row+(
Lists 111
826886~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:33 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:50
PM Page 1 of 18
11
Lists
Getting Started: Generating a Sequence .................................................. 2
Naming Lists.............................................................................................................. 3
Storing and Displaying Lists........................................................................... 4
Entering List Names ............................................................................................. 6
Attaching Formulas to List Names.............................................................. 7
Using Lists in Expressions................................................................................ 9
LIST OPS Menu...................................................................................................... 10
LIST MATH Menu.................................................................................................. 17
Contents
112 Lists
826886~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:33 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:50
PM Page 2 of 18
Getting Started is a fast-paced introduction. Read the chapter for details.
Calculate the first eight terms of the sequence 1/A
2
. Store the results to a user-created
list. Then display the results in fraction form. Begin this example on a blank line on
the home screen.
1. Press y [LIST] ~ to display the LIST OPS
menu.
2. Press 5 to select 5:seq(, which pastes seq( to
the current cursor location.
3. Press 1 [A] [A] 1
8 1 to enter the sequence.
4. Press , and then press yto turn
on alpha-lock. Press [S] [E] [Q], and then press
to turn off alpha-lock. Press 1 to
complete the list name.
5. Press to generate the list and store it in
SEQ1. The list is displayed on the home screen.
An ellipsis (...) indicates that the list continues
beyond the viewing window. Press ~
repeatedly (or press and hold ~) to scroll the
list and view all the list elements.
6. Press y [LIST] to display the LIST NAMES
menu. Press to paste SEQ1 to the
current cursor location. (If SEQ1 is not item 1
on your LIST NAMES menu, move the cursor to
SEQ1 before you press .)
7. Press to display the MATH menu. Press 1
to select 1:4Frac, which pastes 4Frac to the
current cursor location.
8. Press to show the sequence in fraction
form. Press ~ repeatedly (or press and hold ~)
to scroll the list and view all the list elements.
Getting Started: Generating a Sequence
Lists 113
826886~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:33 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:50
PM Page 3 of 18
The TI-82 STATS has six list names in memory: L1, L2, L3, L4,
L5, and L6. The list names L1 through L6 are on the keyboard
above the numeric keys through . To paste one of these
names to a valid screen, press y, and then press the
appropriate key. L1 through L6 are stored in stat list editor
columns 1 through 6 when you reset memory.
To create a list name on the home screen, follow these steps.
1. Press y [ { ], enter one or more list elements, and then
press y [ } ]. Separate list elements with commas. List
elements can be real numbers, complex numbers, or
expressions.
2. Press .
3. Press [letter from A to Z or q] to enter the first letter
of the name.
4. Enter zero to four letters, q, or numbers to complete the
name.
5. Press . The list is displayed on the next line. The list
name and its elements are stored in memory. The list name
becomes an item on the LIST NAMES menu.
Note: If you want to view a user-created list in the stat list editor,
you must store it in the stat list editor (Chapter 12).
You also can create a list name in these four places.
At the Name= prompt in the stat list editor
At an Xlist:, Ylist:, or Data List: prompt in the stat plot editor
At a List:, List1:, List2:, Freq:, Freq1:, Freq2:, XList:, or
YList: prompt in the inferential stat editors
On the home screen using SetUpEditor
You can create as many list names as your TI-82 STATS
memory has space to store.
Naming Lists
Using
TI-82 STATS List
Names L1
through L6
Creating a List
Name on the
Home Screen
114 Lists
826886~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:33 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:50
PM Page 4 of 18
You can store list elements in either of two ways.
Use braces and on the home screen.
Use the stat list editor (Chapter 12).
The maximum dimension of a list is 999 elements.
Tip: When you store a complex number to a list, the entire list is
converted to a list of complex numbers. To convert the list to a list of
real numbers, display the home screen, and then enter
real(listname)! !! !listname.
To display the elements of a list on the home screen, enter the
name of the list (preceded by if necessary; see page 11.16),
and then press . An ellipsis indicates that the list
continues beyond the viewing window. Press ~ repeatedly (or
press and hold ~) to scroll the list and view all the list
elements.
Storing and Displaying Lists
Storing Elements
to a List
Displaying a List
on the Home
Screen
Lists 115
826886~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:33 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:50
PM Page 5 of 18
To copy a list, store it to another list.
You can store a value to or recall a value from a specific list
element. You can store to any element within the current list
dimension or one element beyond.
listname(element)
To delete lists from memory, including L1 through L6, use the
MEMORY DELETE FROM secondary menu (Chapter 18).
Resetting memory restores L1 through L6. Removing a list from
the stat list editor does not delete it from memory.
You can use lists to graph a family of curves (Chapter 3).
Copying One List
to Another
Accessing a List
Element
Deleting a List
from Memory
Using Lists in
Graphing
116 Lists
826886~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:33 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:50
PM Page 6 of 18
To display the LIST NAMES menu, press y [LIST]. Each item is
a user-created list name. LIST NAMES menu items are sorted
automatically in alphanumerical order. Only the first 10 items are
labeled, using 1 through 9, then 0. To jump to the first list name
that begins with a particular alpha character or q, press
[letter from A to Z or q].
Tip: From the top of a menu, press } to move to the bottom. From
the bottom, press to move to the top.
Note: The LIST NAMES menu omits list names L1 through L6. Enter
L1 through L6 directly from the keyboard (page 11.3).
When you select a list name from the LIST NAMES menu, the
list name is pasted to the current cursor location.
The list name symbol precedes a list name when the name
is pasted where non-list name data also is valid, such as the
home screen.
The symbol does not precede a list name when the name is
pasted where a list name is the only valid input, such as the
stat list editors Name= prompt or the stat plot editors XList:
and YList: prompts.
To enter an existing list name directly, follow these steps.
1. Press y [LIST] ~ to display the LIST OPS menu.
2. Select B: , which pastes to the current cursor location. is
not always necessary (page 11.16).
Note: You also can paste to the
current cursor location from the
CATALOG (Chapter 15).
3. Enter the characters that comprise the list name.
Entering List Names
Using the
LIST NAMES
Menu
Entering a User-
Created List
Name Directly
Lists 117
826886~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:33 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:50
PM Page 7 of 18
You can attach a formula to a list name so that each list element
is a result of the formula. When executed, the attached formula
must resolve to a list.
When anything in the attached formula changes, the list to
which the formula is attached is updated automatically.
When you edit an element of a list that is referenced in the
formula, the corresponding element in the list to which the
formula is attached is updated.
When you edit the formula itself, all elements in the list to
which the formula is attached are updated.
For example, the first screen below shows that elements are
stored to L3, and the formula L3+10 is attached to the list name
ADD10. The quotation marks designate the formula to be
attached to ADD10. Each element of ADD10 is the sum of an
element in L3 and 10.
The next screen shows another list, L4. The elements of L4 are
the sum of the same formula that is attached to L3. However,
quotation marks are not entered, so the formula is not attached
to L4.
On the next line, L6! !! !L3(1):L3 changes the first element in L3 to
L6, and then redisplays L3.
The last screen shows that editing L3 updated ADD10, but did
not change L4. This is because the formula L3+10 is attached to
ADD10, but it is not attached to L4.
Note: To view a formula that is attached to a list name, use the stat
list editor (Chapter 12).
Attaching Formulas to List Names
Attaching a
Formula to a List
Name
118 Lists
826886~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:33 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:50
PM Page 8 of 18
To attach a formula to a list name from a blank line on the home
screen or from a program, follow these steps.
1. Press [], enter the formula (which must resolve to a
list), and press [] again.
Note: When you include more than one list name in a formula,
each list must have the same dimension.
2. Press .
3. Enter the name of the list to which you want to attach the
formula.
Press y, and then enter a TI-82 STATS list name L1
through L6.
Press y [LIST] and select a user.created list name from
the LIST NAMES menu.
Enter a user.created list name directly using (page
11.16).
4. Press .
Note: The stat list editor displays a formula-lock symbol next to
each list name that has an attached formula. Chapter 12
describes how to use the stat list editor to attach formulas to lists,
edit attached formulas, and detach formulas from lists.
You can detach (clear) an attached formula from a list in any of
three ways.
Enter ""! !! !listname on the home screen.
Edit any element of a list to which a formula is attached.
Use the stat list editor (Chapter 12).
Note: You also can use ClrList or ClrAllList to detach a formula
from a list (Chapter 18).
Attaching Formulas to List Names (continued)
Attaching a
Formula to a List
on the Home
Screen or in a
Program
Detaching a
Formula from a
List
Lists 119
826886~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:33 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:50
PM Page 9 of 18
You can use lists in an expression in any of three ways. When
you press , any expression is evaluated for each list
element, and a list is displayed.
Use L1L6 or any user-created list name in an expression.
Enter the list elements directly (step 1 on page 11.3).
Use y [RCL] to recall the contents of the list into an
expression at the cursor location (Chapter 1).
&
Note: You must paste user-created list names to the Rcl prompt by
selecting them from the LIST NAMES menu. You cannot enter them
directly using .
You can use a list to input several values for some math
functions. Other chapters and Appendix A specify whether a list
is valid. The function is evaluated for each list element, and a
list is displayed.
When you use a list with a function, the function must be
valid for every element in the list. In graphing, an invalid
element, such as L1 in ({1,0,L1}), is ignored.
This returns an error.
This graphs X (1) and X (0),
but skips X (L1).
When you use two lists with a two-argument function, the
dimension of each list must be the same. The function is
evaluated for corresponding elements.
When you use a list and a value with a two-argument
function, the value is used with each element in the list.
Using Lists in Expressions
Using a List in an
Expression
Using Lists with
Math Functions
1110 Lists
826886~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:33 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:50
PM Page 10 of 18
To display the LIST OPS menu, press y [LIST] ~.
NAMESOPS MATH
1: SortA( Sorts lists in ascending order.
2: SortD( Sorts lists in descending order.
3: dim( Sets the list dimension.
4: Fill( Fills all elements with a constant.
5: seq( Creates a sequence.
6: cumSum( Returns a list of cumulative sums.
7: @List( Returns difference of successive elements.
8: Select( Selects specific data points.
9: augment( Concatenates two lists.
0: List4matr( Stores a list to a matrix.
A: Matr4list( Stores a matrix to a list.
B: Designates the list-name data type.
SortA( (sort ascending) sorts list elements from low to high
values. SortD( (sort descending) sorts list elements from high to
low values. Complex lists are sorted based on magnitude
(modulus).
With one list, SortA( and SortD( sort the elements of listname
and update the list in memory.
SortA(listname) SortD(listname)
With two or more lists, SortA( and SortD( sort keylistname, and
then sort each dependlist by placing its elements in the same
order as the corresponding elements in keylistname. All lists
must have the same dimension.
SortA(keylistname,dependlist1[,dependlist2,...,dependlist n])
SortD(keylistname,dependlist1[,dependlist2,...,dependlist n])
Note: In the example, 5 is the first element in L4, and 1 is the first
element in L5. After SortA(L4,L5), 5 becomes the second element of
L4, and likewise, 1 becomes the second element of L5.
Note: SortA( and SortD( are the same as SortA( and SortD( on the
STAT EDIT menu (Chapter 12).
LIST OPS Menu
LIST OPS Menu
SortA(, SortD(
Lists 1111
826886~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:33 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:50
PM Page 11 of 18
dim( (dimension) returns the length (number of elements) of list.
dim(list)
You can use dim( with to create a new listname with
dimension length from 1 to 999. The elements are zeros.
length! !! !dim(listname)
You can use dim with to redimension an existing listname
to dimension length from 1 to 999.
The elements in the old listname that are within the new
dimension are not changed.
Extra list elements are filled by 0.
Elements in the old list that are outside the new dimension
are deleted.
length! !! !dim(listname)
Fill( replaces each element in listname with value.
Fill(value,listname)
Note: dim( and Fill( are the same as dim( and Fill( on the MATRX
MATH menu (Chapter 10).
Using dim( to
Find List
Dimensions
Using dim( to
Create a List
Using dim( to
Redimension a
List
Fill(
1112 Lists
826886~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:33 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:50
PM Page 12 of 18
seq( (sequence) returns a list in which each element is the result
of the evaluation of expression with regard to variable for the
values ranging from begin to end at steps of increment. variable
need not be defined in memory. increment can be negative; the
default value for increment is 1. seq( is not valid within
expression.
seq(expression,variable,begin,end[,increment])
cumSum( (cumulative sum) returns the cumulative sums of the
elements in list, starting with the first element. list elements can
be real or complex numbers.
cumSum(list)
@List( returns a list containing the differences between
consecutive elements in list. @List subtracts the first element in
list from the second element, subtracts the second element from
the third, and so on. The list of differences is always one
element shorter than the original list. list elements can be a real
or complex numbers.
@List(list)
Select( selects one or more specific data points from a scatter
plot or xyLine plot (only), and then stores the selected data
points to two new lists, xlistname and ylistname. For example,
you can use Select( to select and then analyze a portion of
plotted CBL or CBR data.
Select(xlistname,ylistname)
Note: Before you use Select(, you must have selected (turned on) a
scatter plot or xyLine plot. Also, the plot must be displayed in the
current viewing window (page 11.13).
LIST OPS Menu (continued)
seq(
cumSum(
@List(
Select(
Lists 1113
826886~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:33 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:50
PM Page 13 of 18
Before using Select(, follow these steps.
1. Create two list names and enter the data.
2. Turn on a stat plot, select " "" " (scatter plot) or (xyLine), and
enter the two list names for Xlist: and Ylist: (Chapter 12).
3. Use ZoomStat to plot the data (Chapter 3).
To select data points from a scatter plot or xyLine plot, follow
these steps.
1. Press y [LIST] ~ 8 to select 8:Select( from the LIST OPS
menu. Select( is pasted to the home screen.
2. Enter xlistname, press , enter ylistname, and then press
to designate list names into which you want the selected data
to be stored.
3. Press . The graph screen is displayed with
Left Bound? in the bottom-left corner.
4. Press } or (if more than one stat plot is selected) to move
the cursor onto the stat plot from which you want to select
data points.
5. Press | and ~ to move the cursor to the stat plot data point
that you want as the left bound.
Before Using
Select(
Using Select( to
Select Data
Points from a
Plot
1114 Lists
826886~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:33 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:50
PM Page 14 of 18
6. Press . A 4 indicator on the graph screen shows the left
bound. Right Bound? is displayed in the bottom-left corner.
7. Press | or ~ to move the cursor to the stat plot point that you
want for the right bound, and then press .
The x-values and y-values of the selected points are stored in
xlistname and ylistname. A new stat plot of xlistname and
ylistname replaces the stat plot from which you selected data
points. The list names are updated in the stat plot editor.
Note: The two new lists (xlistname and ylistname) will include the
points you select as left bound and right bound. Also, left-bound
x-value right-bound x-value must be true.
LIST OPS Menu (continued)
Using Select( to
Select Data
Points from a
Plot (continued)
Lists 1115
826886~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:33 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:50
PM Page 15 of 18
augment( concatenates the elements of listA and listB. The list
elements can be real or complex numbers.
augment(listA,listB)
List4matr( (lists stored to matrix) fills matrixname column by
column with the elements from each list. If the dimensions of all
lists are not equal, then List4matr( fills each extra matrixname
row with 0. Complex lists are not valid.
List4matr(list1,list2, . . . ,list n,matrixname)
&
augment(
List4matr(
1116 Lists
826886~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:33 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:50
PM Page 16 of 18
Matr4list( (matrix stored to lists) fills each listname with
elements from each column in matrix. If the number of listname
arguments exceeds the number of columns in matrix, then
Matr4list( ignores extra listname arguments. Likewise, if the
number of columns in matrix exceeds the number of listname
arguments, then Matr4list( ignores extra matrix columns.
Matr4list(matrix,listname1,listname2, . . . ,listname n)
&
Matr4list( also fills a listname with elements from a specified
column# in matrix. To fill a list with a specific column from
matrix, you must enter a column# after matrix.
Matr4list(matrix,column#,listname)
&
preceding one to five characters identifies those characters as a
user-created listname. listname may comprise letters, q, and
numbers, but it must begin with a letter from A to Z or q.
listname
Generally, must precede a user-created list name when you
enter a user-created list name where other input is valid, for
example, on the home screen. Without the , the TI-82 STATS
may misinterpret a user-created list name as implied
multiplication of two or more characters.
need not precede a user-created list name where a list name is
the only valid input, for example, at the Name= prompt in the
stat list editor or the Xlist: and Ylist: prompts in the stat plot
editor. If you enter where it is not necessary, the TI-82 STATS
will ignore the entry.
LIST OPS Menu (continued)
Matr4list(
Lists 1117
826886~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:33 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:50
PM Page 17 of 18
To display the LIST MATH menu, press y [LIST] |.
NAMES
OPS
MAT
H
1: min( Returns minimum element of a list.
2: max( Returns maximum element of a list.
3: mean( Returns mean of a list.
4: median( Returns median of a list.
5: sum( Returns sum of elements in a list.
6: prod( Returns product of elements in list.
7: stdDev( Returns standard deviation of a list.
8: variance( Returns the variance of a list.
min( (minimum) and max( (maximum) return the smallest or
largest element of listA. If two lists are compared, it returns a list
of the smaller or larger of each pair of elements in listA and listB.
For a complex list, the element with smallest or largest magnitude
(modulus) is returned.
min(listA[,listB])
max(listA[,listB])
Note: min( and max( are the same as min( and max( on the MATH
NUM menu.
mean( returns the mean value of list. median( returns the
median value of list. The default value for freqlist is 1. Each
freqlist element counts the number of consecutive occurrences
of the corresponding element in list. Complex lists are not valid.
mean(list[,freqlist])
median(list[,freqlist])
LIST MATH Menu
LIST MATH Menu
min(, max(
mean(, median(
1118 Lists
826886~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:33 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:50
PM Page 18 of 18
sum( (summation) returns the sum of the elements in list. start
and end are optional; they specify a range of elements. list
elements can be real or complex numbers.
prod( returns the product of all elements of list. start and end
elements are optional; they specify a range of list elements. list
elements can be real or complex numbers.
sum(list[,start,end]) prod(list[,start,end])
You can combine sum( or prod( with seq( to obtain:
upper upper
G
expression(x)
expression(x)
x=lower x=lower
To evaluate G 2
(N1)
from N=1 to 4:
stdDev( returns the standard deviation of the elements in list. The
default value for freqlist is 1. Each freqlist element counts the
number of consecutive occurrences of the corresponding element in
list. Complex lists are not valid.
variance( returns the variance of the elements in list. The default
value for freqlist is 1. Each freqlist element counts the number of
consecutive occurrences of the corresponding element in list.
Complex lists are not valid.
stdDev(list[,freqlist]) variance(list[,freqlist])
LIST MATH Menu (continued)
sum(, prod(
Sums and
Products of
Numeric
Sequences
stdDev(,
variance(
Statistics 121
82D315~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:36 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:53
PM Page 1 of 38
12
Statistics
Getting Started: Pendulum Lengths and Periods................................ 2
Setting Up Statistical Analyses...................................................................... 10
Using the Stat List Editor .................................................................................. 11
Attaching Formulas to List Names.............................................................. 14
Detaching Formulas from List Names...................................................... 16
Switching Stat List Editor Contexts............................................................ 17
Stat List Editor Contexts.................................................................................... 18
STAT EDIT Menu .................................................................................................. 20
Regression Model Features.............................................................................. 22
STAT CALC Menu................................................................................................ 24
Statistical Variables............................................................................................... 29
Statistical Analysis in a Program.................................................................. 30
Statistical Plotting................................................................................................... 31
Statistical Plotting in a Program.................................................................... 37
Contents
122 Statistics
82D315~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:36 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:53
PM Page 2 of 38
Getting Started is a fast-paced introduction. Read the chapter for details.
A group of students is attempting to determine the mathematical relationship between
the length of a pendulum and its period (one complete swing of a pendulum). The
group makes a simple pendulum from string and washers and then suspends it from
the ceiling. They record the pendulums period for each of 12 string lengths.*
Length (cm) Time (sec)
6.5 0.51
11.0 0.68
13.2 0.73
15.0 0.79
18.0 0.88
23.1 0.99
24.4 1.01
26.6 1.08
30.5 1.13
34.3 1.26
37.6 1.28
41.5 1.32
1. Press z to set Func
graphing mode.
2. Press 5 to select 5:SetUpEditor.
SetUpEditor is pasted to the home screen.
Press . This removes lists from stat
list editor columns 1 through 20, and then
stores lists L1 through L6 in columns 1
through 6.
Note: Removing lists from the stat list editor does not
delete them from memory.
3. Press 1 to select 1:Edit from the STAT
EDIT menu. The stat list editor is displayed.
If elements are stored in L1 and L2, press }
to move the cursor onto L1, and then press
~ } to clear
both lists. Press | to move the rectangular
cursor back to the first row in L1.
*This example is quoted and adapted from Contemporary Precalculus Through Applications, by
the North Carolina School of Science and Mathematics, by permission of Janson
Publications, Inc., Dedham, MA. 1-800-322-MATH. 1992. All rights reserved.
Getting Started: Pendulum Lengths and Periods
Statistics 123
82D315~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:36 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:53
PM Page 3 of 38
4. Press 6 5 to store the first
pendulum string length (6.5 cm) in L1. The
rectangular cursor moves to the next row.
Repeat this step to enter each of the 12
string length values in the table on page
12.2.
5. Press ~ to move the rectangular cursor to
the first row in L2.
Press 51 to store the first time
measurement (.51 sec) in L2. The
rectangular cursor moves to the next row.
Repeat this step to enter each of the 12 time
values in the table on page 12.2.
6. Press o to display the Y= editor.
If necessary, press to clear the function
Y1. As necessary, press }, , and ~to
turn off Plot1, Plot2, and Plot3 from the top
line of the Y= editor (Chapter 3). As necessary,
press , |, and to deselect functions.
7. Press y [STAT PLOT] 1 to select 1:Plot1
from the STAT PLOTS menu. The stat plot
editor is displayed for plot 1.
8. Press to select On, which turns on
plot 1. Press to select "(scatter
plot). Press y [L1] to specify Xlist:L1
for plot 1. Press y[L2] to specify
Ylist:L2 for plot 1. Press ~to
select + as the Mark for each data point on
the scatter plot.
9. Press q 9 to select 9:ZoomStat from the
ZOOM menu. The window variables are
adjusted automatically, and plot 1 is
displayed. This is a scatter plot of the time-
versus-length data.
124 Statistics
82D315~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:36 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:53
PM Page 4 of 38
Since the scatter plot of time-versus-length data appears to be approximately linear,
fit a line to the data.
10. Press ~ 4 to select 4:LinReg(ax+b)
(linear regression model) from the STAT
CALC menu. LinReg(ax+b) is pasted to the
home screen.
11. Press y [L1] y [L2] . Press
~ 1 to display the VARS Y.VARS
FUNCTION secondary menu, and then press
1 to select 1:Y1. L1, L2, and Y1 are pasted to
the home screen as arguments to
LinReg(ax+b).
12. Press to execute LinReg(ax+b). The
linear regression for the data in L1 and L2 is
calculated. Values for a and b are displayed on
the home screen. The linear regression
equation is stored in Y1. Residuals are
calculated and stored automatically in the list
name RESID, which becomes an item on the
LIST NAMES menu.
13. Press s. The regression line and the
scatter plot are displayed.
Getting Started: Pendulum Lengths and Periods (cont.)
Statistics 125
82D315~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:36 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:53
PM Page 5 of 38
The regression line appears to fit the central portion of the scatter plot well. However,
a residual plot may provide more information about this fit.
14. Press 1 to select 1:Edit. The stat list
editor is displayed.
Press ~ and } to move the cursor onto L3.
Press y [INS]. An unnamed column is
displayed in column 3; L3, L4, L5, and L6
shift right one column. The Name= prompt
is displayed in the entry line, and alpha-lock
is on.
15. Press y [LIST] to display the LIST NAMES
menu.
If necessary, press to move the cursor
onto the list name RESID.
16. Press to select RESID and paste it to
the stat list editors Name= prompt.
17. Press . RESID is stored in column 3 of
the stat list editor.
Press repeatedly to examine the
residuals.
Notice that the first three residuals are negative. They correspond to the shortest
pendulum string lengths in L1. The next five residuals are positive, and three of the
last four are negative. The latter correspond to the longer string lengths in L1. Plotting
the residuals will show this pattern more clearly.
126 Statistics
82D315~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:36 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:53
PM Page 6 of 38
18. Press y [STAT PLOT] 2 to select 2:Plot2
from the STAT PLOTS menu. The stat plot
editor is displayed for plot 2.
19. Press to select On, which turns on
plot 2.
Press to select " "" "(scatter plot).
Press y [L1] to specify Xlist:L1 for plot
2. Press [R] [E] [S] [I] [D] (alpha-lock is
on) to specify Ylist:RESID for plot 2. Press
to select as the mark for each
data point on the scatter plot.
20. Press o to display the Y= editor.
Press | to move the cursor onto the = sign,
and then press to deselect Y1. Press
} to turn off plot 1.
21. Press q 9 to select 9:ZoomStat from the
ZOOM menu. The window variables are
adjusted automatically, and plot 2 is
displayed. This is a scatter plot of the
residuals.
Notice the pattern of the residuals: a group of negative residuals, then a group of
positive residuals, and then another group of negative residuals.
Getting Started: Pendulum Lengths and Periods (cont.)
Statistics 127
82D315~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:36 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:53
PM Page 7 of 38
The residual pattern indicates a curvature associated with this data set for which the
linear model did not account. The residual plot emphasizes a downward curvature, so
a model that curves down with the data would be more accurate. Perhaps a function
such as square root would fit. Try a power regression to fit a function of the form y =
a x
b
.
22. Press o to display the Y= editor.
Press to clear the linear regression
equation from Y1. Press }to turn on
plot 1. Press ~ to turn off plot 2.
23. Press q 9 to select 9:ZoomStat from the
ZOOM menu. The window variables are
adjusted automatically, and the original
scatter plot of time-versus-length data (plot
1) is displayed.
24. Press ~ [A] to select
A:PwrReg from the STAT CALC menu.
PwrReg is pasted to the home screen.
Press y [L1] y [L2] . Press
~ 1 to display the VARS Y.VARS
FUNCTION secondary menu, and then press
1 to select 1:Y1. L1, L2, and Y1 are pasted to
the home screen as arguments to PwrReg.
25. Press to calculate the power
regression. Values for a and b are displayed
on the home screen. The power regression
equation is stored in Y1. Residuals are
calculated and stored automatically in the
list name RESID.
26. Press s. The regression line and the
scatter plot are displayed.
128 Statistics
82D315~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:36 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:53
PM Page 8 of 38
The new function y=.192x
.522
appears to fit the data well. To get more information,
examine a residual plot.
27. Press o to display the Y= editor.
Press | to deselect Y1.
Press } to turn off plot 1. Press ~
to turn on plot 2.
Note: Step 19 defined plot 2 to plot residuals ( RESID)
versus string length (L1).
28. Press q 9 to select 9:ZoomStat from the
ZOOM menu. The window variables are
adjusted automatically, and plot 2 is
displayed. This is a scatter plot of the
residuals.
The new residual plot shows that the residuals are random in sign, with the residuals
increasing in magnitude as the string length increases.
To see the magnitudes of the residuals, continue with these steps.
29. Press r.
Press ~ and | to trace the data. Observe
the values for Y at each point.
With this model, the largest positive residual
is about 0.041 and the smallest negative
residual is about L0.027. All other residuals
are less than 0.02 in magnitude.
Getting Started: Pendulum Lengths and Periods (cont.)
Statistics 129
82D315~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:36 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:53
PM Page 9 of 38
Now that you have a good model for the relationship between length and period, you
can use the model to predict the period for a given string length. To predict the
periods for a pendulum with string lengths of 20 cm and 50 cm, continue with these
steps.
30. Press ~ 1 to display the VARS
Y.VARS FUNCTION secondary menu, and
then press 1 to select 1:Y1. Y1 is pasted to
the home screen.
31. Press 20 to enter a string length of 20
cm.
Press to calculate the predicted time
of about 0.92 seconds.
Based on the residual analysis, we would
expect the prediction of about 0.92 seconds
to be within about 0.02 seconds of the actual
value.
32. Press y [ENTRY] to recall the Last Entry.
Press | | | 5 to change the string length
to 50 cm.
33. Press to calculate the predicted time
of about 1.48 seconds.
Since a string length of 50 cm exceeds the
lengths in the data set, and since residuals
appear to be increasing as string length
increases, we would expect more error with
this estimate.
Note: You also can make predictions using the table
with the TABLE SETUP settings Indpnt:Ask and
Depend:Auto (Chapter 7).
1210 Statistics
82D315~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:36 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:53
PM Page 10 of 38
Data for statistical analyses is stored in lists, which you can
create and edit using the stat list editor. The TI-82 STATS has
six list variables in memory, L1 through L6, to which you can
store data for statistical calculations. Also, you can store data to
list names that you create (Chapter 11).
To set up a statistical analysis, follow these steps. Read the
chapter for details.
1. Enter the statistical data into one or more lists.
2. Plot the data.
3. Calculate the statistical variables or fit a model to the data.
4. Graph the regression equation for the plotted data.
5. Graph the residuals list for the given regression model.
The stat list editor is a table where you can store, edit, and view
up to 20 lists that are in memory. Also, you can create list
names from the stat list editor.
To display the stat list editor, press , and then select 1:Edit
from the STAT EDIT menu.
The top line displays list names. L1 through L6 are stored in
columns 1 through 6 after a memory reset. The number of the
current column is displayed in the top-right corner.
The bottom line is the entry line. All data entry occurs on this
line. The characteristics of this line change according to the
current context (page 12.17).
The center area displays up to seven elements of up to three
lists; it abbreviates values when necessary. The entry line
displays the full value of the current element.
Setting Up Statistical Analyses
Using Lists to
Store Data
Setting Up a
Statistical
Analysis
Displaying the
Stat List Editor
Statistics 1211
82D315~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:36 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:53
PM Page 11 of 38
To enter a list name in the stat list editor, follow these steps.
1. Display the Name= prompt in the entry line in either of two
ways.
Move the cursor onto the list name in the column where
you want to insert a list, and then press y [INS]. An
unnamed column is displayed and the remaining lists shift
right one column.
Press } until the cursor is on the top line, and then press
~ until you reach the unnamed column.
Note: If list names are stored to all 20 columns, you must remove
a list name to make room for an unnamed column.
The Name= prompt is displayed and alpha-lock is on.
2. Enter a valid list name in any of four ways.
Select a name from the LIST NAMES menu (Chapter 11).
Enter L1, L2, L3, L4, L5, or L6 from the keyboard.
Enter an existing user-created list name directly from the
keyboard.
Enter a new user-created list name (page 12.12).
3. Press or to store the list name and its elements, if
any, in the current column of the stat list editor.
To begin entering, scrolling, or editing list elements, press .
The rectangular cursor is displayed.
Note: If the list name you entered in step 2 already was stored in
another stat list editor column, then the list and its elements, if any,
move to the current column from the previous column. Remaining list
names shift accordingly.
Using the Stat List Editor
Entering a List
Name in the Stat
List Editor
1212 Statistics
82D315~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:36 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:53
PM Page 12 of 38
To create a name in the stat list editor, follow these steps.
1. Follow step 1 on page 12.11 to display the Name= prompt.
2. Press [letter from A to Z or q] to enter the first letter of the
name. The first character cannot be a number.
3. Enter zero to four letters, q, or numbers to complete the new
user-created list name. List names can be one to five
characters long.
4. Press or to store the list name in the current
column of the stat list editor. The list name becomes an item
on the LIST NAMES menu (Chapter 11).
To remove a list from the stat list editor, move the cursor onto the
list name and then press {. The list is not deleted from memory;
it is only removed from the stat list editor.
Note: To delete a list name from memory, use the MEMORY
DELETE:List selection screen (Chapter 18).
You can remove all user-created lists from the stat list editor and
restore list names L1 through L6 to columns 1 through 6 in either
of two ways.
Use SetUpEditor with no arguments (page 12.21).
Reset all memory (Chapter 18).
You can clear all elements from a list in any of five ways.
Use ClrList to clear specified lists (page 12.20).
In the stat list editor, press } to move the cursor onto a list
name, and then press .
In the stat list editor, move the cursor onto each element, and
then press { one by one.
On the home screen or in the program editor, enter
0! !! !dim(listname) to set the dimension of listname to 0
(Chapter 11).
Use ClrAllLists to clear all lists in memory (Chapter 18).
Using the Stat List Editor (continued)
Creating a Name
in the Stat List
Editor
Removing a List
from the Stat List
Editor
Removing All
Lists and
Restoring L1
through L6
Clearing All
Elements from a
List
Statistics 1213
82D315~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:36 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:53
PM Page 13 of 38
To edit a list element, follow these steps.
1. Move the rectangular cursor onto the element you want to
edit.
2. Press to move the cursor to the entry line.
Note: If you want to replace the current value, you can enter a
new value without first pressing . When you enter the first
character, the current value is cleared automatically.
3. Edit the element in the entry line.
Press one or more keys to enter the new value. When you
enter the first character, the current value is cleared
automatically.
Press ~ to move the cursor to the character before which
you want to insert, press y [INS], and then enter one or
more characters.
Press ~ to move the cursor to a character you want to
delete, and then press { to delete the character.
To cancel any editing and restore the original element at the
rectangular cursor, press .
Note: You can enter expressions and variables for elements.
4. Press , }, or to update the list. If you entered an
expression, it is evaluated. If you entered only a variable, the
stored value is displayed as a list element.
When you edit a list element in the stat list editor, the list is
updated in memory immediately.
Editing a List
Element
1214 Statistics
82D315~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:36 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:53
PM Page 14 of 38
You can attach a formula to a list name in the stat list editor, and
then display and edit the calculated list elements. When
executed, the attached formula must resolve to a list. Chapter 11
describes in detail the concept of attaching formulas to list
names.
To attach a formula to a list name that is stored in the stat list
editor, follow these steps.
1. Press to display the stat list editor.
2. Press } to move the cursor to the top line.
3. Press | or ~, if necessary, to move the cursor onto the list
name to which you want to attach the formula.
Note: If a formula in quotation marks is displayed on the entry
line, then a formula is already attached to the list name. To edit
the formula, press , and then edit the formula.
4. Press [], enter the formula, and press [].
Note: If you do not use quotation marks, the TI-82 STATS
calculates and displays the same initial list of answers, but does
not attach the formula for future calculations.
Note: Any user-created list name referenced in a formula must be
preceded by an symbol (Chapter 11).
5. Press . The TI-82 STATS calculates each list element
and stores it to the list name to which the formula is attached.
A lock symbol is displayed in the stat list editor, next to the
list name to which the formula is attached.
Attaching Formulas to List Names
Attaching a
Formula to a List
Name in Stat List
Editor
lock symbol
Statistics 1215
82D315~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:36 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:53
PM Page 15 of 38
When you edit an element of a list referenced in an attached
formula, the TI-82 STATS updates the corresponding element in
the list to which the formula is attached (Chapter 11).
When a list with a formula attached is displayed in the stat list
editor and you edit or enter elements of another displayed list,
then the TI-82 STATS takes slightly longer to accept each edit
or entry than when no lists with formulas attached are in view.
Tip: To speed editing time, scroll horizontally until no lists with
formulas are displayed, or rearrange the stat list editor so that no lists
with formulas are displayed.
On the home screen, you can attach to a list a formula that
references another list with dimension 0 (Chapter 11). However,
you cannot display the formula-generated list in the stat list
editor or on the home screen until you enter at least one element
to the list that the formula references.
All elements of a list referenced by an attached formula must be
valid for the attached formula. For example, if Real number
mode is set and the attached formula is log(L1), then each
element of L1 must be greater than 0, since the logarithm of a
negative number returns a complex result.
Tip: If an error menu is returned when you attempt to display a
formula-generated list in the stat list editor, you can select 2:Goto,
write down the formula that is attached to the list, and then press
to detach (clear) the formula. You then can use the stat
list editor to find the source of the error. After making the appropriate
changes, you can reattach the formula to a list.
If you do not want to clear the formula, you can select 1:Quit, display
the referenced list on the home screen, and find and edit the source
of the error. To edit an element of a list on the home screen, store the
new value to listname(element#) (Chapter 11).
Using the Stat
List Editor When
Formula-
Generated Lists
Are Displayed
Handling Errors
Resulting from
Attached
Formulas
1216 Statistics
82D315~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:36 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:53
PM Page 16 of 38
You can detach (clear) a formula from a list name in any of four
ways.
In the stat list editor, move the cursor onto the name of the
list to which a formula is attached. Press
. All list elements remain, but the formula is
detached and the lock symbol disappears.
In the stat list editor, move the cursor onto an element of the
list to which a formula is attached. Press , edit the
element, and then press . The element changes, the
formula is detached, and the lock symbol disappears. All
other list elements remain.
Use ClrList (page 12.20). All elements of one or more
specified lists are cleared, each formula is detached, and each
lock symbol disappears. All list names remain.
Use ClrAllLists (Chapter 18). All elements of all lists in
memory are cleared, all formulas are detached from all list
names, and all lock symbols disappear. All list names
remain.
As described above, one way to detach a formula from a list
name is to edit an element of the list to which the formula is
attached. The TI-82 STATS protects against inadvertently
detaching the formula from the list name by editing an element
of the formula-generated list.
Because of the protection feature, you must press before
you can edit an element of a formula-generated list.
The protection feature does not allow you to delete an element
of a list to which a formula is attached. To delete an element of
a list to which a formula is attached, you must first detach the
formula in any of the ways described above.
Detaching Formulas from List Names
Detaching a
Formula from a
List Name
Editing an
Element of a
Formula-
Generated List
Statistics 1217
82D315~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:36 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:53
PM Page 17 of 38
The stat list editor has four contexts.
View-elements context Edit-elements context
View-names context Enter-name context
The stat list editor is first displayed in view-elements context.
To switch through the four contexts, select 1:Edit from the
STAT EDIT menu and follow these steps.
1. Press }to move the cursor onto a list name. You are now in
view-names context. Press ~and |to view list names
stored in other stat list editor columns.
2. Press . You are now in edit-elements context. You
may edit any element in a list. All elements of the current list
are displayed in braces ( { } )in the entry line. Press ~ and
| to view more list elements.
3. Press again. You are now in view-elements context.
Press ~, |, , and }to view other list elements. The
current elements full value is displayed in the entry line.
4. Press again. You are now in edit-elements context.
You may edit the current element in the entry line.
5. Press }until the cursor is on a list name, then press y
[INS]. You are now in enter-name context.
6. Press . You are now in view-names context.
7. Press . You are now back in view-elements context.
Switching Stat List Editor Contexts
Stat List Editor
Contexts
1218 Statistics
82D315~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:36 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:53
PM Page 18 of 38
In view-elements context, the entry line displays the list name,
the current elements place in that list, and the full value of the
current element, up to 12 characters at a time. An ellipsis (...)
indicates that the element continues beyond 12 characters.
To page down the list six elements, press . To page up
six elements, press }. To delete a list element, press
{. Remaining elements shift up one row. To insert a new
element, press y [INS]. 0 is the default value for a new
element.
In edit-elements context, the data displayed in the entry line
depends on the previous context.
When you switch to edit-elements context from view-
elements context, the full value of the current element is
displayed. You can edit the value of this element, and then
press and } to edit other list elements.
&
When you switch to edit-elements context from view-names
context, the full values of all elements in the list are
displayed. An ellipsis indicates that list elements continue
beyond the screen. You can press ~ and | to edit any
element in the list.
&
Note: In edit-elements context, you can attach a formula to a list
name only if you switched to it from view-names context.
Stat List Editor Contexts
View-Elements
Context
Edit-Elements
Context
Statistics 1219
82D315~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:36 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:53
PM Page 19 of 38
In view-names context, the entry line displays the list name and
the list elements.
To remove a list from the stat list editor, press {. Remaining
lists shift to the left one column. The list is not deleted from
memory.
To insert a name in the current column, press y [INS].
Remaining columns shift to the right one column.
In enter-name context, the Name= prompt is displayed in the
entry line, and alpha-lock is on.
At the Name= prompt, you can create a new list name, paste a
list name from L1 to L6 from the keyboard, or paste an existing
list name from the LIST NAMES menu (Chapter 11). The
symbol is not required at the Name= prompt.
To leave enter-name context without entering a list name, press
. The stat list editor switches to view-names context.
View-Names
Context
Enter-Name
Context
1220 Statistics
82D315~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:36 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:53
PM Page 20 of 38
To display the STAT EDIT menu, press .
EDIT CALC TESTS
1: Edit... Displays the stat list editor.
2: SortA( Sorts a list in ascending order.
3: SortD( Sorts a list in descending order.
4: ClrList Deletes all elements of a list.
5: SetUpEditor Stores lists in the stat list editor.
Note: Chapter 13: Inferential Statistics describes the STAT TESTS
menu items.
SortA( (sort ascending) sorts list elements from low to high
values. SortD( (sort descending) sorts list elements from high to
low values. Complex lists are sorted based on magnitude
(modulus). SortA( and SortD( each can sort in either of two
ways.
With one listname, SortA( and SortD( sort the elements in
listname and update the list in memory.
With two or more lists, SortA( and SortD( sort keylistname,
and then sort each dependlist by placing its elements in the
same order as the corresponding elements in keylistname.
This lets you sort two-variable data on X and keep the data
pairs together. All lists must have the same dimension.
The sorted lists are updated in memory.
SortA(listname)
SortD(listname)
SortA(keylistname,dependlist1[,dependlist2,...,dependlist n])
SortD(keylistname,dependlist1[,dependlist2,...,dependlist n])
Note: SortA( and SortD( are the same as SortA( and SortD( on the
LIST OPS menu.
ClrList clears (deletes) from memory the elements of one or
more listnames. ClrList also detaches any formula attached to a
listname.
ClrList listname1,listname2,...,listname n
Note: To clear from memory all elements of all list names, use
ClrAllLists (Chapter 18).
STAT EDIT Menu
STAT EDIT Menu
SortA(, SortD(
ClrList
Statistics 1221
82D315~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:36 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:53
PM Page 21 of 38
With SetUpEditor you can set up the stat list editor to display
one or more listnames in the order that you specify. You can
specify zero to 20 listnames.
SetUpEditor [listname1,listname2,...,listname n]
SetUpEditor with one to 20 listnames removes all list names
from the stat list editor and then stores listnames in the stat list
editor columns in the specified order, beginning in column 1.
If you enter a listname that is not stored in memory already,
then listname is created and stored in memory; it becomes an
item on the LIST NAMES menu.
SetUpEditor with no listnames removes all list names from the
stat list editor and restores list names L1 through L6 in the stat
list editor columns 1 through 6.
SetUpEditor
Restoring L1
through L6 to the
Stat List Editor
1222 Statistics
82D315~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:36 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:53
PM Page 22 of 38
STAT CALC menu items 3 through C are regression models
(page 12.24). The automatic residual list and automatic
regression equation features apply to all regression models.
Diagnostics display mode applies to some regression models.
When you execute a regression model, the automatic residual
list feature computes and stores the residuals to the list name
RESID. RESID becomes an item on the LIST NAMES menu
(Chapter 11).
The TI-82 STATS uses the formula below to compute RESID
list elements. The next section describes the variable RegEQ.
RESID = Ylistname N RegEQ(Xlistname)
Each regression model has an optional argument, regequ, for
which you can specify a Y= variable such as Y1. Upon execution,
the regression equation is stored automatically to the specified Y=
variable and the Y= function is selected.
Regardless of whether you specify a Y= variable for regequ, the
regression equation always is stored to the TI-82 STATS
variable RegEQ, which is item 1 on the VARS Statistics EQ
secondary menu.
Note: For the regression equation, you can use the fixed-decimal
mode setting to control the number of digits stored after the decimal
point (Chapter 1). However, limiting the number of digits to a small
number could affect the accuracy of the fit.
Regression Model Features
Regression
Model Features
Automatic
Residual List
Automatic
Regression
Equation
Statistics 1223
82D315~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:36 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:53
PM Page 23 of 38
When you execute some regression models, the TI-82 STATS
computes and stores diagnostics values for r (correlation
coefficient) and r
2
(coefficient of determination) or for R
2
(coefficient of determination).
r and r
2
are computed and stored for these regression models.
LinReg(ax+b) LnReg PwrReg
LinReg(a+bx) ExpReg
R
2
is computed and stored for these regression models.
QuadReg CubicReg QuartReg
The r and r
2
that are computed for LnReg, ExpReg, and
PwrReg are based on the linearly transformed data. For
example, for ExpReg (y=ab^x), r and r
2
are computed on
ln y=ln a+x(ln b).
By default, these values are not displayed with the results of a
regression model when you execute it. However, you can set the
diagnostics display mode by executing the DiagnosticOn or
DiagnosticOff instruction. Each instruction is in the CATALOG
(Chapter 15).
Note: To set DiagnosticOn or DiagnosticOff from the home
screen, press y [CATALOG], and then select the instruction for the
mode you want. The instruction is pasted to the home screen. Press
to set the mode.
When DiagnosticOn is set, diagnostics are displayed with the
results when you execute a regression model.
When DiagnosticOff is set, diagnostics are not displayed with
the results when you execute a regression model.
Diagnostics
Display Mode
1224 Statistics
82D315~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:36 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:53
PM Page 24 of 38
To display the STAT CALC menu, press ~.
EDIT CALC TESTS
1: 1-Var Stats Calculates 1-variable statistics.
2: 2-Var Stats Calculates 2-variable statistics.
3: Med-Med Calculates a median-median line.
4: LinReg(ax+b) Fits a linear model to data.
5: QuadReg Fits a quadratic model to data.
6: CubicReg Fits a cubic model to data.
7: QuartReg Fits a quartic model to data.
8: LinReg(a+bx) Fits a linear model to data.
9: LnReg Fits a logarithmic model to data.
0: ExpReg Fits an exponential model to data.
A: PwrReg Fits a power model to data.
B: Logistic Fits a logistic model to data.
C: SinReg Fits a sinusoidal model to data.
For each STAT CALC menu item, if neither Xlistname nor
Ylistname is specified, then the default list names are L1 and L2.
If you do not specify freqlist, then the default is 1 occurrence of
each list element.
For most STAT CALC menu items, you can specify a list of data
occurrences, or frequencies (freqlist).
Each element in freqlist indicates how many times the
corresponding data point or data pair occurs in the data set you
are analyzing.
For example, if L1={15,12,9,14} and FREQ={1,4,1,3}, then the
TI-82 STATS interprets the instruction 1.Var Stats L1, FREQ
to mean that 15 occurs once, 12 occurs four times, 9 occurs
once, and 14 occurs three times.
Each element in freqlist must be 0, and at least one element
must be > 0.
Noninteger freqlist elements are valid. This is useful when
entering frequencies expressed as percentages or parts that add
up to 1. However, if freqlist contains noninteger frequencies, Sx
and Sy are undefined; values are not displayed for Sx and Sy in
the statistical results.
STAT CALC Menu
STAT CALC
Menu
Frequency of
Occurrence for
Data Points
Statistics 1225
82D315~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:36 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:53
PM Page 25 of 38
1.Var Stats (one-variable statistics) analyzes data with one
measured variable. Each element in freqlist is the frequency of
occurrence for each corresponding data point in Xlistname.
freqlist elements must be real numbers > 0.
1.Var Stats [Xlistname,freqlist]
2.Var Stats (two-variable statistics) analyzes paired data.
Xlistname is the independent variable. Ylistname is the
dependent variable. Each element in freqlist is the frequency of
occurrence for each data pair (Xlistname,Ylistname).
2.Var Stats [Xlistname,Ylistname,freqlist]
Med.Med (median-median) fits the model equation y=ax+b to
the data using the median-median line (resistant line) technique,
calculating the summary points x1, y1, x2, y2, x3, and y3.
Med.Med displays values for a (slope) and b (y-intercept).
Med.Med [Xlistname,Ylistname,freqlist,regequ]
LinReg(ax+b) (linear regression) fits the model equation y=ax+b to
the data using a least-squares fit. It displays values for a (slope) and
b (y-intercept); when DiagnosticOn is set, it also displays values
for r
2
and r.
LinReg(ax+b) [Xlistname,Ylistname,freqlist,regequ]
QuadReg (quadratic regression) fits the second-degree
polynomial y=ax
2
+bx+c to the data. It displays values for a, b,
and c; when DiagnosticOn is set, it also displays a value for R
2
.
For three data points, the equation is a polynomial fit; for four
or more, it is a polynomial regression. At least three data points
are required.
QuadReg [Xlistname,Ylistname,freqlist,regequ]
1.Var Stats
2.Var Stats
Med.Med
(ax+b)
LinReg
(ax+b)
QuadReg
(ax2+bx+c)
1226 Statistics
82D315~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:36 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:53
PM Page 26 of 38
CubicReg (cubic regression) fits the third-degree polynomial
y=ax
3
+bx
2
+cx+d to the data. It displays values for a, b, c, and
d; when DiagnosticOn is set, it also displays a value for R
2
. For
four points, the equation is a polynomial fit; for five or more, it
is a polynomial regression. At least four points are required.
CubicReg [Xlistname,Ylistname,freqlist,regequ]
QuartReg (quartic regression) fits the fourth-degree polynomial
y=ax
4
+bx
3
+cx
2
+dx+e to the data. It displays values for a, b, c,
d, and e; when DiagnosticOn is set, it also displays a value for
R
2
. For five points, the equation is a polynomial fit; for six or
more, it is a polynomial regression. At least five points are
required.
QuartReg [Xlistname,Ylistname,freqlist,regequ]
LinReg(a+bx) (linear regression) fits the model equation y=a+bx
to the data using a least-squares fit. It displays values for a
(y-intercept) and b (slope); when DiagnosticOn is set, it also
displays values for r
2
and r.
LinReg(a+bx) [Xlistname,Ylistname,freqlist,regequ]
LnReg (logarithmic regression) fits the model equation
y=a+b ln(x) to the data using a least-squares fit and transformed
values ln(x) and y. It displays values for a and b; when
DiagnosticOn is set, it also displays values for r
2
and r.
LnReg [Xlistname,Ylistname,freqlist,regequ]
ExpReg (exponential regression) fits the model equation y=ab
x
to
the data using a least-squares fit and transformed values x and
ln(y). It displays values for a and b; when DiagnosticOn is set, it
also displays values for r
2
and r.
ExpReg [Xlistname,Ylistname,freqlist,regequ]
STAT CALC Menu (continued)
CubicReg
(ax
3
+bx
2
+cx+d)
QuartReg
(ax
4
+bx
3
+cx
2
+
dx+e)
LinReg
(a+bx)
LnReg
(a+b ln(x))
ExpReg
(ab
x
)
Statistics 1227
82D315~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:36 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:53
PM Page 27 of 38
PwrReg (power regression) fits the model equation y=ax
b
to the
data using a least-squares fit and transformed values ln(x) and
ln(y). It displays values for a and b; when DiagnosticOn is set, it
also displays values for r
2
and r.
PwrReg [Xlistname,Ylistname,freqlist,regequ]
Logistic fits the model equation y=c/ (1+ae
Lbx
) to the data using
an iterative least-squares fit. It displays values for a, b, and c.
Logistic [Xlistname,Ylistname,freqlist,regequ]
SinReg (sinusoidal regression) fits the model equation
y=a sin(bx+c)+d to the data using an iterative least-squares fit. It
displays values for a, b, c, and d. At least four data points are
required. At least two data points per cycle are required in order
to avoid aliased frequency estimates.
SinReg [iterations,Xlistname,Ylistname,period,regequ]
iterations is the maximum number of times the algorithm will
iterate to find a solution. The value for iterations can be an
integer 1 and 16; if not specified, the default is 3. The
algorithm may find a solution before iterations is reached.
Typically, larger values for iterations result in longer execution
times and better accuracy for SinReg, and vice versa.
A period guess is optional. If you do not specify period, the
difference between time values in Xlistname must be equal and
the time values must be ordered in ascending sequential order. If
you specify period, the algorithm may find a solution more
quickly, or it may find a solution when it would not have found
one if you had omitted a value for period. If you specify period,
the differences between time values in Xlistname can be
unequal.
Note: The output of SinReg is always in radians, regardless of the
Radian/Degree mode setting.
A SinReg example is shown on the next page.
PwrReg
(ax
b
)
Logistic
c/ (1+a e
Lbx
)
SinReg
a sin(bx+c)+d
1228 Statistics
82D315~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:36 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:53
PM Page 28 of 38
Compute the regression model for the number of hours of
daylight in Alaska during one year.
&
&
With noisy data, you will achieve better convergence results
when you specify an accurate estimate for period. You can
obtain a period guess in either of two ways.
Plot the data and trace to determine the x-distance between
the beginning and end of one complete period, or cycle. The
illustration above and to the right graphically depicts a
complete period, or cycle.
Plot the data and trace to determine the x-distance between
the beginning and end of N complete periods, or cycles.
Then divide the total distance by N.
After your first attempt to use SinReg and the default value for
iterations to fit the data, you may find the fit to be
approximately correct, but not optimal. For an optimal fit,
execute SinReg 16,Xlistname,Ylistname,2p / b where b is the
value obtained from the previous SinReg execution.
STAT CALC Menu (continued)
SinReg Example:
Daylight Hours in
Alaska for One
Year
1 period
Statistics 1229
82D315~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:36 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:53
PM Page 29 of 38
The statistical variables are calculated and stored as indicated below. To access these
variables for use in expressions, press , and select 5:Statistics. Then select the
VARS menu shown in the column below under VARS menu. If you edit a list or
change the type of analysis, all statistical variables are cleared.
Variables 1.Var
Stats
2.Var
Stats
Other VARS
menu
mean of x values v v XY
sum of x values Gx Gx G
sum of x
2
values Gx
2
Gx
2
G
sample standard deviation of x Sx Sx XY
population standard deviation of x sx sx XY
number of data points n n XY
mean of y values w XY
sum of y values Gy G
sum of y
2
values Gy
2
G
sample standard deviation of y Sy XY
population standard deviation of y sy XY
sum of x y Gxy G
minimum of x values minX minX XY
maximum of x values maxX maxX XY
minimum of y values minY XY
maximum of y values maxY XY
1st quartile Q1 PTS
median Med PTS
3rd quartile Q3 PTS
regression/fit coefficients a, b EQ
polynomial, Logistic, and SinReg
coefficients
a, b, c,
d, e
EQ
correlation coefficient r EQ
coefficient of determination r
2
, R
2
EQ
regression equation RegEQ EQ
summary points (Med.Med only) x1, y1, x2,
y2, x3, y3
PTS
The first quartile (Q1) is the median of points between minX and
Med (median). The third quartile (Q3) is the median of points
between Med and maxX.
Statistical Variables
Q1 and Q3
1230 Statistics
82D315~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:36 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:53
PM Page 30 of 38
You can enter statistical data, calculate statistical results, and fit
models to data from a program. You can enter statistical data
into lists directly within the program (Chapter 11).
To perform a statistical calculation from a program, follow these
steps.
1. On a blank line in the program editor, select the type of
calculation from the STAT CALC menu.
2. Enter the names of the lists to use in the calculation. Separate
the list names with a comma.
3. Enter a comma and then the name of a Y= variable, if you want
to store the regression equation to a Y= variable.
Statistical Analysis in a Program
Entering Stat
Data
Statistical
Calculations
Statistics 1231
82D315~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:36 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:53
PM Page 31 of 38
You can plot statistical data that is stored in lists. The six types
of plots available are scatter plot, xyLine, histogram, modified
box plot, regular box plot, and normal probability plot. You can
define up to three plots.
To plot statistical data in lists, follow these steps.
1. Store the stat data in one or more lists.
2. Select or deselect Y= functions as appropriate.
3. Define the stat plot.
4. Turn on the plots you want to display.
5. Define the viewing window.
6. Display and explore the graph.
Scatter plots plot the data points from Xlist and Ylist as
coordinate pairs, showing each point as a box ( ), cross ( + ),
or dot ( ). Xlist and Ylist must be the same length. You can use
the same list for Xlist and Ylist.
xyLine is a scatter plot in which the data points are plotted and
connected in order of appearance in Xlist and Ylist. You may
want to use SortA( or SortD( to sort the lists before you plot
them (page 12.20).
Statistical Plotting
Steps for Plotting
Statistical Data in
Lists
" "" "
(Scatter)
(xyLine)
1232 Statistics
82D315~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:36 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:53
PM Page 32 of 38
Histogram plots one-variable data. The Xscl window variable
value determines the width of each bar, beginning at Xmin.
ZoomStat adjusts Xmin, Xmax, Ymin, and Ymax to include all
values, and also adjusts Xscl. The inequality
(Xmax N Xmin) Xscl 47 must be true. A value that occurs on
the edge of a bar is counted in the bar to the right.
ModBoxplot (modified box plot) plots one-variable data, like
the regular box plot, except points that are 1.5 Interquartile
Range beyond the quartiles. (The Interquartile Range is defined
as the difference between the third quartile Q3 and the first
quartile Q1.) These points are plotted individually beyond the
whisker, using the Mark ( or + or ) you select. You can trace
these points, which are called outliers.
The prompt for outlier points is x=, except when the outlier is
the maximum point (maxX) or the minimum point (minX).
When outliers exist, the end of each whisker will display x=.
When no outliers exist, minX and maxX are the prompts for the
end of each whisker. Q1, Med (median), and Q3 define the box
(page 12.29).
Box plots are plotted with respect to Xmin and Xmax, but ignore
Ymin and Ymax. When two box plots are plotted, the first one
plots at the top of the screen and the second plots in the middle.
When three are plotted, the first one plots at the top, the second
in the middle, and the third at the bottom.
Statistical Plotting (continued)
(Histogram)
(ModBoxplot)
Statistics 1233
82D315~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:36 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:53
PM Page 33 of 38
Boxplot (regular box plot) plots one-variable data. The whiskers
on the plot extend from the minimum data point in the set
(minX) to the first quartile (Q1) and from the third quartile (Q3)
to the maximum point (maxX). The box is defined by Q1, Med
(median), and Q3 (page 12.29).
Box plots are plotted with respect to Xmin and Xmax, but ignore
Ymin and Ymax. When two box plots are plotted, the first one
plots at the top of the screen and the second plots in the middle.
When three are plotted, the first one plots at the top, the second
in the middle, and the third at the bottom.
NormProbPlot (normal probability plot) plots each observation
X in Data List versus the corresponding quantile z of the
standard normal distribution. If the plotted points lie close to a
straight line, then the plot indicates that the data are normal.
Enter a valid list name in the Data List field. Select X or Y for
the Data Axis setting.
If you select X, the TI-82 STATS plots the data on the x-axis
and the z-values on the y-axis.
If you select Y, the TI-82 STATS plots the data on the y-axis
and the z-values on the x-axis.
(Boxplot)
(NormProbPlot)
1234 Statistics
82D315~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:36 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:53
PM Page 34 of 38
To define a plot, follow these steps.
1. Press y [STAT PLOT]. The STAT PLOTS menu is displayed
with the current plot definitions.
2. Select the plot you want to use. The stat plot editor is
displayed for the plot you selected.
3. Press to select On if you want to plot the statistical
data immediately. The definition is stored whether you select
On or Off.
4. Select the type of plot. Each type prompts for the options
checked in this table.
Plot Type XList YList Mark Freq Data
List
Data
Axis
" "" " Scatter
xyLine
Histogram
ModBoxplot
Boxplot
NormProbPlot
5. Enter list names or select options for the plot type.
Xlist (list name containing independent data)
Ylist (list name containing dependent data)
Mark ( or + or )
Freq (frequency list for Xlist elements; default is 1)
Data List (list name for NormProbPlot)
Data Axis (axis on which to plot Data List)
Statistical Plotting (continued)
Defining the
Plots
Statistics 1235
82D315~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:36 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:53
PM Page 35 of 38
Each stat plot has a unique stat plot editor. The name of the
current stat plot (Plot1, Plot2, or Plot3) is highlighted in the top
line of the stat plot editor. To display the stat plot editor for a
different plot, press }, ~, and | to move the cursor onto the
name in the top line, and then press . The stat plot editor
for the selected plot is displayed, and the selected name remains
highlighted.
PlotsOn and PlotsOff allow you to turn on or turn off stat plots
from the home screen or a program. With no plot number,
PlotsOn turns on all plots and PlotsOff turns off all plots. With
one or more plot numbers (1, 2, and 3), PlotsOn turns on
specified plots, and PlotsOff turns off specified plots.
PlotsOff [1,2,3]
PlotsOn [1,2,3]
Note: You also can turn on and turn off stat plots in the top line of the
Y= editor (Chapter 3).
Displaying Other
Stat Plot Editors
Turning On and
Turning Off Stat
Plots
1236 Statistics
82D315~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:36 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:53
PM Page 36 of 38
Stat plots are displayed on the current graph. To define the
viewing window, press p and enter values for the window
variables. ZoomStat redefines the viewing window to display
all statistical data points.
When you trace a scatter plot or xyLine, tracing begins at the
first element in the lists.
When you trace a histogram, the cursor moves from the top
center of one column to the top center of the next, starting at the
first column.
When you trace a box plot, tracing begins at Med (the median).
Press | to trace to Q1 and minX. Press ~ to trace to Q3 and
maxX.
When you press } or to move to another plot or to another
Y= function, tracing moves to the current or beginning point on
that plot (not the nearest pixel).
The ExprOn/ExprOff format setting applies to stat plots
(Chapter 3).When ExprOn is selected, the plot number and
plotted data lists are displayed in the top-left corner.
Statistical Plotting (continued)
Defining the
Viewing Window
Tracing a Stat
Plot
Statistics 1237
82D315~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:36 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:53
PM Page 37 of 38
To display a stat plot from a program, define the plot, and then
display the graph.
To define a stat plot from a program, begin on a blank line in
the program editor and enter data into one or more lists; then,
follow these steps.
1. Press y [STAT PLOT] to display the STAT PLOTS menu.
2. Select the plot to define, which pastes Plot1(, Plot2(, or
Plot3( to the cursor location.
3. Press y [STAT PLOT] ~ to display the STAT TYPE menu.
4. Select the type of plot, which pastes the name of the plot
type to the cursor location.
Statistical Plotting in a Program
Defining a Stat
Plot in a Program
1238 Statistics
82D315~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:36 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:53
PM Page 38 of 38
5. Press . Enter the list names, separated by commas.
6. Press y [STAT PLOT] | to display the
STAT PLOT MARK menu. (This step is not necessary if you
selected 3:Histogram or 5:Boxplot in step 4.)
Select the type of mark ( or + or ) for each data point. The
selected mark symbol is pasted to the cursor location.
7. Press to complete the command line.
To display a plot from a program, use the DispGraph instruction
(Chapter 16) or any of the ZOOM instructions (Chapter 3).
Statistical Plotting in a Program (continued)
Defining a Stat
Plot in a Program
(continued)
Displaying a Stat
Plot from a
Program
Inferential Statistics and Distributions 131
8250FC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:39 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:57
PM Page 1 of 36
13
Inferential Statistics
and Distributions
Getting Started: Mean Height of a Population..................................... 2
Inferential Stat Editors......................................................................................... 6
STAT TESTS Menu ............................................................................................. 9
Inferential Statistics Input Descriptions................................................... 26
Test and Interval Output Variables.............................................................. 28
Distribution Functions......................................................................................... 29
Distribution Shading............................................................................................. 35
Contents
132 Inferential Statistics and Distributions
8250FC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:39 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:57
PM Page 2 of 36
Getting Started is a fast-paced introduction. Read the chapter for details.
Suppose you want to estimate the mean height of a population of women given the
random sample below. Because heights among a biological population tend to be
normally distributed, a t distribution confidence interval can be used when estimating
the mean. The 10 height values below are the first 10 of 90 values, randomly
generated from a normally distributed population with an assumed mean of 165.1 cm.
and a standard deviation of 6.35 cm. (randNorm(165.1,6.35,90) with a seed of 789).
Height (in cm.) of Each of 10 Women
169.43 168.33 159.55 169.97 159.79 181.42 171.17 162.04 167.15 159.53
1. Press to display the stat list
editor.
Press } to move the cursor onto L1, and then
press y [INS]. The Name= prompt is
displayed on the bottom line. The cursor
indicates that alpha-lock is on. The existing
list name columns shift to the right.
Note: Your stat editor may not look like the one
pictured here, depending on the lists you have
already stored.
2. Enter [H] [G] [H] [T] at the Name= prompt, and
then press . The list to which you will
store the womens height data is created.
Press to move the cursor onto the first row
of the list. HGHT(1)= is displayed on the bottom
line.
3. Press 169 43 to enter the first height value.
As you enter it, it is displayed on the bottom
line.
Press . The value is displayed in the first
row, and the rectangular cursor moves to the
next row.
Enter the other nine height values the same
way.
Getting Started: Mean Height of a Population
Inferential Statistics and Distributions 133
8250FC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:39 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:57
PM Page 3 of 36
4. Press | to display the STAT TESTS
menu, and then press until 8:TInterval is
highlighted.
5. Press to select 8:TInterval. The
inferential stat editor for TInterval is
displayed. If Data is not selected for Inpt:,
press | to select Data.
Press and [H] [G] [H] [T] at the List: prompt
(alpha-lock is on).
Press 99 to enter a 99 percent
confidence level at the C.Level: prompt.
6. Press to move the cursor onto Calculate,
and then press . The confidence interval
is calculated, and the TInterval results are
displayed on the home screen.
Interpret the results.
The first line, (159.74,173.94), shows that the 99 percent confidence interval for the
population mean is between about 159.74 cm. and 173.94 cm. This is about a 14.2
cm. spread.
The .99 confidence level indicates that in a very large number of samples, we expect
99 percent of the intervals calculated to contain the population mean. The actual mean
of the population sampled is 165.1 cm. (introduction; page 13.2), which is in the
calculated interval.
The second line gives the mean height of the sample used to compute this interval.
The third line gives the sample standard deviation Sx. The bottom line gives the
sample size n.
134 Inferential Statistics and Distributions
8250FC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:39 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:57
PM Page 4 of 36
To obtain a more precise bound on the population mean m of womens heights,
increase the sample size to 90. Use a sample mean of 163.8 and sample standard
deviation Sx of 7.1 calculated from the larger random sample (introduction; page
13.2). This time, use the Stats (summary statistics) input option.
7. Press | 8 to display the inferential stat
editor for TInterval.
Press ~ to select Inpt:Stats. The editor
changes so that you can enter summary
statistics as input.
8. Press 163 8 to store 163.8 to .
Press 7 1 to store 7.1 to Sx.
Press 90 to store 90 to n.
9. Press to move the cursor onto Calculate,
and then press to calculate the new 99
percent confidence interval. The results are
displayed on the home screen.
If the height distribution among a population of women is normally distributed with a
mean m of 165.1 cm. and a standard deviation of 6.35 cm., what height is exceeded
by only 5 percent of the women (the 95th percentile)?
10. Press to clear the home screen.
Press y [DISTR] to display the DISTR
(distributions) menu.
Getting Started: Mean Height of a Population (cont.)
Inferential Statistics and Distributions 135
8250FC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:39 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:57
PM Page 5 of 36
11. Press 3 to paste invNorm( to the home screen.
Press 95 165 1 6 35 .
.95 is the area, 165.1 is , and 6.35 is .
The result is displayed on the home screen; it shows that five percent of the women
are taller than 175.5 cm.
Now graph and shade the top 5 percent of the population.
12. Press p and set the window variables to
these values.
Xmin=145 Ymin=L.02 Xres=1
Xmax=185 Ymax=.08
Xscl=5 Yscl=0
13. Press y [DISTR] ~ to display the DISTR
DRAW menu.
14. Press to paste ShadeNorm( to the home
screen.
Press y [ANS] 1 y[EE] 99 165 1
6 35 .
Ans (175.5448205 from step 11) is the lower
bound. 199 is the upper bound. The normal
curve is defined by a mean of 165.1 and a
standard deviation of 6.35.
15. Press to plot and shade the normal
curve.
Area is the area above the 95th percentile. low
is the lower bound. up is the upper bound.
136 Inferential Statistics and Distributions
8250FC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:39 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:57
PM Page 6 of 36
When you select a hypothesis test or confidence interval
instruction from the home screen, the appropriate inferential
statistics editor is displayed. The editors vary according to each
test or intervals input requirements. Below is the inferential stat
editor for T.Test.
Note: When you select the ANOVA( instruction, it is pasted to the
home screen. ANOVA( does not have an editor screen.
To use an inferential stat editor, follow these steps.
1. Select a hypothesis test or confidence interval from the STAT
TESTS menu. The appropriate editor is displayed.
2. Select Data or Stats input, if the selection is available. The
appropriate editor is displayed.
3. Enter real numbers, list names, or expressions for each
argument in the editor.
4. Select the alternative hypothesis (, <, or >) against which to
test, if the selection is available.
5. Select No or Yes for the Pooled option, if the selection is
available.
6. Select Calculate or Draw (when Draw is available) to
execute the instruction.
When you select Calculate, the results are displayed on
the home screen.
When you select Draw, the results are displayed in a
graph.
This chapter describes the selections in the above steps for each
hypothesis test and confidence interval instruction.
Inferential Stat Editors
Displaying the
Inferential Stat
Editors
Using an
Inferential Stat
Editor
Inferential Statistics and Distributions 137
8250FC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:39 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:57
PM Page 7 of 36
Most inferential stat editors prompt you to select one of two
types of input. (1.PropZInt and 2.PropZTest, 1.PropZInt and
2.PropZInt, c
2
.Test, and LinRegTTest do not.)
Select Data to enter the data lists as input.
Select Stats to enter summary statistics, such as , Sx, and
n, as input.
To select Data or Stats, move the cursor to either Data or Stats,
and then press .
Inferential stat editors require a value for every argument. If you
do not know what a particular argument symbol represents, see
the tables on pages 13.26 and 13.27.
When you enter values in any inferential stat editor, the
TI-82 STATS stores them in memory so that you can run many
tests or intervals without having to reenter every value.
Most of the inferential stat editors for the hypothesis tests
prompt you to select one of three alternative hypotheses.
The first is a alternative hypothesis, such as mm0 for the
Z.Test.
The second is a < alternative hypothesis, such as m1<m2 for
the 2.SampTTest.
The third is a > alternative hypothesis, such as p1>p2 for the
2.PropZTest.
To select an alternative hypothesis, move the cursor to the
appropriate alternative, and then press .
Selecting Data or
Stats
Entering the
Values for
Arguments
Selecting an
Alternative
Hypothesis
( < >)
Enter values for
arguments
Select an alternative
hypothesis
Select Calculate
or Draw output
Select Data or
Stats input
138 Inferential Statistics and Distributions
8250FC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:39 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:57
PM Page 8 of 36
Pooled (2.SampTTest and 2.SampTInt only) specifies whether
the variances are to be pooled for the calculation.
Select No if you do not want the variances pooled.
Population variances can be unequal.
Select Yes if you want the variances pooled. Population
variances are assumed to be equal.
To select the Pooled option, move the cursor to Yes, and then
press .
After you have entered all arguments in an inferential stat editor
for a hypothesis test, you must select whether you want to see
the calculated results on the home screen (Calculate) or on the
graph screen (Draw).
Calculate calculates the test results and displays the outputs
on the home screen.
Draw draws a graph of the test results and displays the test
statistic and p-value with the graph. The window variables
are adjusted automatically to fit the graph.
To select Calculate or Draw, move the cursor to either
Calculate or Draw, and then press . The instruction is
immediately executed.
After you have entered all arguments in an inferential stat editor
for a confidence interval, select Calculate to display the results.
The Draw option is not available.
When you press , Calculate calculates the confidence
interval results and displays the outputs on the home screen.
To paste a hypothesis test or confidence interval instruction to
the home screen without displaying the corresponding
inferential stat editor, select the instruction you want from the
CATALOG menu. Appendix A describes the input syntax for
each hypothesis test and confidence interval instruction.
Note: You can paste a hypothesis test or confidence interval
instruction to a command line in a program. From within the program
editor, select the instruction from either the CATALOG (Chapter 15)
or the STAT TESTS menu.
Inferential Stat Editors (continued)
Selecting the
Pooled Option
Selecting
Calculate or
Draw for a
Hypothesis Test
Selecting
Calculate for a
Confidence
Interval
Bypassing the
Inferential Stat
Editors
Inferential Statistics and Distributions 139
8250FC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:39 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:57
PM Page 9 of 36
To display the STAT TESTS menu, press |. When you
select an inferential statistics instruction, the appropriate
inferential stat editor is displayed.
Most STAT TESTS instructions store some output variables to
memory. Most of these output variables are in the TEST
secondary menu (VARS menu; 5:Statistics). For a list of these
variables, see page 13.28.
EDIT CALC TESTS
1: Z-Test... Test for 1 m, known s
2: T-Test... Test for 1 m, unknown s
3: 2-SampZTest... Test comparing 2 ms, known ss
4: 2-SampTTest... Test comparing 2 ms, unknown ss
5: 1-PropZTest... Test for 1 proportion
6: 2-PropZTest... Test comparing 2 proportions
7: ZInterval... Confidence interval for 1 m, known s
8: TInterval... Confidence interval for 1 m, unknown s
9: 2-SampZInt... Conf. int. for diff. of 2 ms, known ss
0: 2-SampTInt... Conf. int. for diff. of 2 ms, unknown ss
A: 1-PropZInt... Confidence int. for 1 proportion
B: 2-PropZInt... Confidence int. for diff. of 2 props
C: c2-Test... Chi-square test for 2-way tables
D: 2-Samp Test... Test comparing 2 ss
E: LinRegTTest... t test for regression slope and r
F: ANOVA( One-way analysis of variance
Note: When a new test or interval is computed, all previous output
variables are invalidated.
In this chapter, the description of each STAT TESTS instruction
shows the unique inferential stat editor for that instruction with
example arguments.
Descriptions of instructions that offer the Data/Stats input
choice show both types of input screens.
Descriptions of instructions that do not offer the Data/Stats
input choice show only one input screen.
The description then shows the unique output screen for that
instruction with the example results.
Descriptions of instructions that offer the Calculate/Draw
output choice show both types of screens: calculated and
graphic results.
Descriptions of instructions that offer only the Calculate
output choice show the calculated results on the home
screen.
STAT TESTS Menu
STAT TESTS
Menu
Inferential Stat
Editors for the
STAT TESTS
Instructions
1310 Inferential Statistics and Distributions
8250FC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:39 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:57
PM Page 10 of 36
Z.Test (one-sample z test; item 1) performs a hypothesis test for
a single unknown population mean m when the population
standard deviation s is known. It tests the null hypothesis
H
0
: m=m
0
against one of the alternatives below.
H
a
: mm
0
(m:m0)
H
a
: m<m
0
(m:<m0)
H
a
: m>m
0
(m:>m0)
In the example:
L1={299.4 297.7 301 298.9 300.2 297}
Data Stats
Input:
, ,
Calculated results:
, ,
Drawn results:
Note: All examples on pages13.10 through 13.25 assume a fixed-
decimal mode setting of 4 (Chapter 1). If you set the decimal mode to
Float or a different fixed-decimal setting, your output may differ from
the output in the examples.
STAT TESTS Menu (continued)
Z.Test
Inferential Statistics and Distributions 1311
8250FC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:39 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:57
PM Page 11 of 36
T.Test (one-sample t test; item 2) performs a hypothesis test for
a single unknown population mean m when the population
standard deviation s is unknown. It tests the null hypothesis
H
0
: m=m
0
against one of the alternatives below.
H
a
: mm
0
(m:m0)
H
a
: m<m
0
(m:<m0)
H
a
: m>m
0
(m:>m0)
In the example:
TEST={91.9 97.8 111.4 122.3 105.4 95}
Data Stats
Input:
, ,
Calculated results:
, ,
Drawn results:
T.Test
1312 Inferential Statistics and Distributions
8250FC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:39 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:57
PM Page 12 of 36
2.SampZTest (two-sample z test; item 3) tests the equality of
the means of two populations (m
1
and m
2
) based on independent
samples when both population standard deviations (s
1
and s
2
)
are known. The null hypothesis H
0
: m
1
=m
2
is tested against one
of the alternatives below.
H
a
: m
1
m
2
(m1:m2)
H
a
: m
1
<m
2
(m1:<m2)
H
a
: m
1
>m
2
(m1:>m2)
In the example:
LISTA={154 109 137 115 140}
LISTB={108 115 126 92 146}
Data Stats
Input:
, ,
Calculated results:
, ,
Drawn results:
STAT TESTS Menu (continued)
2.SampZTest
Inferential Statistics and Distributions 1313
8250FC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:39 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:57
PM Page 13 of 36
2.SampTTest (two-sample t test; item 4) tests the equality of
the means of two populations (m
1
and m
2
) based on independent
samples when neither population standard deviation (s
1
or s
2
) is
known. The null hypothesis H
0
: m
1
=m
2
is tested against one of
the alternatives below.
H
a
: m
1
m
2
(m1:m2)
H
a
: m
1
<m
2
(m1:<m2)
H
a
: m
1
>m
2
(m1:>m2)
In the example:
SAMP1={12.207 16.869 25.05 22.429 8.456 10.589}
SAMP2={11.074 9.686 12.064 9.351 8.182 6.642}
Data Stats
Input:
, ,
Calculated results:
, ,
Drawn results:
2.SampTTest
1314 Inferential Statistics and Distributions
8250FC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:39 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:57
PM Page 14 of 36
1.PropZTest (one-proportion z test; item 5) computes a test for
an unknown proportion of successes (prop). It takes as input the
count of successes in the sample x and the count of observations
in the sample n. 1.PropZTest tests the null hypothesis
H
0
: prop=p
0
against one of the alternatives below.
H
a
: propp
0
(prop:p0)
H
a
: prop<p
0
(prop:<p0)
H
a
: prop>p
0
(prop:>p0)
Input:
,
Calculated results:
,
Drawn results:
STAT TESTS Menu (continued)
1.PropZTest
Inferential Statistics and Distributions 1315
8250FC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:39 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:57
PM Page 15 of 36
2.PropZTest (two-proportion z test; item 6) computes a test to
compare the proportion of successes (p
1
and p
2
) from two
populations. It takes as input the count of successes in each
sample (x
1
and x
2
) and the count of observations in each sample
(n
1
and n
2
). 2.PropZTest tests the null hypothesis H
0
: p
1
=p
2
(using the pooled sample proportion ) against one of the
alternatives below.
H
a
: p
1
p
2
(p1:p2)
H
a
: p
1
<p
2
(p1:<p2)
H
a
: p
1
>p
2
(p1:>p2)
Input:
,
Calculated results:
,
Drawn results:
2.PropZTest
1316 Inferential Statistics and Distributions
8250FC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:39 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:57
PM Page 16 of 36
ZInterval (one-sample z confidence interval; item 7) computes a
confidence interval for an unknown population mean m when the
population standard deviation s is known. The computed
confidence interval depends on the user-specified confidence
level.
In the example:
L1={299.4 297.7 301 298.9 300.2 297}
Data Stats
Input:
, ,
Calculated results:
STAT TESTS Menu (continued)
ZInterval
Inferential Statistics and Distributions 1317
8250FC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:39 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:57
PM Page 17 of 36
TInterval (one-sample t confidence interval; item 8) computes a
confidence interval for an unknown population mean m when the
population standard deviation s is unknown. The computed
confidence interval depends on the user-specified confidence
level.
In the example:
L6={1.6 1.7 1.8 1.9}
Data Stats
Input:
, ,
Calculated results:
TInterval
1318 Inferential Statistics and Distributions
8250FC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:39 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:57
PM Page 18 of 36
2.SampZInt (two-sample z confidence interval; item 9)
computes a confidence interval for the difference between two
population means (m
1
Nm
2
) when both population standard
deviations (s
1
and s
2
) are known. The computed confidence
interval depends on the user-specified confidence level.
In the example:
LISTC={154 109 137 115 140}
LISTD={108 115 126 92 146}
Data Stats
Input:
, ,
Calculated results:
STAT TESTS Menu (continued)
2.SampZInt
Inferential Statistics and Distributions 1319
8250FC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:39 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:57
PM Page 19 of 36
2.SampTInt (two-sample t confidence interval; item 0)
computes a confidence interval for the difference between two
population means (m
1
Nm
2
) when both population standard
deviations (s
1
and s
2
) are unknown. The computed confidence
interval depends on the user-specified confidence level.
In the example:
SAMP1={12.207 16.869 25.05 22.429 8.456 10.589}
SAMP2={11.074 9.686 12.064 9.351 8.182 6.642}
Data Stats
Input:
, ,
Calculated results:
2.SampTInt
1320 Inferential Statistics and Distributions
8250FC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:39 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:57
PM Page 20 of 36
1.PropZInt (one-proportion z confidence interval; item A)
computes a confidence interval for an unknown proportion of
successes. It takes as input the count of successes in the sample
x and the count of observations in the sample n. The computed
confidence interval depends on the user-specified confidence
level.
Input:
,
Calculated results:
STAT TESTS Menu (continued)
1.PropZInt
Inferential Statistics and Distributions 1321
8250FC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:39 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:57
PM Page 21 of 36
2.PropZInt (two-proportion z confidence interval; item B)
computes a confidence interval for the difference between the
proportion of successes in two populations (p
1
Np
2
). It takes as
input the count of successes in each sample (x
1
and x
2
) and the
count of observations in each sample (n
1
and n
2
). The computed
confidence interval depends on the user-specified confidence
level.
Input:
,
Calculated results:
2.PropZInt
1322 Inferential Statistics and Distributions
8250FC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:39 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:57
PM Page 22 of 36
c
2
.Test (chi-square test; item C) computes a chi-square test for
association on the two-way table of counts in the specified
Observed matrix. The null hypothesis H
0
for a two-way table is:
no association exists between row variables and column
variables. The alternative hypothesis is: the variables are related.
Before computing a c
2
.Test, enter the observed counts in a
matrix. Enter that matrix variable name at the Observed:
prompt in the c
2
.Test editor; default=[A]. At the Expected:
prompt, enter the matrix variable name to which you want the
computed expected counts to be stored; default=[B].
Matrix editor:
Note: Press ~ ~ 1 to
select 1:[A] from the MATRX
EDIT menu.
Input:
,
Note: Press [B] to
display matrix [B].
Calculated results:
,
Drawn results:
STAT TESTS Menu (continued)
c
2
.Test
Inferential Statistics and Distributions 1323
8250FC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:39 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:57
PM Page 23 of 36
2.Samp Test (two-sample -test; item D) computes an -test to
compare two normal population standard deviations (s
1
and s
2
).
The population means and standard deviations are all unknown.
2.Samp Test, which uses the ratio of sample variances
Sx1
2
/Sx2
2
, tests the null hypothesis H
0
: s
1
=s
2
against one of the
alternatives below.
H
a
: s
1
s
2
(s1:s2)
H
a
: s
1
<s
2
(s1:<s2)
H
a
: s
1
>s
2
(s1:>s2)
In the example:
SAMP4={ 7 L4 18 17 L3 L5 1 10 11 L2}
SAMP5={ L1 12 L1 L3 3 L5 5 2 L11 L1 L3}
Data Stats
Input:
, ,
Calculated results:
, ,
Drawn results:
2.Samp Test
1324 Inferential Statistics and Distributions
8250FC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:39 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:57
PM Page 24 of 36
LinRegTTest (linear regression t test; item E) computes a linear
regression on the given data and a t test on the value of slope b
and the correlation coefficient r for the equation y=a+bx. It
tests the null hypothesis H
0
: b=0 (equivalently, r=0) against one
of the alternatives below.
H
a
: b0 and r0 (b & r:0)
H
a
: b<0 and r<0 (b & r:<0)
H
a
: b>0 and r>0 (b & r:>0)
The regression equation is automatically stored to RegEQ
(VARS Statistics EQ secondary menu). If you enter a Y= variable
name at the RegEQ: prompt, the calculated regression equation
is automatically stored to the specified Y= equation. In the
example below, the regression equation is stored to Y1, which is
then selected (turned on).
In the example:
L3={38 56 59 64 74}
L4={41 63 70 72 84}
Input:
,
Calculated results:
When LinRegTTest is executed, the list of residuals is created
and stored to the list name RESID automatically. RESID is
placed on the LIST NAMES menu.
Note: For the regression equation, you can use the fix-decimal mode
setting to control the number of digits stored after the decimal point
(Chapter 1). However, limiting the number of digits to a small number
could affect the accuracy of the fit.
STAT TESTS Menu (continued)
LinRegTTest
Inferential Statistics and Distributions 1325
8250FC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:39 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:57
PM Page 25 of 36
ANOVA( (one-way analysis of variance; item F) computes a one-
way analysis of variance for comparing the means of two to 20
populations. The ANOVA procedure for comparing these means
involves analysis of the variation in the sample data. The null
hypothesis H
0
: m
1
=m
2
=...=m
k
is tested against the alternative H
a
:
not all m
1
...m
k
are equal.
ANOVA(list1,list2[,...,list20])
In the example:
L1={7 4 6 6 5}
L2={6 5 5 8 7}
L3={4 7 6 7 6}
Input:
,
Calculated results:
Note: SS is sum of squares and MS is mean square.
ANOVA(
1326 Inferential Statistics and Distributions
8250FC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:39 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:57
PM Page 26 of 36
The tables in this section describe the inferential statistics inputs discussed in this
chapter. You enter values for these inputs in the inferential stat editors. The tables
present the inputs in the same order that they appear in this chapter.
Input Description
m
0
Hypothesized value of the population mean that you are testing.
s The known population standard deviation; must be a real
number > 0.
List The name of the list containing the data you are testing.
Freq The name of the list containing the frequency values for the data
in List. Default=1. All elements must be integers | 0.
Calculate/Draw Determines the type of output to generate for tests and intervals.
Calculate displays the output on the home screen. In tests, Draw
draws a graph of the results.
v, Sx, n Summary statistics (mean, standard deviation, and sample size)
for the one-sample tests and intervals.
s1 The known population standard deviation from the first
population for the two-sample tests and intervals. Must be a real
number > 0.
s2 The known population standard deviation from the second
population for the two-sample tests and intervals. Must be a real
number > 0.
List1, List2 The names of the lists containing the data you are testing for the
two-sample tests and intervals. Defaults are L1 and L2,
respectively.
Freq1, Freq2 The names of the lists containing the frequencies for the data in
List1 and List2 for the two-sample tests and intervals.
Defaults=1. All elements must be integers | 0.
v1, Sx1, n1, v2,
Sx2, n2
Summary statistics (mean, standard deviation, and sample size)
for sample one and sample two in the two-sample tests and
intervals.
Pooled Specifies whether variances are to be pooled for 2.SampTTest
and 2.SampTInt. No instructs the TI-82 STATS not to pool the
variances. Yes instructs the TI-82 STATS to pool the variances.
Inferential Statistics Input Descriptions
Inferential Statistics and Distributions 1327
8250FC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:39 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:57
PM Page 27 of 36
Input Description
p
0
The expected sample proportion for 1.PropZTest. Must be a
real number, such that 0 < p
0
< 1.
x The count of successes in the sample for the 1.PropZTest and
1.PropZInt. Must be an integer 0.
n The count of observations in the sample for the 1.PropZTest
and 1.PropZInt. Must be an integer > 0.
x1 The count of successes from sample one for the 2.PropZTest
and 2.PropZInt. Must be an integer 0.
x2 The count of successes from sample two for the 2.PropZTest
and 2.PropZInt. Must be an integer 0.
n1 The count of observations in sample one for the 2.PropZTest
and 2.PropZInt. Must be an integer > 0.
n2 The count of observations in sample two for the 2.PropZTest
and 2.PropZInt. Must be an integer > 0.
C.Level The confidence level for the interval instructions. Must be 0
and <100. If it is 1, it is assumed to be given as a percent and
is divided by 100. Default=0.95.
Observed (Matrix) The matrix name that represents the columns and rows for the
observed values of a two-way table of counts for the c
2
.Test.
Observed must contain all integers 0. Matrix dimensions must
be at least 22.
Expected (Matrix) The matrix name that specifies where the expected values
should be stored. Expected is created upon successful
completion of the c
2
.Test.
Xlist, Ylist The names of the lists containing the data for LinRegTTest.
Defaults are L1 and L2, respectively. The dimensions of Xlist
and Ylist must be the same.
RegEQ The prompt for the name of the Y= variable where the calculated
regression equation is to be stored. If a Y= variable is specified,
that equation is automatically selected (turned on). The default
is to store the regression equation to the RegEQ variable only.
1328 Inferential Statistics and Distributions
8250FC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:39 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:57
PM Page 28 of 36
The inferential statistics variables are calculated as indicated below. To access these
variables for use in expressions, press , 5 (5:Statistics), and then select the
VARS menu listed in the last column below.
Variables Tests Intervals
LinRegTTest,
ANOVA
VARS
Menu
p-value p p TEST
test statistics z, t, c
2
, t, TEST
degrees of freedom df df df TEST
sample mean of x values for sample
1 and sample 2
v1, v2 v1, v2 TEST
sample standard deviation of x for
sample 1 and sample 2
Sx1,
Sx2
Sx1,
Sx2
TEST
number of data points for sample 1
and sample 2
n1, n2 n1, n2 TEST
pooled standard deviation SxP SxP SxP TEST
estimated sample proportion TEST
estimated sample proportion for
population 1
1 1 TEST
estimated sample proportion for
population 2
2 2 TEST
confidence interval pair lower,
upper
TEST
mean of x values v v XY
sample standard deviation of x Sx Sx XY
number of data points n n XY
standard error about the line s TEST
regression/fit coefficients a, b EQ
correlation coefficient r EQ
coefficient of determination r
2
EQ
regression equation RegEQ EQ
Test and Interval Output Variables
Inferential Statistics and Distributions 1329
8250FC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:39 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:57
PM Page 29 of 36
To display the DISTR menu, press y [DISTR].
DISTR DRAW
1: normalpdf( Normal probability density
2: normalcdf( Normal distribution probability
3: invNorm( Inverse cumulative normal distribution
4: tpdf( Student-t probability density
5: tcdf( Student-t distribution probability
6: c
2
pdf( Chi-square probability density
7: c
2
cdf Chi-square distribution probability
8: pdf( probability density
9: cdf( distribution probability
0: binompdf( Binomial probability
A: binomcdf( Binomial cumulative density
B: poissonpdf( Poisson probability
C: poissoncdf( Poisson cumulative density
D: geometpdf( Geometric probability
E: geometcdf( Geometric cumulative density
Note: L199 and 199 specify infinity. If you want to view the area left
of upperbound, for example, specify lowerbound=L199.
norwmalpdf( computes the probability density function (pdf) for
the normal distribution at a specified x value. The defaults are
mean m=0 and standard deviation s=1. To plot the normal
distribution, paste normalpdf( to the Y= editor. The probability
density function (pdf) is:
f x e
x
( ) = >
1
2
0
2
2
2
( )
,
normalpdf(x[,m,s])
Note: For this example,
Xmin = 28
Xmax = 42
Ymin = 0
Ymax = .25
Tip: For plotting the normal distribution, you can set window variables
Xmin and Xmax so that the mean m falls between them, and then
select 0:ZoomFit from the ZOOM menu.
Distribution Functions
DISTR menu
normalpdf(
1330 Inferential Statistics and Distributions
8250FC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:39 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:57
PM Page 30 of 36
normalcdf( computes the normal distribution probability
between lowerbound and upperbound for the specified mean m
and standard deviation s. The defaults are m=0
and s=1.
normalcdf(lowerbound,upperbound[,m,s])
invNorm( computes the inverse cumulative normal distribution
function for a given area under the normal distribution curve
specified by mean m and standard deviation s. It calculates the x
value associated with an area to the left of the x value.
0 area 1 must be true. The defaults are m=0 and s=1.
invNorm(area[,m,s])
tpdf( computes the probability density function (pdf) for the
Student-t distribution at a specified x value. df (degrees of
freedom) must be >0. To plot the Student-t distribution, paste
tpdf( to the Y= editor. The probability density function (pdf) is:
f x
df
df
x df
df
df
( )
[( ) ]
( )
( )
( )
=
+ +
+
1 2
2
1
2
1 2
/
/
/
/
tpdf(x,df)
Note: For this example,
Xmin = L4.5
Xmax = 4.5
Ymin = 0
Ymax = .4
Distribution Functions (continued)
normalcdf(
invNorm(
tpdf(
Inferential Statistics and Distributions 1331
8250FC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:39 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:57
PM Page 31 of 36
tcdf( computes the Student-t distribution probability between
lowerbound and upperbound for the specified df (degrees of
freedom), which must be > 0.
tcdf(lowerbound,upperbound,df)
c
2
pdf( computes the probability density function (pdf) for the c
2
(chi-square) distribution at a specified x value. df (degrees of
freedom) must be an integer > 0. To plot the c
2
distribution,
paste c
2
pdf( to the Y= editor. The probability density function
(pdf) is:
f x
df
x e x
df df x
( )
( )
(1/ 2) =
1
2
0
2 2 1 2
/
,
/ / /
c
2
pdf(x,df)
Note: For this example,
Xmin = 0
Xmax = 30
Ymin = L.02
Ymax = .132
c
2
cdf( computes the c
2
(chi-square) distribution probability
between lowerbound and upperbound for the specified df
(degrees of freedom), which must be an integer > 0.
c
2
cdf(lowerbound,upperbound,df)
tcdf(
c
2
pdf(
c
2
cdf(
1332 Inferential Statistics and Distributions
8250FC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:39 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:57
PM Page 32 of 36
pdf( computes the probability density function (pdf) for the
distribution at a specified x value. numerator df (degrees of
freedom) and denominator df must be integers > 0. To plot the
distribution, paste pdf( to the Y= editor. The probability
density function (pdf) is:
f x
n d
n d
n
d
x nx d x
n
n n d
( )
[( ) ]
( ) ( )
( )
( )
=
+
+
+
/
/ /
/ ,
/
/ /
2
2 2
1 0
2
2 1 2
where n = numerator degrees of freedom
d = denominator degrees of freedom
pdf(x,numerator df,denominator df)
Note: For this example,
Xmin = 0
Xmax = 5
Ymin = 0
Ymax = 1
cdf( computes the distribution probability between
lowerbound and upperbound for the specified numerator df
(degrees of freedom) and denominator df. numerator df and
denominator df must be integers >0.
cdf(lowerbound,upperbound,numerator df,
denominator df)
Distribution Functions (continued)
pdf(
cdf(
Inferential Statistics and Distributions 1333
8250FC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:39 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:57
PM Page 33 of 36
binompdf( computes a probability at x for the discrete binomial
distribution with the specified numtrials and probability of
success (p) on each trial. x can be an integer or a list of integers.
0p1 must be true. numtrials must be an integer > 0. If you do
not specify x, a list of probabilities from 0 to numtrials is
returned. The probability density function (pdf) is:
f x
n
x
p p x n
x n x
( ) ( ) =
1 0 1 , , , , K
where n = numtrials
binompdf(numtrials,p[,x])
binomcdf( computes a cumulative probability at x for the
discrete binomial distribution with the specified numtrials and
probability of success (p) on each trial. x can be a real number
or a list of real numbers. 0p1 must be true. numtrials must be
an integer > 0. If you do not specify x, a list of cumulative
probabilities is returned.
binomcdf(numtrials,p[,x])
poissonpdf( computes a probability at x for the discrete Poisson
distribution with the specified mean m, which must be a real
number > 0. x can be an integer or a list of integers. The
probability density function (pdf) is:
f x e x x
x
( ) ! = =
/ , , , , 0 1 2 K
poissonpdf(m,x)
binompdf(
binomcdf(
poissonpdf(
1334 Inferential Statistics and Distributions
8250FC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:39 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:57
PM Page 34 of 36
poissoncdf( computes a cumulative probability at x for the
discrete Poisson distribution with the specified mean m, which
must be a real number > 0. x can be a real number or a list of
real numbers.
poissoncdf(m,x)
geometpdf( computes a probability at x, the number of the trial
on which the first success occurs, for the discrete geometric
distribution with the specified probability of success p. 0p1
must be true. x can be an integer or a list of integers. The
probability density function (pdf) is:
f x p p x
x
( ) ( ) = =
1 1 2
1
, , ,K
geometpdf(p,x)
geometcdf( computes a cumulative probability at x, the number
of the trial on which the first success occurs, for the discrete
geometric distribution with the specified probability of success
p. 0p1 must be true. x can be a real number or a list of real
numbers.
geometcdf(p,x)
Distribution Functions (continued)
poissoncdf(
geometpdf(
geometcdf(
Inferential Statistics and Distributions 1335
8250FC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:39 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:57
PM Page 35 of 36
To display the DISTR DRAW menu, press y [DISTR] ~.
DISTR DRAW instructions draw various types of density
functions, shade the area specified by lowerbound and
upperbound, and display the computed area value.
To clear the drawings, select 1:ClrDraw from the DRAW menu
(Chapter 8).
Note: Before you execute a DISTR DRAW instruction, you must set
the window variables so that the desired distribution fits the screen.
DISTR DRA
W
1: ShadeNorm( Shades normal distribution.
2: Shade_t( Shades Student-t distribution.
3: Shadec
2
( Shades c
2
distribution.
4: Shade ( Shades distribution.
Note: L199 and 199 specify infinity. If you want to view the area left
of upperbound, for example, specify lowerbound=L199.
ShadeNorm( draws the normal density function specified by
mean m and standard deviation s and shades the area between
lowerbound and upperbound. The defaults are m=0 and s=1.
ShadeNorm(lowerbound,upperbound[,m,s])
Note: For this example,
Xmin = 55
Xmax = 72
Ymin = L.05
Ymax = .2
Distribution Shading
DISTR DRAW
Menu
ShadeNorm(
1336 Inferential Statistics and Distributions
8250FC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:39 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:57
PM Page 36 of 36
Shade_t( draws the density function for the Student-t
distribution specified by df (degrees of freedom) and shades the
area between lowerbound and upperbound.
Shade_t(lowerbound,upperbound,df)
Note: For this example,
Xmin = L3
Xmax = 3
Ymin = L.15
Ymax = .5
Shadec
2
( draws the density function for the c
2
(chi-square)
distribution specified by df (degrees of freedom) and shades the
area between lowerbound and upperbound.
Shadec
2
(lowerbound,upperbound,df)
Note: For this example,
Xmin = 0
Xmax = 35
Ymin = L.025
Ymax = .1
Shade ( draws the density function for the distribution
specified by numerator df (degrees of freedom) and
denominator df and shades the area between lowerbound and
upperbound.
Shade (lowerbound,upperbound,numerator df,
denominator df)
Note: For this example,
Xmin = 0
Xmax = 5
Ymin = L.25
Ymax = .9
Distribution Shading (continued)
Shade_t(
Shadec
2
(
Shade (
Financial Functions 141
82D362~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:42 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:59
PM Page 1 of 14
14
Financial
Functions
Getting Started: Financing a Car................................................................... 2
Getting Started: Computing Compound Interest ................................ 3
Using the TVM Solver ......................................................................................... 4
Using the Financial Functions........................................................................ 5
Calculating Time Value of Money (TVM).............................................. 6
Calculating Cash Flows...................................................................................... 8
Calculating Amortization................................................................................... 9
Calculating Interest Conversion.................................................................... 12
Finding Days between Dates/Defining Payment Method....................... 13
Using the TVM Variables................................................................................... 14
Contents
142 Financial Functions
82D362~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:42 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:59
PM Page 2 of 14
Getting Started is a fast-paced introduction. Read the chapter for details.
You have found a car you would like to buy. The car costs 9,000. You can afford
payments of 250 per month for four years. What annual percentage rate (APR) will
make it possible for you to afford the car?
1. Press z ~ ~ ~to set the
fixed-decimal mode setting to 2. The
TI-82 STATS will display all numbers with
two decimal places.
2. Press y [FINANCE] to display the
FINANCE CALC menu.
3. Press to select 1:TVM Solver. The TVM
Solver is displayed.
Press 48 to store 48 months to . Press
9000 to store 9,000 to PV. Press
250 to store L250 to PMT. (Negation
indicates cash outflow.) Press 0 to store
0 to FV. Press 12 to store 12 payments
per year to P/Y and 12 compounding periods
per year to C/Y. Setting P/Y to 12 will
compute an annual percentage rate
(compounded monthly) for . Press
to select PMT:END, which indicates that
payments are due at the end of each period.
4. Press } } } } } }to move the cursor to
the prompt. Press [SOLVE] to solve
for . What APR should you look for?
Getting Started: Financing a Car
Financial Functions 143
82D362~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:42 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:59
PM Page 3 of 14
At what annual interest rate, compounded monthly, will 1,250 accumulate to 2,000 in
7 years?
Note: Because there are no payments when you solve compound interest problems, PMT
must be set to 0 and P/Y must be set to 1.
1. Press y [FINANCE] to display the FINANCE
CALC menu.
2. Press to select 1:TVM Solver. Press 7 to
enter the number of periods in years. Press
1250 to enter the present value as a cash
outflow (investment). Press 0 to specify no
payments. Press 2000 to enter the future
value as a cash inflow (return). Press 1 to
enter payment periods per year. Press 12 to
set compounding periods per year to 12.
3. Press } } } } } to place the cursor on the
prompt.
4. Press [SOLVE] to solve for , the
annual interest rate.
Getting Started: Computing Compound Interest
144 Financial Functions
82D362~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:42 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:59
PM Page 4 of 14
The TVM Solver displays the time-value-of-money (TVM)
variables. Given four variable values, the TVM Solver solves for
the fifth variable.
The FINANCE VARS menu section (page 14.14) describes the
five TVM variables ( , , PV, PMT, and FV) and P/Y and C/Y.
PMT: END BEGIN in the TVM Solver corresponds to the
FINANCE CALC menu items Pmt_End (payment at the end of
each period) and Pmt_Bgn (payment at the beginning of each
period).
To solve for an unknown TVM variable, follow these steps.
1. Press y [FINANCE] to display the TVM Solver. The
screen below shows the default values with the fixed-
decimal mode set to two decimal places.
2. Enter the known values for four TVM variables.
Note: Enter cash inflows as positive numbers and cash
outflows as negative numbers.
3. Enter a value for P/Y, which automatically enters the same
value for C/Y; if P/Y C/Y, enter a unique value for C/Y.
4. Select END or BEGIN to specify the payment method.
5. Place the cursor on the TVM variable for which you want to
solve.
6. Press [SOLVE]. The answer is computed, displayed in
the TVM Solver, and stored to the appropriate TVM variable.
An indicator square in the left column designates the solution
variable.
Using the TVM Solver
Using the TVM
Solver
Financial Functions 145
82D362~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:42 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:59
PM Page 5 of 14
When using the TI-82 STATS financial functions, you must
enter cash inflows (cash received) as positive numbers and cash
outflows (cash paid) as negative numbers. The TI-82 STATS
follows this convention when computing and displaying
answers.
To display the FINANCE CALC menu, press y [FINANCE].
CAL
C
VARS
1: TVM Solver... Displays the TVM Solver.
2: tvm_Pmt Computes the amount of each payment.
3: tvm_ Computes the interest rate per year.
4: tvm_PV Computes the present value.
5: tvm_ Computes the number of payment periods.
6: tvm_FV Computes the future value.
7: npv( Computes the net present value.
8: irr( Computes the internal rate of return.
9: bal( Computes the amortization sched. balance.
0: GPrn( Computes the amort. sched. principal sum.
A: GInt( Computes the amort. sched. interest sum.
B: 4Nom( Computes the nominal interest rate.
C: 4Eff( Computes the effective interest rate.
D: dbd( Calculates the days between two dates.
E: Pmt_End Selects ordinary annuity (end of period).
F: Pmt_Bgn Selects annuity due (beginning of period).
Use these functions to set up and perform financial calculations
on the home screen.
TVM Solver displays the TVM Solver (page 14.4).
Using the Financial Functions
Entering Cash
Inflows and Cash
Outflows
FINANCE CALC
Menu
TVM Solver
146 Financial Functions
82D362~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:42 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:59
PM Page 6 of 14
Use time-value-of-money (TVM) functions (menu items 2
through 6) to analyze financial instruments such as annuities,
loans, mortgages, leases, and savings.
Each TVM function takes zero to six arguments, which must be
real numbers. The values that you specify as arguments for
these functions are not stored to the TVM variables (page 14.14).
Note: To store a value to a TVM variable, use the TVM Solver (page
14.4) or use and any TVM variable on the FINANCE VARS
menu (page 14.14).
If you enter less than six arguments, the TI-82 STATS
substitutes a previously stored TVM variable value for each
unspecified argument.
If you enter any arguments with a TVM function, you must place
the argument or arguments in parentheses.
tvm_Pmt computes the amount of each payment.
tvm_Pmt[(,,PV,FV,P/Y,C/Y)]
Note: In the example above, the values are stored to the TVM
variables in the TVM Solver. Then the payment (tvm_Pmt) is
computed on the home screen using the values in the TVM Solver.
Next, the interest rate is changed to 9.5 to illustrate the effect on the
payment amount.
Calculating Time Value of Money (TVM)
Calculating Time
Value of Money
tvm_Pmt
Financial Functions 147
82D362~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:42 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:59
PM Page 7 of 14
tvm_ computes the annual interest rate.
tvm_ [(,PV,PMT,FV,P/Y,C/Y)]
tvm_PV computes the present value.
tvm_PV[(,,PMT,FV,P/Y,C/Y)]
tvm_ computes the number of payment periods.
tvm_ [(,PV,PMT,FV,P/Y,C/Y)]
tvm_FV computes the future value.
tvm_FV[(,,PV,PMT,P/Y,C/Y)]
tvm_
tvm_PV
tvm_
tvm_FV
148 Financial Functions
82D362~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:42 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:59
PM Page 8 of 14
Use the cash flow functions (menu items 7 and 8) to analyze the
value of money over equal time periods. You can enter unequal
cash flows, which can be cash inflows or outflows. The syntax
descriptions for npv( and irr( use these arguments.
interest rate is the rate by which to discount the cash flows
(the cost of money) over one period.
CF0 is the initial cash flow at time 0; it must be a real
number.
CFList is a list of cash flow amounts after the initial cash
flow CF0.
CFFreq is a list in which each element specifies the
frequency of occurrence for a grouped (consecutive) cash
flow amount, which is the corresponding element of CFList.
The default is 1; if you enter values, they must be positive
integers < 10,000.
For example, express this uneven cash flow in lists.
2000
4000 2000 2000
- 3000
4000
CF0 = 2000
CFList = {2000,L3000,4000}
CFFreq = {2,1,2}
npv( (net present value) is the sum of the present values for the
cash inflows and outflows. A positive result for npv indicates a
profitable investment.
npv(interest rate,CF0,CFList[,CFFreq])
irr( (internal rate of return) is the interest rate at which the net
present value of the cash flows is equal to zero.
irr(CF0,CFList[,CFFreq])
3000
5000
1000
- 2000 - 2500
0
Calculating Cash Flows
Calculating a
Cash Flow
npv(, irr(
Financial Functions 149
82D362~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:42 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:59
PM Page 9 of 14
Use the amortization functions (menu items 9, 0, and A) to
calculate balance, sum of principal, and sum of interest for an
amortization schedule.
bal( computes the balance for an amortization schedule using
stored values for , PV, and PMT. npmt is the number of the
payment at which you want to calculate a balance. It must be a
positive integer < 10,000. roundvalue specifies the internal
precision the calculator uses to calculate the balance; if you do
not specify roundvalue, then the TI-82 STATS uses the current
Float/Fix decimal-mode setting.
bal(npmt[,roundvalue])
GPrn( computes the sum of the principal during a specified period
for an amortization schedule using stored values for , PV, and
PMT. pmt1 is the starting payment. pmt2 is the ending payment in
the range. pmt1 and pmt2 must be positive integers < 10,000.
roundvalue specifies the internal precision the calculator uses to
calculate the principal; if you do not specify roundvalue, the
TI-82 STATS uses the current Float/Fix decimal-mode setting.
Note: You must enter values for , PV, PMT, and before computing
the principal.
GPrn(pmt1,pmt2[,roundvalue])
GInt( computes the sum of the interest during a specified period
for an amortization schedule using stored values for , PV, and
PMT. pmt1 is the starting payment. pmt2 is the ending payment
in the range. pmt1 and pmt2 must be positive integers < 10,000.
roundvalue specifies the internal precision the calculator uses to
calculate the interest; if you do not specify roundvalue, the
TI-82 STATS uses the current Float/Fix decimal-mode setting.
GInt(pmt1,pmt2[,roundvalue])
Calculating Amortization
Calculating an
Amortization
Schedule
bal(
GPrn(, GInt(
1410 Financial Functions
82D362~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:42 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:59
PM Page 10 of 14
You want to buy a home with a 30-year mortgage at 8 percent
APR. Monthly payments are 800. Calculate the outstanding loan
balance after each payment and display the results in a graph
and in the table.
1. Press z. Press ~ ~ ~ to set the fixed-decimal
mode setting to 2. Press ~ to select Par graphing
mode.
2. Press y [FINANCE] to display the TVM Solver.
3. Press 360 to enter number of payments. Press 8 to enter
the interest rate. Press 800 to enter the payment
amount. Press 0 to enter the future value of the mortgage.
Press 12 to enter the payments per year, which also sets
the compounding periods per year to 12. Press
to select PMT:END.
4. Press } } } } } to place the cursor on the PV prompt. Press
[SOLVE] to solve for the present value.
5. Press o to display the parametric Y= editor. Turn off all stat
plots. Press to define X1T as T. Press y
[FINANCE] 9 to define Y1T as bal(T).
Calculating Amortization (continued)
Amortization
Example:
Calculating an
Outstanding
Loan Balance
Financial Functions 1411
82D362~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:42 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:59
PM Page 11 of 14
6. Press p to display the window variables. Enter the
values below.
Tmin=0 Xmin=0 Ymin=0
Tmax=360 Xmax=360 Ymax=125000
Tstep=12 Xscl=50 Yscl=10000
7. Press r to draw the graph and activate the trace cursor.
Press ~ and | to explore the graph of the outstanding balance
over time. Press a number and then press to view the
balance at a specific time T.
8. Press y [TBLSET] and enter the values below.
TblStart=0
@Tbl=12
9. Press y [TABLE] to display the table of outstanding
balances (Y1T).
10. Press z ~ ~ to select G.T
split-screen mode, in which the graph and table are displayed
simultaneously.
Press r to display X1T (time) and Y1T (balance) in the
table.
Amortization
Example:
Calculating an
Outstanding
Loan Balance
(continued)
1412 Financial Functions
82D362~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:42 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:59
PM Page 12 of 14
Use the interest conversion functions (menu items B and C) to
convert interest rates from an annual effective rate to a nominal
rate (4Nom( ) or from a nominal rate to an annual effective rate
(4Eff( ).
4Nom( computes the nominal interest rate. effective rate and
compounding periods must be real numbers. compounding
periods must be >0.
4Nom(effective rate,compounding periods)
4Eff( computes the effective interest rate. nominal rate and
compounding periods must be real numbers. compounding
periods must be >0.
4Eff(nominal rate,compounding periods)
Calculating Interest Conversion
Calculating an
Interest
Conversion
4Nom(
4Eff(
Financial Functions 1413
82D362~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:42 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:59
PM Page 13 of 14
Use the date function dbd( (menu item D) to calculate the
number of days between two dates using the actual-day-count
method. date1 and date2 can be numbers or lists of numbers
within the range of the dates on the standard calendar.
Note: Dates must be between the years 1950 through 2049.
dbd(date1,date2)
You can enter date1 and date2 in either of two formats.
MM.DDYY (United States)
DDMM.YY (Europe)
The decimal placement differentiates the date formats.
Pmt_End and Pmt_Bgn (menu items E and F) specify a
transaction as an ordinary annuity or an annuity due. When you
execute either command, the TVM Solver is updated.
Pmt_End (payment end) specifies an ordinary annuity, where
payments occur at the end of each payment period. Most loans
are in this category. Pmt_End is the default.
Pmt_End
On the TVM Solvers PMT:END BEGIN line, select END to set
PMT to ordinary annuity.
Pmt_Bgn (payment beginning) specifies an annuity due, where
payments occur at the beginning of each payment period. Most
leases are in this category.
Pmt_Bgn
On the TVM Solvers PMT:END BEGIN line, select BEGIN to set
PMT to annuity due.
Finding Days between Dates/Defining Payment Method
dbd(
Defining the
Payment Method
Pmt_End
Pmt_Bgn
1414 Financial Functions
82D362~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:42 PM Printed: 10/27/05 2:59
PM Page 14 of 14
To display the FINANCE VARS menu, press y [FINANCE] ~.
You can use TVM variables in TVM functions and store values to
them on the home screen.
CALC VAR
S
1: Total number of payment periods
2: Annual interest rate
3: PV Present value
4: PMT Payment amount
5: FV Future value
6: P/Y Number of payment periods per year
7: C/Y Number of compounding periods/year
, , PV, PMT, and FV are the five TVM variables. They
represent the elements of common financial transactions, as
described in the table above. is an annual interest rate that is
converted to a per-period rate based on the values of P/Y and
C/Y.
P/Y is the number of payment periods per year in a financial
transaction.
C/Y is the number of compounding periods per year in the same
transaction.
When you store a value to P/Y, the value for C/Y automatically
changes to the same value. To store a unique value to C/Y, you
must store the value to C/Y after you have stored a value to P/Y.
Using the TVM Variables
FINANCE VARS
Menu
, , PV, PMT,
FV
P/Y and C/Y
CATALOG, Strings, Hyperbolic Functions 151
82500E~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 9:25 AM Printed: 10/28/05 9:25
AM Page 1 of 10
15
CATALOG, Strings,
Hyperbolic Functions
Browsing the TI-82 STATS CATALOG.................................................. 2
Entering and Using Strings............................................................................... 3
Storing Strings to String Variables.............................................................. 4
String Functions and Instructions in the CATALOG........................ 6
Hyperbolic Functions in the CATALOG.................................................. 10
Contents
152 CATALOG, Strings, Hyperbolic Functions
82500E~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 9:25 AM Printed: 10/28/05 9:25
AM Page 2 of 10
The CATALOG is an alphabetical list of all functions and
instructions on the TI-82 STATS. You also can access each
CATALOG item from a menu or the keyboard, except:
The six string functions (page 15.6)
The six hyperbolic functions (page 15.10)
The solve( instruction without the equation solver editor
(Chapter 2)
The inferential stat functions without the inferential stat
editors (Chapter 13)
Note: The only CATALOG programming commands you can execute
from the home screen are GetCalc(, Get(, and Send(.
To select a CATALOG item, follow these steps.
1. Press y CATALOG to display the CATALOG.
The 4 in the first column is the selection cursor.
2. Press or } to scroll the CATALOG until the selection
cursor points to the item you want.
To jump to the first item beginning with a particular
letter, press that letter; alpha-lock is on.
Items that begin with a number are in alphabetical order
according to the first letter after the number. For
example, 2.PropZTest( is among the items that begin
with the letter P.
Functions that appear as symbols, such as +,
L1
, <, and
(, follow the last item that begins with Z. To jump to the
first symbol, !, press [q].
3. Press to paste the item to the current screen.
Tip: From the top of the CATALOG menu, press } to move to the
bottom. From the bottom, press to move to the top.
Browsing the TI-82 STATS CATALOG
What Is the
CATALOG?
Selecting an Item
from the
CATALOG
CATALOG, Strings, Hyperbolic Functions 153
82500E~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 9:25 AM Printed: 10/28/05 9:25
AM Page 3 of 10
A string is a sequence of characters that you enclose within
quotation marks. On the TI-82 STATS, a string has two primary
applications.
It defines text to be displayed in a program.
It accepts input from the keyboard in a program.
Characters are the units that you combine to form a string.
Count each number, letter, and space as one character.
Count each instruction or function name, such as sin( or
cos(, as one character; the TI-82 STATS interprets each
instruction or function name as one character.
To enter a string on a blank line on the home screen or in a
program, follow these steps.
1. Press [] to indicate the beginning of the string.
2. Enter the characters that comprise the string.
Use any combination of numbers, letters, function names,
or instruction names to create the string.
To enter a blank space, press ['].
To enter several alpha characters in a row, press y
[A.LOCK] to activate alpha-lock.
3. Press [] to indicate the end of the string.
"string"
4. Press . On the home screen, the string is displayed on
the next line without quotations. An ellipsis (...) indicates
that the string continues beyond the screen. To scroll the
entire string, press ~ and |.
Note: Quotation marks do not count as string characters.
Entering and Using Strings
What Is a String?
Entering a String
154 CATALOG, Strings, Hyperbolic Functions
82500E~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 9:25 AM Printed: 10/28/05 9:25
AM Page 4 of 10
The TI-82 STATS has 10 variables to which you can store
strings. You can use string variables with string functions and
instructions.
To display the VARS STRING menu, follow these steps.
1. Press to display the VARS menu. Move the cursor to
7:String.
2. Press to display the STRING secondary menu.
Storing Strings to String Variables
String Variables
CATALOG, Strings, Hyperbolic Functions 155
82500E~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 9:25 AM Printed: 10/28/05 9:25
AM Page 5 of 10
To store a string to a string variable, follow these steps.
1. Press [], enter the string, and press [].
2. Press .
3. Press 7 to display the VARS STRING menu.
4. Select the string variable (from Str1 to Str9, or Str0) to
which you want to store the string.
The string variable is pasted to the current cursor location,
next to the store symbol (! !! !).
5. Press to store the string to the string variable. On the
home screen, the stored string is displayed on the next line
without quotation marks.
To display the contents of a string variable on the home screen,
select the string variable from the VARS STRING menu, and
then press . The string is displayed.
Storing a String
to a String
Variable
Displaying the
Contents of a
String Variable
156 CATALOG, Strings, Hyperbolic Functions
82500E~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 9:25 AM Printed: 10/28/05 9:25
AM Page 6 of 10
String functions and instructions are available only from the
CATALOG. The table below lists the string functions and
instructions in the order in which they appear among the other
CATALOG menu items. The ellipses in the table indicate the
presence of additional CATALOG items.
CATALOG
...
Equ4String( Converts an equation to a string.
expr( Converts a string to an expression.
...
inString( Returns a characters place number.
...
length( Returns a strings character length.
...
String4Equ( Converts a string to an equation.
sub( Returns a string subset as a string.
...
To concatenate two or more strings, follow these steps.
1. Enter string1, which can be a string or string name.
2. Press .
3. Enter string2, which can be a string or string name. If
necessary, press and enter string3, and so on.
string1+string2+string3. . .
4. Press to display the strings as a single string.
To select a string function or instruction and paste it to the
current screen, follow the steps on page 15.2.
String Functions and Instructions in the CATALOG
Displaying String
Functions and
Instructions in
the CATALOG
+ (Concatenation)
Selecting a String
Function from
the CATALOG
CATALOG, Strings, Hyperbolic Functions 157
82500E~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 9:25 AM Printed: 10/28/05 9:25
AM Page 7 of 10
Equ4String( converts to a string an equation that is stored to any
VARS Y.VARS variable. Yn contains the equation. Strn (from
Str1 to Str9, or Str0) is the string variable to which you want the
equation to be stored as a string.
Equ4String(Yn,Strn)
expr( converts the character string contained in string to an
expression and executes it. string can be a string or a string
variable.
expr(string)
inString( returns the character position in string of the first
character of substring. string can be a string or a string variable.
start is an optional character position at which to start the
search; the default is 1.
inString(string,substring[,start])
Note: If string does not contain substring, or start is greater than the
length of string, inString( returns 0.
Equ4String(
expr(
inString(
158 CATALOG, Strings, Hyperbolic Functions
82500E~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 9:25 AM Printed: 10/28/05 9:25
AM Page 8 of 10
length( returns the number of characters in string. string can be
a string or string variable.
Note: An instruction or function name, such as sin( or cos(, counts
as one character.
length(string)
String4Equ( converts string into an equation and stores the
equation to Yn. string can be a string or string variable.
String4Equ( is the inverse of Equ4String(.
String4Equ(string,Yn)
String Functions and Instructions in the CATALOG (cont.)
length(
String4Equ(
CATALOG, Strings, Hyperbolic Functions 159
82500E~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 9:25 AM Printed: 10/28/05 9:25
AM Page 9 of 10
sub( returns a string that is a subset of an existing string. string
can be a string or a string variable. begin is the position number
of the first character of the subset. length is the number of
characters in the subset.
sub(string,begin,length)
In a program, you can enter a function to graph during program
execution using these commands.
Note: When you execute this program, enter a function to store to Y3
at the ENTRY= prompt.
sub(
Entering a
Function to
Graph during
Program
Execution
1510 CATALOG, Strings, Hyperbolic Functions
82500E~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 9:25 AM Printed: 10/28/05 9:25
AM Page 10 of 10
The hyperbolic functions are available only from the CATALOG.
The table below lists the hyperbolic functions in the order in
which they appear among the other CATALOG menu items. The
ellipses in the table indicate the presence of additional
CATALOG items.
CATALOG
...
cosh( Hyperbolic cosine
cosh
L1
( Hyperbolic arccosine
...
sinh( Hyperbolic sine
sinh
L1
( Hyperbolic arcsine
...
tanh( Hyperbolic tangent
tanh
L1
( Hyperbolic arctangent
...
sinh(, cosh(, and tanh( are the hyperbolic functions. Each is
valid for real numbers, expressions, and lists.
sinh(value)
cosh(value)
tanh(value)
sinh
L1
( is the hyperbolic arcsine function. cosh
L1
( is the
hyperbolic arccosine function. tanh
L1
( is the hyperbolic
arctangent function. Each is valid for real numbers, expressions,
and lists.
sinh
L1
(value)
cosh
L1
(value)
sinh
L1
(value)
Hyperbolic Functions in the CATALOG
Hyperbolic
Functions
sinh(, cosh(,
tanh(
sinh
L1
(, cosh
L1
(,
tanh
L1
(
Programming 161
82E978~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:47 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:02
PM Page 1 of 22
16
Programming
Getting Started: Volume of a Cylinder..................................................... 2
Creating and Deleting Programs................................................................... 4
Entering Command Lines and Executing Programs ........................ 5
Editing Programs .................................................................................................... 6
Copying and Renaming Programs............................................................... 7
PRGM CTL (Control) Instructions.............................................................. 8
PRGM I/O (Input/Output) Instructions..................................................... 16
Calling Other Programs as Subroutines ................................................... 22
Contents
162 Programming
82E978~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:47 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:02
PM Page 2 of 22
Getting Started is a fast-paced introduction. Read the chapter for details.
A program is a set of commands that the TI-82 STATS executes sequentially, as if
you had entered them from the keyboard. Create a program that prompts for the
radius R and the height H of a cylinder and then computes its volume.
1. Press ~ ~ to display the PRGM NEW
menu.
2. Press to select 1:Create New. The
Name= prompt is displayed, and alpha-lock is
on. Press [C] [Y] [L] [I] [N] [D] [E] [R], and then
press to name the program CYLINDER.
You are now in the program editor. The colon
( : ) in the first column of the second line
indicates the beginning of a command line.
3. Press ~ 2 to select 2:Prompt from the
PRGM I/O menu. Prompt is copied to the
command line. Press [R] [H]
to enter the variable names for radius and
height. Press .
4. Press y p [R] [H]
[V] to enter the expression pR
2
H
and store it to the variable V.
Getting Started: Volume of a Cylinder
Programming 163
82E978~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:47 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:02
PM Page 3 of 22
5. Press ~ 3 to select 3:Disp from the
PRGM I/O menu. Disp is pasted to the
command line. Press y[A.LOCK] [V] [O]
[L] [U] [M] [E]['] [I] [S]
[V] to set up the program to display the
text VOLUME IS on one line and the calculated
value of V on the next.
6. Press y [QUIT] to display the home screen.
7. Press to display the PRGM EXEC menu.
The items on this menu are the names of stored
programs.
8. Press to paste prgmCYLINDER to the
current cursor location. (If CYLINDER is not
item 1 on your PRGM EXEC menu, move the
cursor to CYLINDER before you press .)
9. Press to execute the program. Enter 1.5
for the radius, and then press . Enter 3
for the height, and then press . The text
VOLUME IS, the value of V, and Done are
displayed.
Repeat steps 7 through 9 and enter different
values for R and H.
164 Programming
82E978~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:47 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:02
PM Page 4 of 22
A program is a set of one or more command lines. Each line
contains one or more instructions. When you execute a program,
the TI-82 STATS performs each instruction on each command
line in the same order in which you entered them. The number
and size of programs that the TI-82 STATS can store is limited
only by available memory.
To create a new program, follow these steps.
1. Press | to display the PRGM NEW menu.
2. Press to select 1:Create New. The Name= prompt is
displayed, and alpha-lock is on.
3. Press a letter from A to Z or q to enter the first character of
the new program name.
Note: A program name can be one to eight characters long. The
first character must be a letter from A to Z or q. The second
through eighth characters can be letters, numbers, or q.
4. Enter zero to seven letters, numbers, or q to complete the
new program name.
5. Press . The program editor is displayed.
6. Enter one or more program commands (page 16.5).
7. Press y [QUIT] to leave the program editor and return to
the home screen.
To check whether adequate memory is available for a program
you want to enter, press y [MEM], and then select
1:Check RAM from the MEMORY menu (Chapter 18).
To increase available memory, press y [MEM], and then select
2:Delete from the MEMORY menu (Chapter 18).
To delete a specific program, press y [MEM], select 2:Delete
from the MEMORY menu, and then select 7:Prgm from the
DELETE FROM secondary menu (Chapter 18).
Creating and Deleting Programs
What Is a
Program?
Creating a New
Program
Managing
Memory and
Deleting a
Program
Programming 165
82E978~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:47 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:02
PM Page 5 of 22
You can enter on a command line any instruction or expression
that you could execute from the home screen. In the program
editor, each new command line begins with a colon. To enter more
than one instruction or expression on a single command line,
separate each with a colon.
Note: A command line can be longer than the screen is wide;
long command lines wrap to the next screen line.
While in the program editor, you can display and select from
menus. You can return to the program editor from a menu in
either of two ways.
Select a menu item, which pastes the item to the current
command line.
Press .
When you complete a command line, press . The cursor
moves to the next command line.
Programs can access variables, lists, matrices, and strings saved
in memory. If a program stores a new value to a variable, list,
matrix, or string, the program changes the value in memory
during execution.
You can call another program as a subroutine (page 16.15 and
page 16.22).
To execute a program, begin on a blank line on the home screen
and follow these steps.
1. Press to display the PRGM EXEC menu.
2. Select a program name from the PRGM EXEC menu (page
16.7). prgmname is pasted to the home screen (for example,
prgmCYLINDER).
3. Press to execute the program. While the program is
executing, the busy indicator is on.
Last Answer (Ans) is updated during program execution. Last
Entry is not updated as each command is executed (Chapter 1).
The TI-82 STATS checks for errors during program execution.
It does not check for errors as you enter a program.
To stop program execution, press . The ERR:BREAK menu is
displayed.
To return to the home screen, select 1:Quit.
To go where the interruption occurred, select 2:Goto.
Entering Command Lines and Executing Programs
Entering a
Program
Command Line
Executing a
Program
Breaking a
Program
166 Programming
82E978~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:47 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:02
PM Page 6 of 22
To edit a stored program, follow these steps.
1. Press ~ to display the PRGM EDIT menu.
2. Select a program name from the PRGM EDIT menu (page
16.7). Up to the first seven lines of the program are
displayed.
Note: The program editor does not display a $ to indicate that
a program continues beyond the screen.
3. Edit the program command lines.
Move the cursor to the appropriate location, and then
delete, overwrite, or insert.
Press to clear all program commands on the
command line (the leading colon remains), and then enter
a new program command.
Tip: To move the cursor to the beginning of a command line, press
y |; to move to the end, press y ~. To scroll the cursor down
seven command lines, press . To scroll the cursor up seven
command lines, press }.
To insert a new command line anywhere in the program, place
the cursor where you want the new line, press y [INS], and
then press . A colon indicates a new line.
To delete a command line, place the cursor on the line, press
to clear all instructions and expressions on the line, and
then press { to delete the command line, including the colon.
Editing Programs
Editing a
Program
Inserting and
Deleting
Command Lines
Programming 167
82E978~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:47 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:02
PM Page 7 of 22
To copy all command lines from one program into a new
program, follow steps 1 through 5 for Creating a New Program
(page 16.4), and then follow these steps.
1. Press y [RCL]. Rcl is displayed on the bottom line of the
program editor in the new program (Chapter 1).
2. Press | to display the PRGM EXEC menu.
3. Select a name from the menu. prgmname is pasted to the
bottom line of the program editor.
4. Press . All command lines from the selected program
are copied into the new program.
Copying programs has at least two convenient applications.
You can create a template for groups of instructions that you
use frequently.
You can rename a program by copying its contents into a
new program.
Note: You also can copy all the command lines from one existing
program to another existing program using RCL.
The TI-82 STATS sorts PRGM EXEC and PRGM EDIT menu
items automatically into alphanumerical order. Each menu only
labels the first 10 items using 1 through 9, then 0.
To jump to the first program name that begins with a particular
alpha character or q, press [letter from A to Z or q].
Tip: From the top of either the PRGM EXEC or PRGM EDIT menu,
press } to move to the bottom. From the bottom, press to move to
the top. To scroll the cursor down the menu seven items, press
. To scroll the cursor up the menu seven items, press }.
Copying and Renaming Programs
Copying and
Renaming a
Program
Scrolling the
PRGM EXEC and
PRGM EDIT
Menus
168 Programming
82E978~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:47 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:02
PM Page 8 of 22
To display the PRGM CTL (program control) menu, press
from the program editor only.
CTL I/O EXEC
1: If Creates a conditional test.
2: Then Executes commands when If is true.
3: Else Executes commands when If is false.
4: For( Creates an incrementing loop.
5: While Creates a conditional loop.
6: Repeat Creates a conditional loop.
7: End Signifies the end of a block.
8: Pause Pauses program execution.
9: Lbl Defines a label.
0: Goto Goes to a label.
A: IS>( Increments and skips if greater than.
B: DS<( Decrements and skips if less than.
C: Menu( Defines menu items and branches.
D: prgm Executes a program as a subroutine.
E: Return Returns from a subroutine.
F: Stop Stops execution.
G: DelVar Deletes a variable from within program.
H: GraphStyle( Designates the graph style to be drawn.
These menu items direct the flow of an executing program.
They make it easy to repeat or skip a group of commands during
program execution. When you select an item from the menu, the
name is pasted to the cursor location on a command line in the
program.
To return to the program editor without selecting an item, press
.
Program control instructions tell the TI-82 STATS which
command to execute next in a program. If, While, and Repeat
check a defined condition to determine which command to
execute next. Conditions frequently use relational or Boolean
tests (Chapter 2), as in:
If A<7:A+1! !! !A
or
If N=1 and M=1:Goto Z
PRGM CTL (Control) Instructions
PRGM CTL Menu
Controlling
Program Flow
Programming 169
82E978~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:47 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:02
PM Page 9 of 22
Use If for testing and branching. If condition is false (zero), then
the command immediately following If is skipped. If condition is
true (nonzero), then the next command is executed. If
instructions can be nested.
:If condition
:command (if true)
:command
Program Output
Then following an If executes a group of commands if condition
is true (nonzero). End identifies the end of the group of
commands.
:If condition
:Then
:command (if true)
:command (if true)
:End
:command
Program Output
If
If.Then
1610 Programming
82E978~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:47 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:02
PM Page 10 of 22
Else following If.Then executes a group of commands if
condition is false (zero). End identifies the end of the group of
commands.
:If condition
:Then
:command (if true)
:command (if true)
:Else
:command (if false)
:command (if false)
:End
:command
Program Output
For( loops and increments. It increments variable from begin to
end by increment. increment is optional (default is 1) and can be
negative (end<begin). end is a maximum or minimum value not
to be exceeded. End identifies the end of the loop. For( loops
can be nested.
:For(variable,begin,end[,increment])
:command (while end not exceeded)
:command (while end not exceeded)
:End
:command
Program Output
PRGM CTL (Control) Instructions (continued)
If.Then.Else
For(
Programming 1611
82E978~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:47 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:02
PM Page 11 of 22
While performs a group of commands while condition is true.
condition is frequently a relational test (Chapter 2). condition is
tested when While is encountered. If condition is true (nonzero),
the program executes a group of commands. End signifies the
end of the group. When condition is false (zero), the program
executes each command following End. While instructions can
be nested.
:While condition
:command (while condition is true)
:command (while condition is true)
:End
:command
Program Output
Repeat repeats a group of commands until condition is true
(nonzero). It is similar to While, but condition is tested when
End is encountered; therefore, the group of commands is always
executed at least once. Repeat instructions can be nested.
:Repeat condition
:command (until condition is true)
:command (until condition is true)
:End
:command
Program Output
While
Repeat
1612 Programming
82E978~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:47 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:02
PM Page 12 of 22
End identifies the end of a group of commands. You must
include an End instruction at the end of each For(, While, or
Repeat loop. Also, you must paste an End instruction at the end
of each If.Then group and each If.Then.Else group.
Pause suspends execution of the program so that you can see
answers or graphs. During the pause, the pause indicator is on in
the top-right corner. Press to resume execution.
Pause without a value temporarily pauses the program. If
the DispGraph or Disp instruction has been executed, the
appropriate screen is displayed.
Pause with value displays value on the current home screen.
value can be scrolled.
Pause [value]
Program Output
PRGM CTL (Control) Instructions (continued)
End
Pause
Programming 1613
82E978~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:47 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:02
PM Page 13 of 22
Lbl (label) and Goto (go to) are used together for branching.
Lbl specifies the label for a command. label can be one or two
characters (A through Z, 0 through 99, or q).
Lbl label
Goto causes the program to branch to label when Goto is
encountered.
Goto label
Program Output
IS>( (increment and skip) adds 1 to variable. If the answer is >
value (which can be an expression), the next command is
skipped; if the answer is { value, the next command is executed.
variable cannot be a system variable.
:IS>(variable,value)
:command (if answer value)
:command (if answer > value)
Program Output
Note: IS>( is not a looping instruction.
Lbl, Goto
IS>(
1614 Programming
82E978~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:47 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:02
PM Page 14 of 22
DS<( (decrement and skip) subtracts 1 from variable. If the
answer is < value (which can be an expression), the next
command is skipped; if the answer is | value, the next command
is executed. variable cannot be a system variable.
:DS<(variable,value)
:command (if answer value)
:command (if answer < value)
Program Output
Note: DS<( is not a looping instruction.
Menu( sets up branching within a program. If Menu( is
encountered during program execution, the menu screen is
displayed with the specified menu items, the pause indicator is
on, and execution pauses until you select a menu item.
The menu title is enclosed in quotation marks ( " ). Up to seven
pairs of menu items follow. Each pair comprises a text item
(also enclosed in quotation marks) to be displayed as a menu
selection, and a label item to which to branch if you select the
corresponding menu selection.
Menu("title","text1",label1,"text2",label2, . . .)
Program Output
The program above pauses until you select 1 or 2. If you select
2, for example, the menu disappears and the program continues
execution at Lbl B.
PRGM CTL (Control) Instructions (continued)
DS<(
Menu(
Programming 1615
82E978~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:47 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:02
PM Page 15 of 22
Use prgm to execute other programs as subroutines (page
16.22). When you select prgm, it is pasted to the cursor
location. Enter characters to spell a program name. Using prgm
is equivalent to selecting existing programs from the PRGM
EXEC menu; however, it allows you to enter the name of a
program that you have not yet created.
prgmname
Note: You cannot directly enter the subroutine name when using
RCL. You must paste the name from the PRGM EXEC menu (page
16.7).
Return quits the subroutine and returns execution to the calling
program (page 16.22), even if encountered within nested loops.
Any loops are ended. An implied Return exists at the end of any
program that is called as a subroutine. Within the main program,
Return stops execution and returns to the home screen.
Stop stops execution of a program and returns to the home
screen. Stop is optional at the end of a program.
DelVar deletes from memory the contents of variable.
DelVar variable
GraphStyle( designates the style of the graph to be drawn.
function# is the number of the Y= function name in the current
graphing mode. graphstyle is a number from 1 to 7 that
corresponds to the graph style, as shown below.
1 = (line) 5 = (path)
2 = (thick) 6 = (animate)
3 = (shade above) 7 = (dot)
4 = (shade below)
GraphStyle(function#,graphstyle)
For example, GraphStyle(1,5) in Func mode sets the graph style
for Y1 to (path; 5).
Not all graph styles are available in all graphing modes. For a
detailed description of each graph style, see the Graph Styles
table in Chapter 3.
prgm
Return
Stop
DelVar
GraphStyle(
1616 Programming
82E978~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:47 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:02
PM Page 16 of 22
To display the PRGM I/O (program input/output) menu, press
~ from within the program editor only.
CTL I/O EXEC
1: Input Enters a value or uses the cursor.
2: Prompt Prompts for entry of variable values.
3: Disp Displays text, value, or the home screen.
4: DispGraph Displays the current graph.
5: DispTable Displays the current table.
6: Output( Displays text at a specified position.
7: getKey Checks the keyboard for a keystroke.
8: ClrHome Clears the display.
9: ClrTable Clears the current table.
0: GetCalc( Gets a variable from another TI-82 STATS.
A: Get( Gets a variable from CBL or CBR.
B: Send( Sends a variable to CBL or CBR.
These instructions control input to and output from a program
during execution. They allow you to enter values and display
answers during program execution.
To return to the program editor without selecting an item, press
.
Input without a variable displays the current graph. You can
move the free-moving cursor, which updates X and Y (and R and
q for PolarGC format). The pause indicator is on. Press
to resume program execution.
Input
Program Output
PRGM I/O (Input/Output) Instructions
PRGM I/O Menu
Displaying a
Graph with Input
Programming 1617
82E978~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:47 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:02
PM Page 17 of 22
Input with variable displays a ? (question mark) prompt during
execution. variable may be a real number, complex number, list,
matrix, string, or Y= function. During program execution, enter
a value, which can be an expression, and then press . The
value is evaluated and stored to variable, and the program
resumes execution.
Input [variable]
You can display text or the contents of Strn (a string variable) of
up to 16 characters as a prompt. During program execution,
enter a value after the prompt and then press . The value
is stored to variable, and the program resumes execution.
Input ["text",variable]
Input [Strn,variable]
Program Output
Note: When a program prompts for input of lists and Yn functions
during execution, you must include the braces ( { } ) around the list
elements and quotation marks ( " ) around the expressions.
Storing a
Variable Value
with Input
1618 Programming
82E978~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:47 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:02
PM Page 18 of 22
During program execution, Prompt displays each variable, one
at a time, followed by =?. At each prompt, enter a value or
expression for each variable, and then press . The values
are stored, and the program resumes execution.
Prompt variableA[,variableB,...,variable n]
Program Output
Note: Y= functions are not valid with Prompt.
Disp (display) without a value displays the home screen. To
view the home screen during program execution, follow the
Disp instruction with a Pause instruction.
Disp
Disp with one or more values displays the value of each.
Disp [valueA,valueB,valueC,...,value n]
If value is a variable, the current value is displayed.
If value is an expression, it is evaluated and the result is
displayed on the right side of the next line.
If value is text within quotation marks, it is displayed on the
left side of the current display line. ! !! ! is not valid as text.
Program Output
If Pause is encountered after Disp, the program halts
temporarily so you can examine the screen. To resume
execution, press .
Note: If a matrix or list is too large to display in its entirety, ellipses
(...) are displayed in the last column, but the matrix or list cannot be
scrolled. To scroll, use Pause value (page 16.12).
PRGM I/O (Input/Output) Instructions (continued)
Prompt
Displaying the
Home Screen
Displaying
Values and
Messages
Programming 1619
82E978~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:47 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:02
PM Page 19 of 22
DispGraph (display graph) displays the current graph. If Pause
is encountered after DispGraph, the program halts temporarily
so you can examine the screen. Press to resume
execution.
DispTable (display table) displays the current table. The
program halts temporarily so you can examine the screen. Press
to resume execution.
Output( displays text or value on the current home screen
beginning at row (1 through 8) and column (1 through 16),
overwriting any existing characters.
Tip: You may want to precede Output( with ClrHome (page 16.20).
Expressions are evaluated and values are displayed according to
the current mode settings. Matrices are displayed in entry format
and wrap to the next line. ! !! ! is not valid as text.
Output(row,column,"text")
Output(row,column,value)
Program Output
For Output( on a Horiz split screen, the maximum value for row
is 4.
DispGraph
DispTable
Output(
1620 Programming
82E978~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:47 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:02
PM Page 20 of 22
getKey returns a number corresponding to the last key pressed,
according to the key code diagram below. If no key has been
pressed, getKey returns 0. Use getKey inside loops to transfer
control, for example, when creating video games.
Program Output
Note: , , , and
were pressed during
program execution.
Note: You can press at any time during execution to break the
program (page 16.5).
ClrHome (clear home screen) clears the home screen during
program execution.
ClrTable (clear table) clears the values in the table during
program execution.
PRGM I/O (Input/Output) Instructions (continued)
getKey
TI-82 STATS Key
Code Diagram
ClrHome,
ClrTable
Programming 1621
82E978~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:47 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:02
PM Page 21 of 22
GetCalc( gets the contents of variable on another TI-82 STATS
and stores it to variable on the receiving TI-82 STATS. variable
can be a real or complex number, list element, list name, matrix
element, matrix name, string, Y= variable, graph database, or
picture.
GetCalc(variable)
Note: GetCalc( does not work between TI.82 and TI-82 STATS.
Get( gets data from the Calculator-Based Laboratory (CBL)
System or Calculator-Based Ranger (CBR) and stores it to
variable on the receiving TI-82 STATS. variable can be a real
number, list element, list name, matrix element, matrix name,
string, Y= variable, graph database, or picture.
Get(variable)
Note: If you transfer a program that references the Get( command to
the TI-82 STATS from a TI.82, the TI-82 STATS will interpret it as the
Get( described above. Use GetCalc( to get data from another
TI-82 STATS.
Send( sends the contents of variable to the CBL or CBR. You
cannot use it to send to another TI-82 STATS. variable can be a
real number, list element, list name, matrix element, matrix
name, string, Y= variable, graph database, or picture. variable
can be a list of elements.
Send(variable)
Note: This program gets sound data
and time in seconds from CBL.
Note: You can access Get(, Send(, and GetCalc( from the
CATALOG to execute them from the home screen (Chapter 15).
GetCalc(
Get(, Send(
1622 Programming
82E978~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:47 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:02
PM Page 22 of 22
On the TI-82 STATS, any stored program can be called from
another program as a subroutine. Enter the name of the program
to use as a subroutine on a line by itself.
You can enter a program name on a command line in either of
two ways.
Press | to display the PRGM EXEC menu and select
the name of the program (page 16.7). prgmname is pasted to
the current cursor location on a command line.
Select prgm from the PRGM CTL menu, and then enter the
program name (page 16.15).
prgmname
When prgmname is encountered during execution, the next
command that the program executes is the first command in the
second program. It returns to the subsequent command in the
first program when it encounters either Return or the implied
Return at the end of the second program.
Program Output
&
Subroutine ( '
Variables are global.
label used with Goto and Lbl is local to the program where it is
located. label in one program is not recognized by another
program. You cannot use Goto to branch to a label in another
program.
Return exits a subroutine and returns to the calling program,
even if it is encountered within nested loops.
Calling Other Programs as Subroutines
Calling a
Program from
Another Program
Notes about
Calling Programs
Applications 171
82501F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:49 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:04
PM Page 1 of 20
17
Applications
Comparing Test Results Using Box Plots............................................... 2
Graphing Piecewise Functions....................................................................... 4
Graphing Inequalities........................................................................................... 5
Solving a System of Nonlinear Equations.............................................. 6
Using a Program to Create the Sierpinski Triangle.......................... 7
Graphing Cobweb Attractors .......................................................................... 8
Using a Program to Guess the Coefficients........................................... 9
Graphing the Unit Circle and Trigonometric Curves ...................... 10
Finding the Area between Curves................................................................ 11
Using Parametric Equations: Ferris Wheel Problem........................ 12
Demonstrating the Fundamental Theorem of Calculus.................. 14
Computing Areas of Regular N-Sided Polygons................................ 16
Computing and Graphing Mortgage Payments ................................... 18
Contents
172 Applications
82501F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:49 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:04
PM Page 2 of 20
An experiment found a significant difference between boys and
girls pertaining to their ability to identify objects held in their
left hands, which are controlled by the right side of their brains,
versus their right hands, which are controlled by the left side of
their brains. The TI Graphics team conducted a similar test for
adult men and women.
The test involved 30 small objects, which participants were not
allowed to see. First, they held 15 of the objects one by one in
their left hands and guessed what they were. Then they held the
other 15 objects one by one in their right hands and guessed what
they were. Use box plots to compare visually the correct-guess
data from this table.
Correct Guesses
Women
Left
Women
Right
Men
Left
Men
Right
8 4 7 12
9 1 8 6
12 8 7 12
11 12 5 12
10 11 7 7
8 11 8 11
12 13 11 12
7 12 4 8
9 11 10 12
11 12 14 11
13 9
5 9
1. Press 5 to select 5:SetUpEditor. Enter list names
WLEFT, WRGHT, MLEFT, and MRGHT, separated by
commas. Press . The stat list editor now contains only
these four lists.
2. Press 1 to select 1:Edit.
3. Enter into WLEFT the number of correct guesses each woman
made using her left hand (Women Left). Press ~ to move to
WRGHT and enter the number of correct guesses each woman
made using her right hand (Women Right).
4. Likewise, enter each mans correct guesses in MLEFT (Men
Left) and MRGHT (Men Right).
5. Press y [STAT PLOT]. Select 1:Plot1. Turn on plot 1; define it
as a modified box plot that uses WLEFT. Move the cursor
to the top line and select Plot2. Turn on plot 2; define it as a
modified box plot that uses WRGHT.
Comparing Test Results Using Box Plots
Problem
Procedure
Applications 173
82501F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:49 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:04
PM Page 3 of 20
6. Press o. Turn off all functions.
7. Press p. Set Xscl=1 and Yscl=0. Press q 9 to
select 9:ZoomStat. This adjusts the viewing window and
displays the box plots for the womens results.
8. Press r.
%Womens left-hand data
%Womens right-hand data
Use | and ~ to examine minX, Q1, Med, Q3, and maxX for
each plot. Notice the outlier to the womens right-hand data.
What is the median for the left hand? For the right hand?
With which hand were the women more accurate guessers,
according to the box plots?
9. Examine the mens results. Redefine plot 1 to use MLEFT,
redefine plot 2 to use MRGHT. Press r.
%Mens left-hand data
%Mens right-hand data
Press | and ~ to examine minX, Q1, Med, Q3, and maxX
for each plot. What difference do you see between the plots?
10. Compare the left-hand results. Redefine plot 1 to use
WLEFT, redefine plot 2 to use MLEFT, and then press r
to examine minX, Q1, Med, Q3, and maxX for each plot. Who
were the better left-hand guessers, men or women?
11. Compare the right-hand results. Define plot 1 to use WRGHT,
define plot 2 to use MRGHT, and then press r to examine
minX, Q1, Med, Q3, and maxX for each plot. Who were the
better right-hand guessers?
In the original experiment boys did not guess as well with
right hands, while girls guessed equally well with either
hand. This is not what our box plots show for adults. Do you
think that this is because adults have learned to adapt or
because our sample was not large enough?
Procedure
(continued)
174 Applications
82501F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:49 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:04
PM Page 4 of 20
The fine for speeding on a road with a speed limit of 45
kilometers per hour (kph) is 50; plus 5 for each kph from 46 to
55 kph; plus 10 for each kph from 56 to 65 kph; plus 20 for each
kph from 66 kph and above. Graph the piecewise function that
describes the cost of the ticket.
The fine (Y) as a function of kilometers per hour (X) is:
Y = 0 0 < X 45
Y = 50 + 5 (X N 45) 45 < X 55
Y = 50 + 5 10 + 10 (X N 55) 55 < X 65
Y = 50 + 5 10 + 10 10 + 20 (X N 65) 65 < X
1. Press z. Select Func and the default settings.
2. Press o. Turn off all functions and stat plots. Enter the
Y= function to describe the fine. Use the TEST menu
operations to define the piecewise function. Set the graph
style for Y1 to (dot).
3. Press p and set Xmin=L2, Xscl=10, Ymin=L5, and
Yscl=10. Ignore Xmax and Ymax; they are set by @X and @Y
in step 4.
4. Press y [QUIT] to return to the home screen. Store 1 to @X,
and then store 5 to @Y. @X and @Y are on the VARS Window
X/Y secondary menu. @X and @Y specify the horizontal and
vertical distance between the centers of adjacent pixels.
Integer values for @X and @Y produce nice values for tracing.
5. Press r to plot the function. At what speed does the
ticket exceed 250?
Graphing Piecewise Functions
Problem
Procedure
Applications 175
82501F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:49 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:04
PM Page 5 of 20
Graph the inequality 0.4X
3
N 3X + 5 < 0.2X + 4. Use the TEST
menu operations to explore the values of X where the inequality
is true and where it is false.
1. Press z. Select Dot, Simul, and the default settings.
Setting Dot mode changes all graph style icons to (dot) in
the Y= editor.
2. Press o. Turn off all functions and stat plots. Enter the left
side of the inequality as Y4 and the right side as Y5.
3. Enter the statement of the inequality as Y6. This function
evaluates to 1 if true or 0 if false.
4. Press q 6 to graph the inequality in the standard
window.
5. Press r to move to Y6. Then press | and ~ to
trace the inequality, observing the value of Y.
6. Press o. Turn off Y4, Y5, and Y6. Enter equations to graph
only the inequality.
7. Press r. Notice that the values of Y7 and Y8 are zero
where the inequality is false.
Graphing Inequalities
Problem
Procedure
176 Applications
82501F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:49 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:04
PM Page 6 of 20
Using a graph, solve the equation X
3
N 2X = 2cos(X). Stated
another way, solve the system of two equations and two
unknowns: Y = X
3
N2X and Y = 2cos(X). Use ZOOM factors to
control the decimal places displayed on the graph.
1. Press z. Select the default mode settings. Press o. Turn
off all functions and stat plots. Enter the functions.
2. Press q 4 to select 4:ZDecimal. The display shows that
two solutions may exist (points where the two functions
appear to intersect).
3. Press q ~ 4 to select 4:SetFactors from the ZOOM
MEMORY menu. Set XFact=10 and YFact=10.
4. Press q 2 to select 2:Zoom In. Use |, ~, }, and to
move the free-moving cursor onto the apparent intersection
of the functions on the right side of the display. As you move
the cursor, notice that the X and Y values have one decimal
place.
5. Press to zoom in. Move the cursor over the
intersection. As you move the cursor, notice that now the X
and Y values have two decimal places.
6. Press to zoom in again. Move the free-moving cursor
onto a point exactly on the intersection. Notice the number
of decimal places.
7. Press y [CALC] 5 to select 5:intersect. Press to
select the first curve and to select the second curve.
To guess, move the trace cursor near the intersection. Press
. What are the coordinates of the intersection point?
8. Press q 4 to select 4:ZDecimal to redisplay the original
graph.
9. Press q. Select 2:Zoom In and repeat steps 4 through 8
to explore the apparent function intersection on the left side
of the display.
Solving a System of Nonlinear Equations
Problem
Procedure
Applications 177
82501F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:49 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:04
PM Page 7 of 20
This program creates a drawing of a famous fractal, the
Sierpinski Triangle, and stores the drawing to a picture. To
begin, press ~ ~ 1. Name the program SIERPINS, and
then press . The program editor is displayed.
PROGRAM:SIERPINS
:FnOff :ClrDraw
:PlotsOff
:AxesOff
:0! !! !Xmin:1! !! !Xmax
:0! !! !Ymin:1! !! !Ymax
Set viewing window.
:rand! !! !X:rand! !! !Y
:For(K,1,3000)
:rand! !! !N
Beginning of For group.
:If N13
:Then
:.5X! !! !X
:.5Y! !! !Y
:End
If/Then group
:If 13<N and N23
:Then
:.5(.5+X)! !! !X
:.5(1+Y)! !! !Y
:End
If/Then group.
:If 23<N
:Then
:.5(1+X)! !! !X
:.5Y! !! !Y
:End
If/Then group.
:Pt-On(X,Y) Draw point.
:End End of For group.
:StorePic 6 Store picture.
After you execute the program above, you can recall and display
the picture with the instruction RecallPic 6.
Using a Program to Create the Sierpinski Triangle
Setting up the
Program
Program
178 Applications
82501F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:49 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:04
PM Page 8 of 20
Using Web format, you can identify points with attracting and
repelling behavior in sequence graphing.
1. Press z. Select Seq and the default mode settings. Press
y [FORMAT]. Select Web format and the default format
settings.
2. Press o. Clear all functions and turn off all stat plots. Enter
the sequence that corresponds to the expression Y = K
X(1NX).
u(n)=Ku(nN1)(1Nu(nN1))
u(nMin)=.01
3. Press y [QUIT] to return to the home screen, and then store
2.9 to K.
4. Press p. Set the window variables.
nMin=0 Xmin=0 Ymin=M.26
nMax=10 Xmax=1 Ymax=1.1
PlotStart=1 Xscl=1 Yscl=1
PlotStep=1
5. Press r to display the graph, and then press ~ to trace
the cobweb. This is a cobweb with one attractor.
6. Change K to 3.44 and trace the graph to show a cobweb with
two attractors.
7. Change K to 3.54 and trace the graph to show a cobweb with
four attractors.
Graphing Cobweb Attractors
Problem
Procedure
Applications 179
82501F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:49 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:04
PM Page 9 of 20
This program graphs the function A sin(BX) with random
integer coefficients between 1 and 10. Try to guess the
coefficients and graph your guess as C sin(DX). The program
continues until your guess is correct.
PROGRAM:GUESS
:PlotsOff :Func
:FnOff :Radian
:ClrHome
:"Asin(BX)"! !! !Y1
:"Csin(DX)"! !! !Y2
Define equations.
:GraphStyle(1,1)
:GraphStyle(2,5)
Set line and path graph
styles.
:FnOff 2
:randInt(1,10)! !! !A
:randInt(1,10)! !! !B
:0! !! !C:0! !! !D
Initialize coefficients.
:L2p! !! !Xmin
:2p! !! !Xmax
:p2! !! !Xscl
:L10! !! !Ymin
:10! !! !Ymax
:1! !! !Yscl
Set viewing window.
:DispGraph
:Pause
Display graph.
:FnOn 2
:Lbl Z
:Prompt C,D Prompt for guess.
:DispGraph
:Pause
Display graph.
:If C=A
:Text(1,1,"C IS OK")
:If CA
:Text(1,1,"C IS WRONG")
:If D=B
:Text(1,50,"D IS OK")
:If DB
:Text(1,50,"D IS WRONG")
Display results.
:DispGraph
:Pause
Display graph.
:If C=A and D=B
:Stop
:Goto Z
Quit if guesses are correct.
Using a Program to Guess the Coefficients
Setting Up the
Program
Program
1710 Applications
82501F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:49 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:04
PM Page 10 of 20
Using parametric graphing mode, graph the unit circle and the
sine curve to show the relationship between them.
Any function that can be plotted in Func mode can be plotted in
Par mode by defining the X component as T and the Y
component as F(T).
1. Press z. Select Par, Simul, and the default settings.
2. Press p. Set the viewing window.
Tmin=0 Xmin=L2 Ymin=L3
Tmax=2p Xmax=7.4 Ymax=3
Tstep=.1 Xscl=p2 Yscl=1
3. Press o. Turn off all functions and stat plots. Enter the
expressions to define the unit circle centered on (0,0).
4. Enter the expressions to define the sine curve.
5. Press r. As the graph is plotting, you may press
to pause and again to resume graphing as you watch
the sine function unwrap from the unit circle.
Note: You can generalize the unwrapping. Replace sin(T) in Y2T with
any other trig function to unwrap that function.
Graphing the Unit Circle and Trigonometric Curves
Problem
Procedure
Applications 1711
82501F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:49 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:04
PM Page 11 of 20
Find the area of the region bounded by
f(x) = 300x / ( x
2
+ 625)
g(x) = 3cos(.1x)
x = 75
1. Press z. Select the default mode settings.
2. Press p. Set the viewing window.
Xmin=0 Ymin=L5
Xmax=100 Ymax=10
Xscl=10 Yscl=1
Xres=1
3. Press o. Turn off all functions and stat plots. Enter the
upper and lower functions.
Y1=300X(X
2
+625)
Y2=3cos(.1X)
4. Press y [CALC] 5 to select 5:Intersect. The graph is
displayed. Select a first curve, second curve, and guess for
the intersection toward the left side of the display. The
solution is displayed, and the value of X at the intersection,
which is the lower limit of the integral, is stored in Ans and
X.
5. Press y [QUIT] to go to the home screen. Press y [DRAW]
7 and use Shade( to see the area graphically.
Shade(Y2,Y1,Ans,75)
6. Press y [QUIT] to return to the home screen. Enter the
expression to evaluate the integral for the shaded region.
fnInt(Y1Y2,X,Ans,75)
The area is 325.839962.
Finding the Area between Curves
Problem
Procedure
1712 Applications
82501F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:49 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:04
PM Page 12 of 20
Using two pairs of parametric equations, determine when two
objects in motion are closest to each other in the same plane.
A ferris wheel has a diameter (d) of 20 meters and is rotating
counterclockwise at a rate (s) of one revolution every 12
seconds. The parametric equations below describe the location
of a ferris wheel passenger at time T, where a is the angle of
rotation, (0,0) is the bottom center of the ferris wheel, and
(10,10) is the passengers location at the rightmost point, when
T=0.
X(T) = r cos a where a = 2pTs and r = d2
Y(T) = r + r sin a
A person standing on the ground throws a ball to the ferris wheel
passenger. The throwers arm is at the same height as the bottom
of the ferris wheel, but 25 meters (b) to the right of the ferris
wheels lowest point (25,0). The person throws the ball with
velocity (v
0
) of 22 meters per second at an angle (q) of 66 from
the horizontal. The parametric equations below describe the
location of the ball at time T.
X(T) = b N Tv
0
cosq
Y(T) = Tv
0
sinq N (g2) T
2
where g =
9.8 m/ sec
2
1. Press z. Select Par, Simul, and the default settings.
Simul (simultaneous) mode simulates the two objects in
motion over time.
2. Press p. Set the viewing window.
Tmin=0 Xmin=L13 Ymin=0
Tmax=12 Xmax=34 Ymax=31
Tstep=.1 Xscl=10 Yscl=10
3. Press o. Turn off all functions and stat plots. Enter the
expressions to define the path of the ferris wheel and the path of
the ball. Set the graph style for X2T to (path).
Tip: Try setting the graph styles to X1T and X2T, which simulates
a chair on the ferris wheel and the ball flying through the air when you
press s.
Using Parametric Equations: Ferris Wheel Problem
Problem
Procedure
Applications 1713
82501F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:49 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:04
PM Page 13 of 20
4. Press s to graph the equations. Watch closely as they
are plotted. Notice that the ball and the ferris wheel
passenger appear to be closest where the paths cross in the
top-right quadrant of the ferris wheel.
5. Press p. Change the viewing window to concentrate
on this portion of the graph.
Tmin=1 Xmin=0 Ymin=10
Tmax=3 Xmax=23.5 Ymax=25.5
Tstep=.03 Xscl=10 Yscl=10
6. Press r. After the graph is plotted, press ~ to move
near the point on the ferris wheel where the paths cross.
Notice the values of X, Y, and T.
7. Press to move to the path of the ball. Notice the values of
X and Y (T is unchanged). Notice where the cursor is located.
This is the position of the ball when the ferris wheel
passenger passes the intersection. Did the ball or the
passenger reach the intersection first?
You can use r to, in effect, take snapshots in time and
explore the relative behavior of two objects in motion.
Procedure
(continued)
1714 Applications
82501F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:49 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:04
PM Page 14 of 20
Using the functions fnInt( and nDeriv( from the MATH menu to
graph functions defined by integrals and derivatives
demonstrates graphically that:
F(x) =
1
x
1t dt = ln(x), x > 0 and that
D
x
[
1
x
1t dt] = 1x
1. Press z. Select the default settings.
2. Press p. Set the viewing window.
Xmin=.01 Ymin=M1.5 Xres=3
Xmax=10 Ymax=2.5
Xscl=1 Yscl=1
3. Press o. Turn off all functions and stat plots. Enter the
numerical integral of 1T from 1 to X and the function
ln(X). Set the graph style for Y1 to (line) and Y2 to
(path).
4. Press r. Press |, }, ~, and to compare the values
of Y1 and Y2.
5. Press o. Turn off Y1 and Y2, and then enter the numerical
derivative of the integral of 1X and the function 1X. Set
the graph style for Y3 to (line) and Y4 to (thick).
6. Press r. Again, use the cursor keys to compare the
values of the two graphed functions, Y3 and Y4.
Demonstrating the Fundamental Theorem of Calculus
Problem 1
Procedure 1
Applications 1715
82501F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:49 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:04
PM Page 15 of 20
Explore the functions defined by
y =
M
2
x
t
2
dt,
0
x
t
2
dt, and
2
x
t
2
dt
1. Press o. Turn off all functions and stat plots. Use a list to
define these three functions simultaneously. Store the
function in Y5.
2. Press q 6 to select 6:ZStandard.
3. Press r. Notice that the functions appear identical, only
shifted vertically by a constant.
4. Press o. Enter the numerical derivative of Y5 in Y6.
5. Press r. Notice that although the three graphs defined
by Y5 are different, they share the same derivative.
Problem 2
Procedure 2
1716 Applications
82501F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:49 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:04
PM Page 16 of 20
Use the equation solver to store a formula for the area of a
regular N-sided polygon, and then solve for each variable, given
the other variables. Explore the fact that the limiting case is the
area of a circle, pr
2
.
Consider the formula A = NB
2
sin(pN) cos(pN) for the area
of a regular polygon with N sides of equal length and B distance
from the center to a vertex.
N = 4 sides N = 8 sides N = 12 sides
1. Press 0 to select 0:Solver from the MATH menu. Either
the equation editor or the interactive solver editor is
displayed. If the interactive solver editor is displayed, press
} to display the equation editor.
2. Enter the formula as 0=ANNB
2
sin(p / N)cos(p / N), and then
press . The interactive solver editor is displayed.
3. Enter N=4 and B=6 to find the area (A) of a square with a
distance (B) from center to vertex of 6 centimeters.
4. Press } } to move the cursor onto A, and then press
[SOLVE]. The solution for A is displayed on the interactive
solver editor.
5. Now solve for B for a given area with various number of
sides. Enter A=200 and N=6. To find the distance B, move the
cursor onto B, and then press [SOLVE].
6. Enter N=8. To find the distance B, move the cursor onto B,
and then press [SOLVE]. Find B for N=9, and then for
N=10.
Computing Areas of Regular N-Sided Polygons
Problem
Procedure
Applications 1717
82501F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:49 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:04
PM Page 17 of 20
Find the area given B=6, and N=10, 100, 150, 1000, and 10000.
Compare your results with p6
2
(the area of a circle with radius
6), which is approximately 113.097.
7. Enter B=6. To find the area A, move the cursor onto A, and
then press [SOLVE]. Find A for N=10, then N=100,
then N=150, then N=1000, and finally N=10000. Notice that
as N gets large, the area A approaches pB
2
.
Now graph the equation to see visually how the area changes as
the number of sides gets large.
8. Press z. Select the default mode settings.
9. Press p. Set the viewing window.
Xmin=0 Ymin=0 Xres=1
Xmax=200 Ymax=150
Xscl=10 Yscl=10
10. Press o. Turn off all functions and stat plots. Enter the
equation for the area. Use X in place of N. Set the graph
styles as shown.
11. Press r. After the graph is plotted, press 100 to
trace to X=100. Press 150 . Press 188 . Notice
that as X increases, the value of Y converges to p6
2
, which is
approximately 113.097. Y2=pB
2
(the area of the circle) is a
horizontal asymptote to Y1. The area of an N-sided regular
polygon, with r as the distance from the center to a vertex,
approaches the area of a circle with radius r (pr
2
) as N gets
large.
Procedure
(continued)
1718 Applications
82501F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:49 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:04
PM Page 18 of 20
You are a loan officer at a mortgage company, and you recently
closed on a 30-year home mortgage at 8 percent interest with
monthly payments of 800. The new home owners want to know
how much will be applied to the interest and how much will be
applied to the principal when they make the 240th payment 20
years from now.
1. Press z and set the fixed-decimal mode to 2 decimal
places. Set the other mode settings to the defaults.
2. Press y [FINANCE] 1 to display the TVM Solver. Enter these
values.
Note: Enter a positive number (800) to show PMT as a cash
inflow. Payment values will be displayed as positive numbers on
the graph. Enter 0 for FV, since the future value of a loan is 0
once it is paid in full. Enter PMT: END, since payment is due at
the end of a period.
3. Move the cursor onto the PV= prompt, and then press
[SOLVE]. The present value, or mortgage amount, of the
house is displayed at the PV= prompt.
Computing and Graphing Mortgage Payments
Problem
Procedure
Applications 1719
82501F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:49 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:04
PM Page 19 of 20
Now compare the graph of the amount of interest with the graph
of the amount of principal for each payment.
4. Press z. Set Par and Simul.
5. Press o. Turn off all functions and stat plots. Enter these
equations and set the graph styles as shown.
Note: GPrn( and GInt( are located on the FINANCE CALC
menu.
6. Press p. Set these window variables.
Tmin=1 Xmin=0 Ymin=0
Tmax=360 Xmax=360 Ymax=1000
Tstep=12 Xscl=10 Yscl=100
Tip: To increase the graph speed, change Tstep to 24.
7. Press r. After the graph is drawn, press 240 to
move the trace cursor to T=240, which is equivalent to 20
years of payments.
The graph shows that for the 240th payment (X=240), 358.03
of the 800 payment is applied to principal (Y=358.03).
Note: The sum of the payments (Y3T=Y1T+Y2T) is always 800.
Procedure
(continued)
1720 Applications
82501F~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 1:49 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:04
PM Page 20 of 20
8. Press to move the cursor onto the function for interest
defined by X2T and Y2T. Enter 240.
The graph shows that for the 240th payment (X=240), 441.97
of the 800 payment is interest (Y=441.97).
9. Press y [QUIT] y [FINANCE] 9 to paste 9:bal( to the home
screen. Check the figures from the graph.
At which monthly payment will the principal allocation surpass
the interest allocation?
Computing and Graphing Mortgage Payments (cont.)
Procedure
(continued)
Memory Management 181
82D304~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 9:19 AM Printed: 10/28/05 9:21
AM Page 1 of 6
18
Memory
Management
Checking Available Memory.......................................................................... 2
Deleting Items from Memory......................................................................... 3
Clearing Entries and List Elements............................................................. 4
Resetting the TI-82 STATS............................................................................. 5
Contents
182 Memory Management
82D304~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 9:19 AM Printed: 10/28/05 9:21
AM Page 2 of 6
To display the MEMORY menu, press y [MEM].
MEMO
RY
1: Check RAM... Reports memory availability/usage.
2: Delete... Displays DELETE FROM menu.
3: Clear Entries Clears ENTRY (last-entry storage).
4: ClrAllLists Clears all lists in memory.
5: Reset... Displays RESET menu (all/defaults).
Check RAM displays the Check RAM screen. The top line
reports the total amount of available memory. The remaining
lines report the amount of memory each variable type is using.
You can check this screen to see whether you need to delete
variables from memory to make room for new data, such as
programs.
To check RAM usage, follow these steps.
1. Press y [MEM] to display the MEMORY menu.
2. Select 1:Check RAM to display the Check RAM screen. The
TI-82 STATS expresses memory quantities in bytes.
Note: The $ in the left column of
the bottom row indicates that you
can scroll or page down to view
more variable types.
Note: Real, List, Y.Vars, and Prgm variable types never reset
to zero, even after memory is cleared.
To leave the Check RAM screen, press either y [QUIT] or
. Both options display the home screen.
Checking Available Memory
MEMORY Menu
Displaying the
Check RAM
Screen
Memory Management 183
82D304~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 9:19 AM Printed: 10/28/05 9:21
AM Page 3 of 6
To increase available memory by deleting the contents of any
variable (real or complex number, list, matrix, Y= variable,
program, picture, graph database, or string), follow these steps.
1. Press y [MEM] to display the MEMORY menu.
2. Select 2:Delete to display the DELETE FROM secondary
menu.
3. Select the type of data you want to delete, or select 1:All for
a list of all variables of all types. A screen is displayed
listing each variable of the type you selected and the number
of bytes each variable is using.
For example, if you select 4:List, the DELETE:List screen is
displayed.
4. Press } and to move the selection cursor (4) next to the
item you want to delete, and then press . The variable
is deleted from memory. You can delete individual variables
one by one from this screen.
To leave any DELETE: screen without deleting anything, press
y [QUIT], which displays the home screen.
Note: You cannot delete some system variables, such as the last-
answer variable Ans and the statistical variable RegEQ.
Deleting Items from Memory
Deleting an Item
184 Memory Management
82D304~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 9:19 AM Printed: 10/28/05 9:21
AM Page 4 of 6
Clear Entries clears the contents of the ENTRY (last entry)
storage area (Chapter 1). To clear the ENTRY storage area,
follow these steps.
1. Press y [MEM] to display the MEMORY menu.
2. Select 3:Clear Entries to paste the instruction to the home
screen.
3. Press to clear the ENTRY storage area.
To cancel Clear Entries, press .
Note: If you select 3:Clear Entries from within a program, the Clear
Entries instruction is pasted to the program editor, and the Entry
(last entry) is cleared when the program is executed.
ClrAllLists sets to 0 the dimension of each list in memory.
To clear all elements from all lists, follow these steps.
1. Press y [MEM] to display the MEMORY menu.
2. Select 4:ClrAllLists to paste the instruction to the home
screen.
3. Press to set to 0 the dimension of each list in memory.
To cancel ClrAllLists, press .
ClrAllLists does not delete list names from memory, from the
LIST NAMES menu, or from the stat list editor.
Note: If you select 4:ClrAllLists from within a program, the
ClrAllLists instruction is pasted to the program editor. The lists are
cleared when the program is executed.
Clearing Entries and List Elements
Clear Entries
ClrAllLists
Memory Management 185
82D304~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 9:19 AM Printed: 10/28/05 9:21
AM Page 5 of 6
The RESET secondary menu gives you the option of resetting
all memory (including default settings) or resetting the default
settings while preserving other data stored in memory, such as
programs and Y= functions.
Resetting all memory on the TI-82 STATS restores memory to
the factory settings. It deletes all nonsystem variables and all
programs. It resets all system variables to the default settings.
Tip: Before you reset all memory, consider restoring sufficient
available memory by deleting only selected data (page 18.3).
To reset all memory on the TI-82 STATS, follow these steps.
1. Press y [MEM] to display the MEMORY menu.
2. Select 5:Reset to display the RESET secondary menu.
3. Select 1:All Memory to display the RESET MEMORY tertiary
menu.
4. Read the message below the RESET MEMORY menu.
To cancel memory reset and return to the home screen,
select 1:No.
To erase from memory all data and programs, select
2:Reset. All factory defaults are restored. Mem cleared is
displayed on the home screen.
Note: When you clear memory, the contrast sometimes changes. If
the screen is faded or blank, adjust the contrast (Chapter 1).
Resetting the TI-82 STATS
RESET
Secondary Menu
Resetting All
Memory
186 Memory Management
82D304~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/28/05 9:19 AM Printed: 10/28/05 9:21
AM Page 6 of 6
When you reset defaults on the TI-82 STATS, all defaults are
restored to the factory settings. Stored data and programs are not
changed.
These are some examples of TI-82 STATS defaults that are
restored by resetting the defaults.
Mode settings such as Normal (notation); Func (graphing);
Real (numbers); and Full (screen)
Y= functions off
Window variable values such as Xmin=L10; Xmax=10;
Xscl=1; Yscl=1; and Xres=1
Stat plots off
Format settings such as CoordOn (graphing coordinates on);
AxesOn; and ExprOn (expression on)
rand seed value to 0
To reset all TI-82 STATS factory defaults, follow these steps.
1. Press y [MEM] to display the MEMORY menu.
2. Select 5:Reset to display the RESET secondary menu.
3. Select 2:Defaults to display the RESET DEFAULTS tertiary
menu.
4. Consider the consequences of resetting defaults.
To cancel reset and return to the home screen, select
1:No.
To restore factory default settings, select 2:Reset.
Default settings are restored. Defaults set is displayed on
the home screen.
Resetting the TI-82 STATS (continued)
Resetting
Defaults
Communication Link 191
825A7D~1.DOC TI-83 Intl English, Chap 19 Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/27/05 1:26 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:07
PM Page 1 of 10
19
Communication
Link
Getting Started: Sending Variables............................................................. 2
TI-82 STATS LINK............................................................................................... 3
Selecting Items to Send....................................................................................... 4
Receiving Items ....................................................................................................... 5
Transmitting Items................................................................................................. 6
Transmitting Lists to a TI-82.......................................................................... 8
Transmitting from a TI-82 to a TI-82 STATS..................................... 9
Backing Up Memory............................................................................................ 10
Contents
192 Communication Link
825A7D~1.DOC TI-83 Intl English, Chap 19 Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/27/05 1:26 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:07
PM Page 2 of 10
Getting Started is a fast-paced introduction. Read the chapter for details.
Create and store a variable and a matrix, and then transfer them to another
TI-82 STATS.
1. On the home screen of the sending unit, press
5 5 Q. Press to store
5.5 to Q.
2. Press y [ [ ] y [ [ ] 1 2 y[ ] ] y[ [ ]
3 4 y [ ] ] y [ ] ] 1. Press
to store the matrix to [A].
3. Connect the calculators with the link cable.
Push both ends in firmly.
4. On the receiving unit, press y[LINK] ~to
display the RECEIVE menu. Press 1 to select
1:Receive. The message Waiting... is
displayed and the busy indicator is on.
5. On the sending unit, press y[LINK] to
display the SEND menu.
6. Press 2 to select 2:AllN. The AllN SELECT
screen is displayed.
7. Press until the selection cursor ( 4 ) is next
to [A] MATRX. Press .
8. Press until the selection cursor is next to
Q REAL. Press . A square dot next to
[A] and Q indicates that each is selected to
send.
9. On the sending unit, press ~to display the
TRANSMIT menu.
10. On the sending unit, press 1 to select
1:Transmit and begin transmission. The
receiving unit displays the message
Receiving....When the items are transmitted,
both units display the name and type of each
transmitted variable.
Getting Started: Sending Variables
Communication Link 193
825A7D~1.DOC TI-83 Intl English, Chap 19 Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/27/05 1:26 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:07
PM Page 3 of 10
The TI-82 STATS has a port to connect and communicate with
another TI-82 STATS, a TI-82 STATS, the Calculator-Based
Laboratory (CBL) System, the Calculator-Based Ranger
(CBR), or a personal computer. The unit-to-unit link cable is
included with the TI-82 STATS. This chapter describes how to
communicate with another calculator.
You can transfer all variables and programs to another
TI-82 STATS or backup the entire memory of a TI-82 STATS.
The software that enables this communication is built into the
TI-82 STATS. To transmit from one TI-82 STATS to another,
follow the steps on pages 19.6 and 19.7.
You can transfer from a TI-82 to a TI-82 STATS all variables and
programs. Also, you can transfer from a TI-82 STATS to a TI-82
lists L1 through L6.
The software that enables this communication is built into the
TI-82 STATS. To transmit data from a TI-82 to a TI-82 STATS,
follow the steps on pages 19.6 and 19.7.
You cannot perform a memory backup from a TI-82 to a
TI-82 STATS.
The only data type you can transmit from a TI-82 STATS to
a TI-82 is list data stored in L1 through L6. Use the LINK
SEND menu item 5:Lists to TI82 (page 19.8).
1. Insert either end of the cable into the port very firmly.
2. Insert the other end of the cable into the other calculators
port.
CBR and the CBL System are optional accessories that connect
to a TI-82 STATS with the unit-to-unit link cable. With a CBR
or a CBL and a TI-82 STATS, you can collect and analyze real-
world data.
You can connect your TI-82 STATS to a personal computer
using TI Connect software and a TI Connectivity cable. The
software is included on the CD in the TI-82 STATS package.
When you connect to the TI Connect software, the TI-82
STATS calculator will be identified by TI Connect as a TI-83
calculator. Everything else should function as expected.
For more information, consult the TI Connect Help.
TI-82 STATS LINK
TI-82 STATS Link
Capabilities
Linking Two
TI-82 STATS
calculators
Linking a TI-82
and a
TI-82 STATS
Connecting Two
Calculators with
the Cable
Linking to a CBR
or the CBL
System
Linking to a PC
or Macintosh
194 Communication Link
825A7D~1.DOC TI-83 Intl English, Chap 19 Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/27/05 1:26 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:07
PM Page 4 of 10
To display the LINK SEND menu, press y [LINK].
SEND RECEIVE
1: All+... Displays all items selected.
2: AllN... Displays all items deselected.
3: Prgm... Displays all programs names.
4: List... Displays all list names.
5: Lists to TI82... Displays list names L1 through L6.
6: GDB... Displays all graph databases.
7: Pic... Displays all picture data types.
8: Matrix... Displays all matrix data types.
9: Real... Displays all real variables.
0: Complex... Displays all complex variables.
A: Y-Vars... Displays all Y= variables.
B: String... Displays all string variables.
C: Back Up... Selects all for backup to TI-82 STATS.
When you select an item on the LINK SEND menu, the
corresponding SELECT screen is displayed.
Note: Each SELECT screen, except All+ SELECT, is displayed
initially with no data selected.
To select items to send on the sending unit, follow these steps.
1. Press y [LINK] to display the LINK SEND menu.
2. Select the menu item that describes the data type to send.
The corresponding SELECT screen is displayed.
3. Press } and to move the selection cursor ( 4 ) to an item
you want to select or deselect.
4. Press to select or deselect the item. Selected names
are marked with a 0.
5. Repeat steps 3 and 4 to select or deselect additional items.
Selecting Items to Send
LINK SEND Menu
Selecting Items
to Send
Communication Link 195
825A7D~1.DOC TI-83 Intl English, Chap 19 Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/27/05 1:26 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:07
PM Page 5 of 10
To display the LINK RECEIVE menu, press y [LINK] ~.
SEND RECEIVE
1: Receive Sets unit to receive data transmission.
When you select 1:Receive from the LINK RECEIVE menu on
the receiving unit, the message Waiting... and the busy indicator
are displayed. The receiving unit is ready to receive transmitted
items. To exit the receive mode without receiving items, press
, and then select 1:Quit from the Error in Xmit menu.
To transmit, follow the steps on page 19.6.
When transmission is complete, the unit exits the receive mode.
You can select 1:Receive again to receive more items. The
receiving unit then displays a list of items received. Press y
[QUIT] to exit the receive mode.
During transmission, if a variable name is duplicated, the
DuplicateName menu is displayed on the receiving unit.
DuplicateName
1: Rename Prompts to rename receiving variable.
2: Overwrite Overwrites data in receiving variable.
3: Omit Skips transmission of sending variable.
4: Quit Stops transmission at duplicate variable.
When you select 1:Rename, the Name= prompt is displayed,
and alpha-lock is on. Enter a new variable name, and then press
. Transmission resumes.
When you select 2:Overwrite, the sending units data overwrites
the existing data stored on the receiving unit. Transmission
resumes.
When you select 3:Omit, the sending unit does not send the data
in the duplicated variable name. Transmission resumes with the
next item.
When you select 4:Quit, transmission stops, and the receiving
unit exits receive mode.
During transmission, if the receiving unit does not have
sufficient memory to receive an item, the Memory Full menu is
displayed on the receiving unit.
To skip this item for the current transmission, select 1:Omit.
Transmission resumes with the next item.
To cancel the transmission and exit receive mode, select
2:Quit.
Receiving Items
LINK RECEIVE
Menu
Receiving Unit
DuplicateName
Menu
Insufficient
Memory in
Receiving Unit
196 Communication Link
825A7D~1.DOC TI-83 Intl English, Chap 19 Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/27/05 1:26 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:07
PM Page 6 of 10
To transmit selected items after you have selected items to send
on the sending unit (page 19.4) and set the receiving unit to
receive (page 19.5), follow these steps.
1. Press ~ on the sending unit to display the TRANSMIT menu.
2. Confirm that Waiting... is displayed on the receiving unit,
which indicates it is set to receive (page 19.5).
3. Press to select 1:Transmit. The name and type of each
item are displayed line by line on the sending unit as the item
is queued for transmission, and then on the receiving unit as
each item is accepted.
After all selected items have been transmitted, the message
Done is displayed on both calculators. Press } and to scroll
through the names.
To stop a link transmission, press . The Error in Xmit menu is
displayed on both units. To leave the error menu, select 1:Quit.
A transmission error occurs after one or two seconds if:
A cable is not attached to the sending unit.
A cable is not attached to the receiving unit.
Note: If the cable is attached, push it in firmly and try again.
The receiving unit is not set to receive transmission.
You attempt a backup between a TI-82 and a TI-82 STATS.
You attempt a data transfer from a TI-82 STATS to a TI-82
with data other than lists L1 through L6 or without using
menu item 5:Lists to TI82.
Although a transmission error does not occur, these two
conditions may prevent successful transmission.
You try to use Get( with a calculator instead of a CBL or
CBR.
You try to use GetCalc( with a TI-82 instead of a
TI-82 STATS.
Transmitting Items
Transmitting
Items
Stopping a
Transmission
Error Conditions
Communication Link 197
825A7D~1.DOC TI-83 Intl English, Chap 19 Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/27/05 1:26 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:07
PM Page 7 of 10
After sending or receiving data, you can repeat the same
transmission to additional TI-82 STATS unitsfrom either the
sending unit or the receiving unitwithout having to reselect
data to send. The current items remain selected.
Note: You cannot repeat transmission if you selected All+ or All ..
To transmit to an additional TI-82 STATS, follow these steps.
1. Set the TI-82 STATS to receive (page 19.5).
2. Do not select or deselect any new items to send. If you select
or deselect an item, all selections or deselections from the
previous transmission are cleared.
3. Disconnect the link cable from one TI-82 STATS and
connect it to the additional TI-82 STATS.
4. Set the additional TI-82 STATS to receive (page 19.5).
5. Press y [LINK] on the sending TI-82 STATS to display the
LINK SEND menu.
6. Select the menu item that you used for the last transmission.
The data from your last transmission is still selected.
7. Press ~ to display the LINK TRANSMIT menu.
8. Confirm that the receiving unit is set to receive (page 19.5).
9. Press to select 1:Transmit and begin transmitting.
Transmitting
Items to an
Additional
TI-82 STATS
198 Communication Link
825A7D~1.DOC TI-83 Intl English, Chap 19 Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/27/05 1:26 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:07
PM Page 8 of 10
The only data type you can transmit from a TI-82 STATS to a
TI-82 is list data stored in L1 through L6.
To transmit to a TI-82 the list data that is stored to
TI-82 STATS lists L1, L2, L3, L4, L5, or L6, follow these steps.
1. Set the TI-82 to receive (page 19.5).
2. Press y [LINK] 5 on the sending TI-82 STATS to select
5:Lists to TI82. The SELECT screen is displayed.
3. Select each list to transmit.
4. Press ~ to display the LINK TRANSMIT menu.
5. Confirm that the receiving unit is set to receive (page 19.5).
6. Press to select 1:Transmit and begin transmitting.
Note: If dimension > 99 for a TI-82 STATS list that is selected to
send, the receiving TI-82 will truncate the list at the ninety-ninth
element during transmission.
Transmitting Lists to a TI-82
Transmitting
Lists to a TI-82
Communication Link 199
825A7D~1.DOC TI-83 Intl English, Chap 19 Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/27/05 1:26 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:07
PM Page 9 of 10
Generally, you can transmit items to a TI-82 STATS from a
TI-82, but differences between the two products may affect
some transmitted data. This table shows differences for which
the software built into the TI-82 STATS automatically adjusts
when a TI-82 STATS receives TI-82 data.
TI.82 TI-82 STATS
nMin PlotStart
nStart nMin
Un u
Vn v
UnStart u(nMin)
VnStart v(nMin)
TblMin TblStart
For example, if you transmit from a TI-82 to a TI-82 STATS a
program that contains nStart on a command line and then
display the program on the receiving TI-82 STATS, you will see
that nMin has automatically replaced nStart on the command
line.
The software built into the TI-82 STATS cannot resolve some
differences between the TI-82 and TI-82 STATS, which are
described below. You must edit the data on the TI-82 STATS
after you transmit to account for these differences, or the
TI-82 STATS will misinterpret the data.
The TI-82 STATS reinterprets TI-82 STATS prefix functions to
include open parentheses, which may add extraneous
parentheses to transmitted expressions.
For example, if you transmit sin X+5 from a TI-82 to a
TI-82 STATS, the TI-82 STATS reinterprets it as sin(X+5.
Without a closing parenthesis after X, the TI-82 STATS
interprets this as sin(X+5), not the sum of 5 and sin(X).
If a TI-82 instruction that the TI-82 STATS cannot translate is
transmitted, the ERR:INVALID menu is displayed when the
TI-82 STATS attempts to execute the instruction. For example,
on the TI-82, the character group Un-1 is pasted to the cursor
location when you press y [UnN1]. The TI-82 STATS cannot
directly translate Un-1 to the TI-82 STATS syntax u(nN1), so the
ERR:INVALID menu is displayed.
Note: TI-82 STATS implied multiplication rules differ from those of the
TI.82. For example, the TI-82 STATS evaluates 12X as (12) X,
while the TI-82 evaluates 12X as 1(2 X) (Chapter 2).
Transmitting from a TI-82 to a TI-82 STATS
Resolved
Differences
between the
TI-82 and
TI-82 STATS
Unresolved
Differences
between the
TI-82 and
TI-82 STATS
1910 Communication Link
825A7D~1.DOC TI-83 Intl English, Chap 19 Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/27/05 1:26 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:07
PM Page 10 of 10
To copy the exact contents of memory in the sending
TI-82 STATS to the memory of the receiving TI-82 STATS, put
the other unit in receive mode. Then, on the receiving unit,
select C:Back Up from the LINK SEND menu.
Warning: C:Back Up overwrites the memory in the
receiving unit; all information in the memory of the
receiving unit is lost.
Note: If you do not want to do a backup, select 2:Quit to return to
the LINK SEND menu.
Select 1:Transmit to begin transmission.
As a safety check to prevent accidental loss of memory, the
message WARNING . Backup is displayed when the receiving
unit receives notice of a backup.
To continue with the backup process, select 1:Continue. The
backup transmission begins.
To prevent the backup, select 2:Quit.
Note: If a transmission error is returned during a backup, the
receiving unit is reset.
When the backup is complete, both the sending calculator and
receiving calculator display a confirmation screen.
Backing Up Memory
Memory Backup
Receiving Unit
Memory Backup
Complete
Tables and Reference Information A1
826DEC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 2:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:09
PM Page 1 of 58
A
Tables and Reference
Information
Table of Functions and Instructions............................................................ 2
TI-82 STATS Menu Map.................................................................................. 39
Variables....................................................................................................................... 49
Statistics Formulas................................................................................................. 50
Financial Formulas ................................................................................................ 54
Contents
A2 Tables and Reference Information
826DEC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 2:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:09
PM Page 2 of 58
Functions return a value, list, or matrix. You can use functions in an expression.
Instructions initiate an action. Some functions and instructions have arguments. Optional
arguments and accompanying commas are enclosed in brackets ( [ ] ). For details about
an item, including argument descriptions and restrictions, turn to the page listed on the
right side of the table.
From the CATALOG, you can paste any function or instruction to the home screen or
to a command line in the program editor. However, some functions and instructions
are not valid on the home screen. The items in this table appear in the same order as
they appear in the CATALOG.
indicates keystrokes that are valid in the program editor only. Some keystrokes display
menus that are available only in the program editor. Others paste mode, format, or table-
set instructions only when you are in the program editor.
Function or Instruction/
Arguments Result
Key or Keys/
Menu or Screen/Item
abs(value) Returns the absolute value of a
real number, expression, list, or
matrix.
NUM
1:abs( 2-13
10-10
abs(complex value) Returns the magnitude of a
complex number or list.
CPX
5:abs( 2-19
valueA and valueB Returns 1 if both valueA and
valueB are 0. valueA and
valueB can be real numbers,
expressions, or lists.
y[TEST]
LOGIC
1:and
2-26
angle(value) Returns the polar angle of a
complex number or list of
complex numbers.
CPX
4:angle( 2-19
ANOVA(list1,list2
[,list3,...,list20])
Performs a one-way analysis of
variance for comparing the means
of two to 20 populations.
TESTS
F:ANOVA(
13-25
Ans Returns the last answer. y [ANS] 1-18
Table of Functions and Instructions
Tables and Reference Information A3
826DEC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 2:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:09
PM Page 3 of 58
Function or Instruction/
Arguments Result
Key or Keys/
Menu or Screen/Item
augment(matrixA,matrixB) Returns a matrix, which is matrixB
appended to matrixA as new
columns.
MATH
7:augment( 10-14
augment(listA,listB) Returns a list, which is listB
concatenated to the end of listA.
y[LIST]
OPS
9:augment( 11-15
AxesOff Turns off the graph axes. y[FORMAT]
AxesOff 3-14
AxesOn Turns on the graph axes. y[FORMAT]
AxesOn 3-14
a+bi Sets the mode to rectangular
complex number mode (a+bi).
z
a+bi 1-12
bal(npmt[,roundvalue]) Computes the balance at npmt for
an amortization schedule using
stored values for PV, , and
PMT and rounds the computation
to roundvalue.
y[FINANCE]
CALC
9:bal(
14-9
binomcdf(numtrials,p[,x]) Computes a cumulative
probability at x for the discrete
binomial distribution with the
specified numtrials and
probability p of success on each
trial.
y[DISTR]
DISTR
A:binomcdf(
13-33
binompdf(numtrials,p[,x]) Computes a probability at x for
the discrete binomial distribution
with the specified numtrials and
probability p of success on each
trial.
y[DISTR]
DISTR
0:binompdf(
13-33
c
2
cdf(lowerbound,
upperbound,df)
Computes the c
2
distribution
probability between lowerbound
and upperbound for the specified
degrees of freedom df.
y[DISTR]
DISTR
7:c
2
cdf(
13-31
A4 Tables and Reference Information
826DEC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 2:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:09
PM Page 4 of 58
Function or Instruction/
Arguments Result
Key or Keys/
Menu or Screen/Item
c
2
pdf(x,df) Computes the probability density
function (pdf) for the c
2
distribution at a specified x value
for the specified degrees of
freedom df.
y[DISTR]
DISTR
6:c
2
pdf(
13-31
c
2
.Test(observedmatrix,
expectedmatrix
[,drawflag])
Performs a chi-square test.
drawflag=1 draws results;
drawflag=0 calculates results.
TESTS
C:c
2
.Test( 13-22
Circle(X,Y,radius) Draws a circle with center (X,Y)
and radius.
y[DRAW]
DRAW
9:Circle( 8-11
Clear Entries Clears the contents of the Last
Entry storage area.
y[MEM]
MEMORY
3:Clear Entries 18-4
ClrAllLists Sets to 0 the dimension of all lists
in memory.
y[MEM]
MEMORY
4:ClrAllLists 18-4
ClrDraw Clears all drawn elements from a
graph or drawing.
y[DRAW]
DRAW
1:ClrDraw 8-4
ClrHome Clears the home screen.
I/O
8:ClrHome 16-20
ClrList listname1
[,listname2, ...,
listname n]
Sets to 0 the dimension of one or
more listnames.
EDIT
4:ClrList 12-20
ClrTable Clears all values from the table.
I/O
9:ClrTable 16-20
conj(value) Returns the complex conjugate of
a complex number or list of
complex numbers.
CPX
1:conj( 2-18
Connected Sets connected plotting mode;
resets all Y= editor graph-style
settings to .
z
Connected
1-11
Table of Functions and Instructions (continued)
Tables and Reference Information A5
826DEC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 2:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:09
PM Page 5 of 58
Function or Instruction/
Arguments Result
Key or Keys/
Menu or Screen/Item
CoordOff Turns off cursor coordinate value
display.
y[FORMAT]
CoordOff 3-14
CoordOn Turns on cursor coordinate value
display.
y[FORMAT]
CoordOn 3-14
cos(value) Returns cosine of a
real number, expression, or list.
2-3
cos
L1
(value) Returns arccosine of a real
number, expression, or list.
y[COS
L1
]
2-3
cosh(value) Returns hyperbolic cosine of a
real number, expression, or list.
y[CATALOG]
cosh(
15-10
cosh
L1
(value) Returns hyperbolic arccosine of a
real number, expression,
or list.
y[CATALOG]
cosh
L1
(
15-10
CubicReg [Xlistname,
Ylistname,freqlist,
regequ]
Fits a cubic regression model to
Xlistname and Ylistname with
frequency freqlist, and stores the
regression equation to regequ.
CALC
6:CubicReg
12-26
cumSum(list) Returns a list of the cumulative
sums of the elements in list,
starting with the first element.
y[LIST]
OPS
6:cumSum( 11-12
cumSum(matrix) Returns a matrix of the
cumulative sums of matrix
elements. Each element in the
returned matrix is a cumulative
sum of a matrix column from top
to bottom.
MATH
0:cumSum(
10-15
dbd(date1,date2) Calculates the number of days
between date1 and date2 using the
actual-day-count method.
y[FINANCE]
CALC
D:dbd( 14-13
value4Dec Displays a real or complex
number, expression, list, or matrix
in decimal format.
MATH
2:4Dec 2-5
A6 Tables and Reference Information
826DEC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 2:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:09
PM Page 6 of 58
Function or Instruction/
Arguments Result
Key or Keys/
Menu or Screen/Item
Degree Sets degree angle mode. z
Degree 1-11
DelVar variable Deletes from memory the
contents of variable.
CTL
G:DelVar 16-15
DependAsk Sets table to ask for dependent-
variable values.
y[TBLSET]
Depend: Ask 7-3
DependAuto Sets table to generate dependent-
variable values automatically.
y[TBLSET]
Depend: Auto
7-3
det(matrix) Returns determinant of matrix.
MATH
1:det( 10-12
DiagnosticOff Sets diagnostics-off mode; r, r
2
,
and R
2
are not displayed as
regression model results.
y[CATALOG]
DiagnosticOff
12-23
DiagnosticOn Sets diagnostics-on mode; r, r
2
,
and R
2
are displayed as
regression model results.
y[CATALOG]
DiagnosticOn
12-23
dim(listname) Returns the dimension of
listname.
y[LIST]
OPS
3:dim( 11-11
dim(matrixname) Returns the dimension of
matrixname as a list.
MATH
3:dim( 10-12
length! !! !dim(listname) Assigns a new dimension (length)
to a new or existing listname.
y[LIST]
OPS
3:dim( 11-11
{rows,columns}! !! !
dim(matrixname)
Assigns new dimensions to a new
or existing matrixname.
MATH
3:dim( 10-13
Disp Displays the home screen.
I/O
3:Disp 16-18
Disp [valueA,valueB,
valueC,...,value n]
Displays each value.
I/O
3:Disp 16-18
Table of Functions and Instructions (continued)
Tables and Reference Information A7
826DEC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 2:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:09
PM Page 7 of 58
Function or Instruction/
Arguments Result
Key or Keys/
Menu or Screen/Item
DispGraph Displays the graph.
I/O
4:DispGraph 16-19
DispTable Displays the table.
I/O
5:DispTable 16-19
value4DMS Displays value in DMS format. y[ANGLE]
ANGLE
4:4DMS 2-24
Dot Sets dot plotting mode; resets all
Y= editor graph-style settings to .
z
Dot
1-11
DrawF expression Draws expression (in terms of X)
on the graph.
y[DRAW]
DRAW
6:DrawF 8-9
DrawInv expression Draws the inverse of expression
by plotting X values on the y-axis
and Y values on the x-axis.
y[DRAW]
DRAW
8:DrawInv
8-9
:DS<(variable,value)
:commandA
:commands
Decrements variable by 1; skips
commandA if variable < value.
CTL
B:DS<( 16-14
e^(power) Returns e raised to power. y[e
x
]
2-4
e^(list) Returns a list of e raised to a list
of powers.
y[e
x
]
2-4
Exponent:
valueEexponent
Returns value times 10 to the
exponent.
y[EE]
1-7
Exponent:
listEexponent
Returns list elements times 10 to
the exponent.
y[EE]
1-7
Exponent:
matrixEexponent
Returns matrix elements times 10
to the exponent.
y[EE]
1-7
4Eff(nominal rate,
compounding periods)
Computes the effective interest
rate.
y[FINANCE]
CALC
C:4Eff( 14-12
Else
See If:Then:Else
A8 Tables and Reference Information
826DEC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 2:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:09
PM Page 8 of 58
Function or Instruction/
Arguments Result
Key or Keys/
Menu or Screen/Item
End Identifies end of For(,
If-Then-Else, Repeat, or While
loop.
CTL
7:End 16-12
Eng Sets engineering display mode. z
Eng 1-10
Equ4String(Y= var,Strn) Converts the contents of a Y= var
to a string and stores it in Strn.
y[CATALOG]
Equ4String(
15-7
expr(string) Converts string to an expression
and executes it.
y[CATALOG]
expr( 15-7
ExpReg [Xlistname,
Ylistname,freqlist,regequ]
Fits an exponential regression
model to Xlistname and Ylistname
with frequency freqlist, and stores
the regression equation to regequ.
CALC
0:ExpReg
12-26
ExprOff Turns off the expression display
during TRACE.
y[FORMAT]
ExprOff 3-14
ExprOn Turns on the expression display
during TRACE.
y[FORMAT]
ExprOn 3-14
cdf(lowerbound,
upperbound,
numerator df,
denominator df)
Computes the distribution
probability between lowerbound
and upperbound for the specified
numerator df (degrees of
freedom) and denominator df.
y[DISTR]
DISTR
9: cdf(
13-32
Fill(value,matrixname) Stores value to each element in
matrixname.
MATH
4:Fill( 10-13
Fill(value,listname) Stores value to each element in
listname.
y[LIST]
OPS
4:Fill( 11-11
Fix # Sets fixed-decimal mode for # of
decimal places.
z
0123456789
(select one) 1-10
Float Sets floating decimal mode. z
Float 1-10
Table of Functions and Instructions (continued)
Tables and Reference Information A9
826DEC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 2:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:09
PM Page 9 of 58
Function or Instruction/
Arguments Result
Key or Keys/
Menu or Screen/Item
fMax(expression,variable,
lower,upper[,tolerance])
Returns the value of variable
where the local maximum of
expression occurs, between lower
and upper, with specified
tolerance.
MATH
7:fMax(
2-6
fMin(expression,variable,
lower,upper[,tolerance])
Returns the value of variable
where the local minimum of
expression occurs, between lower
and upper, with specified
tolerance.
MATH
6:fMin(
2-6
fnInt(expression,variable,
lower,upper[,tolerance])
Returns the function integral of
expression with respect to
variable, between lower and
upper, with specified tolerance.
MATH
9:fnInt(
2-7
FnOff [function#,
function#,...,function n]
Deselects all Y= functions or
specified Y= functions.
Y-VARS On/Off
2:FnOff 3-8
FnOn [function#,
function#,...,function n]
Selects all Y= functions or
specified Y= functions.
Y-VARS On/Off
1:FnOn 3-8
:For(variable,begin,end
[,increment])
:commands
:End
:commands
Executes commands through
End, incrementing variable from
begin by increment until
variable>end.
CTL
4:For(
16-10
fPart(value) Returns the fractional part or parts
of a real or complex number,
expression, list, or matrix.
NUM
4:fPart( 2-14
10-11
pdf(x,numerator df,
denominator df)
Computes the distribution
probability between lowerbound
and upperbound for the specified
numerator df (degrees of
freedom) and denominator df.
y[DISTR]
DISTR
8: pdf(
13-32
A10 Tables and Reference Information
826DEC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 2:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:09
PM Page 10 of 58
Function or Instruction/
Arguments Result
Key or Keys/
Menu or Screen/Item
value4Frac Displays a real or complex
number, expression, list, or matrix
as a fraction simplified to its
simplest terms.
MATH
1:4Frac
2-5
Full Sets full screen mode. z
Full 1-12
Func Sets function graphing mode. z
Func 1-11
gcd(valueA,valueB) Returns the greatest common
divisor of valueA and valueB,
which can be real numbers or
lists.
NUM
9:gcd(
2-15
geometcdf(p,x) Computes a cumulative
probability at x, the number of the
trial on which the first success
occurs, for the discrete geometric
distribution with the specified
probability of success p.
y[DISTR]
DISTR
E:geometcdf(
13-34
geometpdf(p,x) Computes a probability at x, the
number of the trial on which the
first success occurs, for the discrete
geometric distribution with the
specified probability of success p.
y[DISTR]
DISTR
D:geometpdf(
13-34
Get(variable) Gets data from the CBL System or
CBR and stores it in variable.
I/O
A:Get( 16-21
GetCalc(variable) Gets contents of variable on
another TI-82 STATS and stores it
to variable on the receiving
TI-82 STATS.
I/O
0:GetCalc( 16-21
getKey Returns the key code for the
current keystroke, or 0, if no key
is pressed.
I/O
7:getKey 16-20
Goto label Transfers control to label.
CTL
0:Goto 16-13
Table of Functions and Instructions (continued)
Tables and Reference Information A11
826DEC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 2:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:09
PM Page 11 of 58
Function or Instruction/
Arguments Result
Key or Keys/
Menu or Screen/Item
GraphStyle(function#,
graphstyle#)
Sets a graphstyle for function#.
CTL
H:GraphStyle(
16-15
GridOff Turns off grid format. y[FORMAT]
GridOff 3-14
GridOn Turns on grid format. y[FORMAT]
GridOn 3-14
G-T Sets graph-table vertical
split-screen mode.
z
G-T 1-12
Horiz Sets horizontal
split-screen mode.
z
Horiz 1-12
Horizontal y Draws a horizontal line at y. y[DRAW]
DRAW
3:Horizontal 8-6
identity(dimension) Returns the identity matrix of
dimension rows dimension
columns.
MATH
5:identity( 10-13
:If condition
:commandA
:commands
If condition = 0 (false), skips
commandA.
CTL
1:If 16-9
:If condition
:Then
:commands
:End
:commands
Executes commands from Then
to End if condition = 1 (true).
CTL
2:Then
16-9
:If condition
:Then
:commands
:Else
:commands
:End
:commands
Executes commands from Then
to Else if condition = 1 (true);
from Else to End if condition = 0
(false).
CTL
3:Else
16-10
imag(value) Returns the imaginary (nonreal)
part of a complex number or list
of complex numbers.
CPX
3:imag(
2-18
A12 Tables and Reference Information
826DEC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 2:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:09
PM Page 12 of 58
Function or Instruction/
Arguments Result
Key or Keys/
Menu or Screen/Item
IndpntAsk Sets table to ask for independent-
variable values.
y[TBLSET]
Indpnt: Ask 7-3
IndpntAuto Sets table to generate
independent-variable values
automatically.
y[TBLSET]
Indpnt: Auto
7-3
Input Displays graph.
I/O
1:Input 16-16
Input [variable]
Input ["text",variable]
Prompts for value to store to
variable.
I/O
1:Input 16-17
Input [Strn,variable] Displays Strn and stores entered
value to variable.
I/O
1:Input 16-17
inString(string,substring
[,start])
Returns the character position in
string of the first character of
substring beginning at start.
y[CATALOG]
inString(
15-7
int(value) Returns the largest integer a real
or complex number, expression,
list, or matrix.
NUM
5:int( 2-14
10-11
GInt(pmt1,pmt2
[,roundvalue])
Computes the sum, rounded to
roundvalue, of the interest
amount between pmt1 and pmt2
for an amortization schedule.
y[FINANCE]
CALC
A:GInt(
14-9
invNorm(area[,m,s]) Computes the inverse cumulative
normal distribution function for a
given area under the normal
distribution curve specified by m
and s.
y[DISTR]
DISTR
3:invNorm(
13-30
iPart(value) Returns the integer part of a real
or complex number, expression,
list, or matrix.
NUM
3:iPart( 2-14
10-11
Table of Functions and Instructions (continued)
Tables and Reference Information A13
826DEC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 2:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:09
PM Page 13 of 58
Function or Instruction/
Arguments Result
Key or Keys/
Menu or Screen/Item
irr(CF0,CFList[,CFFreq]) Returns the interest rate at which
the net present value of the cash
flows is equal to zero.
y[FINANCE]
CALC
8:irr(
14-8
:IS>(variable,value)
:commandA
:commands
Increments variable
by 1; skips commandA if
variable>value.
CTL
A:IS>( 16-13
listname Identifies the next one to five
characters as a user-created list
name.
y[LIST]
OPS
B: 11-16
LabelOff Turns off axes labels. y[FORMAT]
LabelOff 3-14
LabelOn Turns on axes labels. y[FORMAT]
LabelOn 3-14
Lbl label Creates a label of one or two
characters.
CTL
9:Lbl 16-13
lcm(valueA,valueB) Returns the least common
multiple of valueA and valueB,
which can be real numbers or
lists.
NUM
8:lcm(
2-15
length(string) Returns the number of characters
in string.
y[CATALOG]
length( 15-8
Line(X1,Y1,X2,Y2) Draws a line from (X1,Y1) to
(X2,Y2).
y[DRAW]
DRAW
2:Line( 8-5
Line(X1,Y1,X2,Y2,0) Erases a line from (X1,Y1) to
(X2,Y2).
y[DRAW]
DRAW
2:Line( 8-5
A14 Tables and Reference Information
826DEC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 2:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:09
PM Page 14 of 58
Function or Instruction/
Arguments Result
Key or Keys/
Menu or Screen/Item
LinReg(a+bx) [Xlistname,
Ylistname,freqlist,
regequ]
Fits a linear regression model to
Xlistname and Ylistname with
frequency freqlist, and stores the
regression equation to regequ.
CALC
8:LinReg(a+bx)
12-26
LinReg(ax+b) [Xlistname,
Ylistname,freqlist,
regequ]
Fits a linear regression model to
Xlistname and Ylistname with
frequency freqlist, and stores the
regression equation to regequ.
CALC
4:LinReg(ax+b)
12-25
LinRegTTest [Xlistname,
Ylistname,freqlist,
alternative,regequ]
Performs a linear regression and a
t-test. alternative=L1 is <;
alternative=0 is ; alternative=1
is >.
TESTS
E:LinRegTTest
13-24
@List(list) Returns a list containing the
differences between consecutive
elements in list.
y[LIST]
OPS
7:@List( 11-12
List 4 matr(listname1,...,
listname n,matrixname)
Fills matrixname column by
column with the elements from
each specified listname.
y[LIST]
OPS
0:List 4 matr( 10-14
11-15
ln(value) Returns the natural logarithm of a
real or complex number,
expression, or list.
2-4
LnReg [Xlistname,
Ylistname,freqlist,
regequ]
Fits a logarithmic regression
model to Xlistname and Ylistname
with frequency freqlist, and stores
the regression equation to regequ.
CALC
9:LnReg
12-26
log(value) Returns logarithm of a real or
complex number, expression, or
list.
2-4
Table of Functions and Instructions (continued)
Tables and Reference Information A15
826DEC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 2:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:09
PM Page 15 of 58
Function or Instruction/
Arguments Result
Key or Keys/
Menu or Screen/Item
Logistic [Xlistname,
Ylistname,freqlist,
regequ]
Fits a logistic regression model to
Xlistname and Ylistname with
frequency freqlist, and stores the
regression equation to regequ.
CALC
B:Logistic
12-27
Matr 4 list(matrix,
listnameA,...,listname n)
Fills each listname with elements
from each column in matrix.
y[LIST]
OPS 10-14
A:Matr 4 list( 11-16
Matr 4 list(matrix,
column#,listname)
Fills a listname with elements from
a specified column# in matrix.
y[LIST]
OPS 10-14
A:Matr 4 list( 11-16
max(valueA,valueB) Returns the larger of valueA and
valueB.
NUM
7:max( 2-15
max(list) Returns largest real or complex
element in list.
y[LIST]
MATH
2:max( 11-16
max(listA,listB) Returns a real or complex list of
the larger of each pair of elements
in listA and listB.
y[LIST]
MATH
2:max(
11-16
max(value,list) Returns a real or complex list of
the larger of value or each list
element.
y[LIST
MATH
2:max( 11-16
mean(list[,freqlist]) Returns the mean of list with
frequency freqlist.
y[LIST]
MATH
3:mean( 11-16
median(list[,freqlist]) Returns the median of list with
frequency freqlist.
y[LIST]
MATH
4:median( 11-16
Med-Med [Xlistname,
Ylistname,freqlist,
regequ]
Fits a median-median model to
Xlistname and Ylistname with
frequency freqlist, and stores the
regression equation to regequ.
CALC
3:Med-Med
12-25
Menu("title","text1",label1
[,...,"text7",label7])
Generates a menu of up to seven
items during program execution.
CTL
C:Menu( 16-14
A16 Tables and Reference Information
826DEC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 2:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:09
PM Page 16 of 58
Function or Instruction/
Arguments Result
Key or Keys/
Menu or Screen/Item
min(valueA,valueB) Returns smaller of valueA and
valueB.
NUM
6:min( 2-15
min(list) Returns smallest real or complex
element in list.
y[LIST]
MATH
1:min( 11-16
min(listA,listB) Returns real or complex list of the
smaller of each pair of elements
in listA and listB.
y[LIST]
MATH
1:min( 11-16
min(value,list) Returns a real or complex list of
the smaller of value or each list
element.
y[LIST]
MATH
1:min( 11-16
valueA nCr valueB Returns the number of
combinations of valueA taken
valueB at a time.
PRB
3:nCr 2-21
value nCr list Returns a list of the combinations
of value taken each element in list
at a time.
PRB
3:nCr 2-21
list nCr value Returns a list of the combinations
of each element in list taken value
at a time.
PRB
3:nCr 2-21
listA nCr listB Returns a list of the combinations
of each element in listA taken
each element in listB at a time.
PRB
3:nCr
2-21
nDeriv(expression,variable,
value[,H])
Returns approximate numerical
derivative of expression with
respect to variable at value, with
specified H.
MATH
8:nDeriv(
2-7
4Nom(effective rate,
compounding periods)
Computes the nominal interest
rate.
y[FINANCE]
CALC
B:4Nom( 14-12
Normal Sets normal display mode. z
Normal 1-10
Table of Functions and Instructions (continued)
Tables and Reference Information A17
826DEC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 2:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:09
PM Page 17 of 58
Function or Instruction/
Arguments Result
Key or Keys/
Menu or Screen/Item
normalcdf(lowerbound,
upperbound[,m,s])
Computes the normal distribution
probability between lowerbound
and upperbound for the specified
m and s.
y[DISTR]
DISTR
2:normalcdf(
13-27
normalpdf(x[,m,s]) Computes the probability density
function for the normal
distribution at a specified x value
for the specified m and s.
y[DISTR]
DISTR
1:normalpdf(
13-29
not(value) Returns 0 if value is 0. value
can be a real number, expression,
or list.
y[TEST]
LOGIC
4:not( 2-26
valueA nPr valueB Returns the number of
permutations of valueA taken
valueB at a time.
PRB
2:nPr 2-21
value nPr list Returns a list of the permutations
of value taken each element in list
at a time.
PRB
2:nPr 2-21
list nPr value Returns a list of the permutations
of each element in list taken value
at a time.
PRB
2:nPr 2-21
listA nPr listB Returns a list of the permutations
of each element in listA taken
each element in listB at a time.
PRB
2:nPr
2-21
npv(interest rate,CF0,
CFList[,CFFreq])
Computes the sum of the present
values for cash inflows and
outflows.
y[FINANCE]
CALC
7:npv( 14-8
valueA or valueB Returns 1 if valueA or valueB is
0. valueA and valueB can be real
numbers, expressions, or lists.
y[TEST]
LOGIC
2:or
2-26
A18 Tables and Reference Information
826DEC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 2:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:09
PM Page 18 of 58
Function or Instruction/
Arguments Result
Key or Keys/
Menu or Screen/Item
Output(row,column,"text") Displays text beginning at
specified row and column.
I/O
6:Output( 16-19
Output(row,column,value) Displays value beginning at
specified row and column.
I/O
6:Output( 16-19
Param Sets parametric graphing mode. z
Par 1-11
Pause Suspends program execution until
you press .
CTL
8:Pause 16-12
Pause [value] Displays value; suspends program
execution until you press .
CTL
8:Pause 16-12
Plot#(type,Xlistname,
Ylistname,mark)
Defines Plot# (1, 2, or 3) of type
Scatter or xyLine for Xlistname
and Ylistname using mark.
y[STAT PLOT]
PLOTS
1:Plot1(
2:Plot2(
3:Plot3( 12-37
Plot#(type,Xlistname,
freqlist)
Defines Plot# (1, 2, or 3) of type
Histogramor Boxplot for
Xlistname with frequency freqlist.
y[STAT PLOT]
PLOTS
1:Plot1(
2:Plot2(
3:Plot3( 12-37
Plot#(type,Xlistname,
freqlist,mark)
Defines Plot# (1, 2, or 3) of type
ModBoxplot for Xlistname with
frequency freqlist using mark.
y[STAT PLOT]
PLOTS
1:Plot1(
2:Plot2(
3:Plot3( 12-37
Plot#(type,datalistname,
data axis,mark)
Defines Plot# (1, 2, or 3) of type
NormProbPlot for datalistname
on data axis using mark. data
axis can be X or Y.
y[STAT PLOT]
PLOTS
1:Plot1(
2:Plot2(
3:Plot3( 12-37
PlotsOff [1,2,3] Deselects all stat plots or one or
more specified stat plots (1, 2, or
3).
y[STAT PLOT]
STAT PLOTS
4:PlotsOff 12-35
PlotsOn [1,2,3] Selects all stat plots or one or
more specified stat plots (1, 2, or
3).
y[STAT PLOT]
STAT PLOTS
5:PlotsOn 12-35
Table of Functions and Instructions (continued)
Tables and Reference Information A19
826DEC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 2:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:09
PM Page 19 of 58
Function or Instruction/
Arguments Result
Key or Keys/
Menu or Screen/Item
Pmt_Bgn Specifies an annuity due, where
payments occur at the beginning
of each payment period.
y[FINANCE]
CALC
F:Pmt_Bgn
14-13
Pmt_End Specifies an ordinary annuity,
where payments occur at the end
of each payment period.
y[FINANCE]
CALC
E:Pmt_End 14-13
poissoncdf(m,x) Computes a cumulative
probability at x for the discrete
Poisson distribution with
specified mean m.
y[DISTR]
DISTR
C:poissoncdf(
13-34
poissonpdf(m,x) Computes a probability at x for the
discrete Poisson distribution with
the specified mean m.
y[DISTR]
DISTR
B:poissonpdf( 13-33
Polar Sets polar graphing mode. z
Pol 1-11
complex value 4Polar Displays complex value in polar
format.
CPX
7:4Polar 2-19
PolarGC Sets polar graphing coordinates
format.
y[FORMAT]
PolarGC 3-13
prgmname Executes the program name.
CTRL
D:prgm 16-15
GPrn(pmt1,pmt2
[,roundvalue])
Computes the sum, rounded to
roundvalue, of the principal
amount between pmt1 and pmt2
for an amortization schedule.
y[FINANCE]
CALC
0:GPrn(
14-9
prod(list[,start,end]) Returns product of list elements
between start and end.
y[LIST]
MATH
6:prod( 11-18
Prompt variableA
[,variableB,...,variable n]
Prompts for value for variableA,
then variableB, and so on.
I/O
2:Prompt 16-18
A20 Tables and Reference Information
826DEC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 2:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:09
PM Page 20 of 58
Function or Instruction/
Arguments Result
Key or Keys/
Menu or Screen/Item
1.PropZInt(x,n
[,confidence level])
Computes a one-proportion
z confidence interval.
TESTS
A:1.PropZInt( 13-20
2.PropZInt(x1,n1,x2,n2
[,confidence level])
Computes a two-proportion
z confidence interval.
TESTS
B:2.PropZInt( 13-21
1.PropZTest(p0,x,n
[,alternative,drawflag])
Computes a one-proportion z test.
alternative=L1 is <; alternative=0
is ; alternative=1 is >.
drawflag=1 draws results;
drawflag=0 calculates results.
TESTS
5:1.PropZTest(
13-14
2.PropZTest(x1,n1,x2,n2
[,alternative,drawflag])
Computes a two-proportion z test.
alternative=L1 is <; alternative=0
is ; alternative=1 is >.
drawflag=1 draws results;
drawflag=0 calculates results.
TESTS
6:2.PropZTest(
13-15
Pt.Change(x,y) Reverses a point at (x,y). y[DRAW]
POINTS
3:Pt.Change( 8-15
Pt.Off(x,y[,mark]) Erases a point at (x,y) using mark. y[DRAW]
POINTS
2:Pt.Off( 8-15
Pt.On(x,y[,mark]) Draws a point at (x,y) using mark. y[DRAW]
POINTS
1:Pt.On( 8-14
PwrReg [Xlistname,
Ylistname,freqlist,
regequ]
Fits a power regression model to
Xlistname and Ylistname with
frequency freqlist, and stores the
regression equation to regequ.
CALC
A:PwrReg
12-27
Table of Functions and Instructions (continued)
Tables and Reference Information A21
826DEC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 2:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:09
PM Page 21 of 58
Function or Instruction/
Arguments Result
Key or Keys/
Menu or Screen/Item
Pxl.Change(row,column) Reverses pixel at (row,column);
0 row 62 and
0 column 94.
y[DRAW
POINTS
6:Pxl.Change( 8-16
Pxl.Off(row,column) Erases pixel at (row,column);
0 row 62 and
0 column 94.
y[DRAW]
POINTS
5:Pxl.Off( 8-16
Pxl.On(row,column) Draws pixel at (row,column);
0 row 62 and
0 column 94.
y[DRAW]
POINTS
4:Pxl.On( 8-16
pxl.Test(row,column) Returns 1 if pixel (row, column)
is on, 0 if it is off; 0 row 62
and 0 column 94.
y[DRAW]
POINTS
7:pxl.Test(
8-16
P4Rx(r,q) Returns X, given polar
coordinates r and q or a list of
polar coordinates.
y[ANGLE]
ANGLE
7:P4Rx( 2-24
P4Ry(r,q) Returns Y, given polar
coordinates r and q or a list of
polar coordinates.
y[ANGLE]
ANGLE
8:P4Ry( 2-24
QuadReg [Xlistname,
Ylistname,freqlist,
regequ]
Fits a quadratic regression model
to Xlistname and Ylistname with
frequency freqlist, and stores the
regression equation to regequ.
CALC
5:QuadReg
12-25
QuartReg [Xlistname,
Ylistname,freqlist,
regequ]
Fits a quartic regression model to
Xlistname and Ylistname with
frequency freqlist, and stores the
regression equation to regequ.
CALC
7:QuartReg
12-26
Radian Sets radian angle mode. z
Radian 1-11
rand[(numtrials)] Returns a random number
between 0 and 1 for a specified
number of trials numtrials.
PRB
1:rand
2-20
randBin(numtrials,prob
[,numsimulations])
Generates and displays a random
real number from a specified
Binomial distribution.
PRB
7:randBin( 2-22
A22 Tables and Reference Information
826DEC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 2:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:09
PM Page 22 of 58
Function or Instruction/
Arguments Result
Key or Keys/
Menu or Screen/Item
randInt( lower,upper
[,numtrials])
Generates and displays a random
integer within a range specified
by lower and upper integer
bounds for a specified number of
trials numtrials.
PRB
5:randInt(
2-22
randM(rows,columns) Returns a random matrix of rows
(199) columns (199).
MATH
6:randM( 10-13
randNorm(m,s[,numtrials]) Generates and displays a random
real number from a specified
Normal distribution specified by
m and s for a specified number of
trials numtrials.
PRB
6:randNorm(
2-22
re^qi Sets the mode to polar complex
number mode (re^qi).
z
re^qi 1-12
Real Sets mode to display complex
results only when you enter
complex numbers.
z
Real
1-12
real(value) Returns the real part of a complex
number or list of complex
numbers.
CPX
2:real( 2-18
RecallGDB n Restores all settings stored in the
graph database variable GDBn.
y[DRAW]
STO
4:RecallGDB 8-20
RecallPic n Displays the graph and adds the
picture stored in Picn.
y[DRAW]
STO
2:RecallPic 8-18
complex value 4Rect Displays complex value or list in
rectangular format.
CPX
6:4Rect 2-19
RectGC Sets rectangular graphing
coordinates format.
y[FORMAT]
RectGC 3-13
ref(matrix) Returns the row-echelon form of
a matrix.
MATH
A:ref( 10-15
Table of Functions and Instructions (continued)
Tables and Reference Information A23
826DEC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 2:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:09
PM Page 23 of 58
Function or Instruction/
Arguments Result
Key or Keys/
Menu or Screen/Item
:Repeat condition
:commands
:End
:commands
Executes commands until
condition is true.
CTL
6:Repeat 16-11
Return Returns to the calling program.
CTL
E:Return 16-15
round(value[,#decimals]) Returns a number, expression,
list, or matrix rounded to
#decimals ( 9).
NUM
2:round( 2-13
row(value,matrix,row) Returns a matrix with row of
matrix multiplied by value and
stored in row.
MATH
E: row( 10-16
row+(matrix,rowA,rowB) Returns a matrix with rowA of
matrix added to rowB and stored
in rowB.
MATH
D:row+( 10-16
row+(value,matrix,
rowA,rowB)
Returns a matrix with rowA of
matrix multiplied by value, added
to rowB, and stored in rowB.
MATH
F: row+(
10-16
rowSwap(matrix,rowA,
rowB)
Returns a matrix with rowA of
matrix swapped with rowB.
MATH
C:rowSwap( 10-16
rref(matrix) Returns the reduced row-echelon
form of a matrix.
MATH
B:rref( 10-15
R4Pr(x,y) Returns R, given rectangular
coordinates x and y or a list of
rectangular coordinates.
y[ANGLE]
ANGLE
5:R4Pr( 2-24
R4Pq(x,y) Returns q, given rectangular
coordinates x and y or a list of
rectangular coordinates.
y[ANGLE]
ANGLE
6:R4Pq( 2-24
A24 Tables and Reference Information
826DEC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 2:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:09
PM Page 24 of 58
Function or Instruction/
Arguments Result
Key or Keys/
Menu or Screen/Item
2.Samp Test [listname1,
listname2,freqlist1,
freqlist2,alternative,
drawflag]
(Data list input)
Performs a two-sample test.
alternative=L1 is <; alternative=0
is ; alternative=1 is >.
drawflag=1 draws results;
drawflag=0 calculates results.
TESTS
D:2.Samp Test
13-23
2.Samp Test Sx1,n1,
Sx2,n2[,alternative,
drawflag]
(Summary stats input)
Performs a two-sample test.
alternative=L1 is <; alternative=0
is ; alternative=1 is >.
drawflag=1 draws results;
drawflag=0 calculates results.
TESTS
D:2.Samp Test
13-23
2.SampTInt [listname1,
listname2,
freqlist1,freqlist2,
confidence level,pooled]
(Data list input)
Computes a two-sample t
confidence interval. pooled=1
pools variances; pooled=0 does
not pool variances.
TESTS
0:2.SampTInt
13-19
2.SampTInt v1,Sx1,n1,
v2,Sx2,n2
[,confidence level,pooled]
(Summary stats input)
Computes a two-sample t
confidence interval. pooled=1
pools variances; pooled=0 does
not pool variances.
TESTS
0:2.SampTInt
13-19
2.SampTTest [listname1,
listname2,freqlist1,
freqlist2,alternative,
pooled,drawflag]
(Data list input)
Computes a two-sample t test.
alternative=L1 is <; alternative=0
is ; alternative=1 is >. pooled=1
pools variances; pooled=0 does
not pool variances. drawflag=1
draws results; drawflag=0
calculates results.
TESTS
4:2.SampTTest
13-13
Table of Functions and Instructions (continued)
Tables and Reference Information A25
826DEC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 2:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:09
PM Page 25 of 58
Function or Instruction/
Arguments Result
Key or Keys/
Menu or Screen/Item
2.SampTTest v1,Sx1,n1,
v2,Sx2,n2[,alternative,
pooled,drawflag]
(Summary stats input)
Computes a two-sample t test.
alternative=L1 is <; alternative=0
is ; alternative=1 is >. pooled=1
pools variances; pooled=0 does
not pool variances. drawflag=1
draws results; drawflag=0
calculates results.
TESTS
4:2.SampTTest
13-13
2.SampZInt(s1,s
2
[,listname1,listname2,
freqlist1,freqlist2,
confidence level])
(Data list input)
Computes a two-sample z
confidence interval.
TESTS
9:2.SampZInt(
13-18
2.SampZInt(s1,s
2
,
v1,n1,v2,n2
[,confidence level])
(Summary stats input)
Computes a two-sample z
confidence interval.
TESTS
9:2.SampZInt(
13-18
2.SampZTest(s1,s
2
[,listname1,listname2,
freqlist1,freqlist2,
alternative,drawflag])
(Data list input)
Computes a two-sample z test.
alternative=L1 is <; alternative=0
is ; alternative=1 is >.
drawflag=1 draws results;
drawflag=0 calculates results.
TESTS
3:2.SampZTest(
13-12
2.SampZTest(s1,s
2
,
v1,n1,v2,n2
[,alternative,drawflag])
(Summary stats input)
Computes a two-sample z test.
alternative=L1 is <; alternative=0
is ; alternative=1 is >.
drawflag=1 draws results;
drawflag=0 calculates results.
TESTS
3:2.SampZTest(
13-12
Sci Sets scientific notation display
mode.
z
Sci 1-10
Select(Xlistname,
Ylistname)
Selects one or more specific data
points from a scatter plot or
xyLine plot (only), and then
stores the selected data points to
two new lists, Xlistname and
Ylistname.
y[LIST]
OPS
8:Select(
11-12
A26 Tables and Reference Information
826DEC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 2:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:09
PM Page 26 of 58
Function or Instruction/
Arguments Result
Key or Keys/
Menu or Screen/Item
Send(variable) Sends contents of variable to the
CBL System or CBR.
I/O
B:Send( 16-21
seq(expression,variable,
begin,end[,increment])
Returns list created by evaluating
expression with regard to
variable, from begin to end by
increment.
y[LIST]
OPS
5:seq(
11-11
Seq Sets sequence graphing mode. z
Seq 1-11
Sequential Sets mode to graph functions
sequentially.
z
Sequential 1-12
SetUpEditor Removes all list names from the
stat list editor, and then restores
list names L1 through L6 to
columns 1 through 6.
EDIT
5:SetUpEditor
12-21
SetUpEditor listname1
[,listname2,...,
listname20]
Removes all list names from the
stat list editor, then sets it up to
display one or more listnames in
the specified order, starting with
column 1.
EDIT
5:SetUpEditor
12-21
Shade(lowerfunc,
upperfunc[,Xleft,Xright,
pattern,patres])
Draws lowerfunc and upperfunc
in terms of X on the current graph
and uses pattern and patres to
shade the area bounded by
lowerfunc, upperfunc, Xleft, and
Xright.
y[DRAW]
DRAW
7:Shade(
8-10
Shadec
2
(lowerbound,
upperbound,df)
Draws the density function for the
c
2
distribution specified by
degrees of freedom df and shades
the area between lowerbound and
upperbound.
y[DISTR]
DRAW
3:Shadec
2
(
13-36
Table of Functions and Instructions (continued)
Tables and Reference Information A27
826DEC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 2:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:09
PM Page 27 of 58
Function or Instruction/
Arguments Result
Key or Keys/
Menu or Screen/Item
Shade (lowerbound,
upperbound,
numerator df,
denominator df)
Draws the density function for the
distribution specified by
numerator df and denominator df
and shades the area between
lowerbound and upperbound.
y[DISTR]
DRAW
4:Shade (
13-36
ShadeNorm(lowerbound,
upperbound[,m,s])
Draws the normal density
function specified by m and s and
shades the area between
lowerbound and upperbound.
y[DISTR]
DRAW
1:ShadeNorm(
13-35
Shade_t(lowerbound,
upperbound,df)
Draws the density function for the
Student-t distribution specified by
degrees of freedom df, and shades
the area between lowerbound and
upperbound.
y[DISTR]
DRAW
2:Shade_t(
13-36
Simul Sets mode to graph functions
simultaneously.
z
Simul 1-12
sin(value) Returns the sine of a real number,
expression, or list.
2-3
sin
L1
(value) Returns the arcsine of a real
number, expression, or list.
y[SIN
L1
]
2-3
sinh(value) Returns the hyperbolic sine of a
real number, expression, or list.
y[CATALOG]
sinh(
15-10
sinh
L1
(value) Returns the hyperbolic arcsine of
a real number, expression, or list.
y[CATALOG]
sinh
L1
(
15-10
A28 Tables and Reference Information
826DEC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 2:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:09
PM Page 28 of 58
Function or Instruction/
Arguments Result
Key or Keys/
Menu or Screen/Item
SinReg [iterations,
Xlistname,Ylistname,
period,regequ]
Attempts iterations times to fit a
sinusoidal regression model to
Xlistname and Ylistname using a
period guess, and stores the
regression equation to regequ.
CALC
C:SinReg
12-27
solve(expression,variable,
guess,{lower,upper})
Solves expression for variable,
given an initial guess and lower
and upper bounds within which
the solution is sought.
MATH
0:solve(
2-12
SortA(listname) Sorts elements of listname in
ascending order.
y[LIST]
OPS 11-10
1:SortA( 12-20
SortA(keylistname,
dependlist1[,dependlist2,
...,dependlist n])
Sorts elements of keylistname in
ascending order, then sorts each
dependlist as a dependent list.
y[LIST]
OPS
1:SortA( 11-10
12-20
SortD(listname) Sorts elements of listname in
descending order.
y[LIST]
OPS 11-10
2:SortD( 12-20
SortD(keylistname,
dependlist1[,dependlist2,...,
dependlist n])
Sorts elements of keylistname in
descending order, then sorts each
dependlist as a dependent list.
y[LIST]
OPS
2:SortD( 11-10
12-20
stdDev(list[,freqlist]) Returns the standard deviation of
the elements in list with
frequency freqlist.
y[LIST]
MATH
7:stdDev( 11-18
Stop Ends program execution; returns
to home screen.
CTL
F:Stop 16-15
Store: value! !! !variable Stores value in variable. 1-14
StoreGDB n Stores current graph in database
GDBn.
y[DRAW]
STO
3:StoreGDB 8-19
Table of Functions and Instructions (continued)
Tables and Reference Information A29
826DEC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 2:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:09
PM Page 29 of 58
Function or Instruction/
Arguments Result
Key or Keys/
Menu or Screen/Item
StorePic n Stores current picture in picture
Picn.
y[DRAW]
STO
1:StorePic 8-17
String4Equ(string,Y= var) Converts string into an equation
and stores it in Y= var.
y[CATALOG]
String4Equ(
15-8
sub(string,begin,length) Returns a string that is a subset of
another string, from begin to
length.
y[CATALOG]
sub(
15-9
sum(list[,start,end]) Returns the sum of elements of
list from start to end.
y[LIST]
MATH
5:sum( 11-18
tan(value) Returns the tangent of a real
number, expression,
or list.
2-3
tan
L1
(value) Returns the arctangent of a real
number, expression, or list.
y[TAN
L1
]
2-3
Tangent(expression,value) Draws a line tangent to
expression at X=value.
y[DRAW
DRAW
5:Tangent( 8-8
tanh(value) Returns hyperbolic tangent of a
real number, expression, or list.
y[CATALOG]
tanh( 15-10
tanh
L1
(value) Returns the hyperbolic arctangent
of a real number, expression,
or list.
y[CATALOG]
tanh
L1
(
15-10
tcdf(lowerbound,
upperbound,df)
Computes the Student-t
distribution probability between
lowerbound and upperbound for
the specified degrees of freedom
df.
y[DISTR]
DISTR
5:tcdf(
13-31
Text(row,column,text1,
text2,...,text n)
Writes text on graph beginning at
pixel (row,column), where
0 row 57 and
0 column 94.
y[DRAW]
DRAW
0:Text(
8-12
Then
See If:Then
A30 Tables and Reference Information
826DEC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 2:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:09
PM Page 30 of 58
Function or Instruction/
Arguments Result
Key or Keys/
Menu or Screen/Item
Time Sets sequence graphs to plot with
respect to time.
y[FORMAT]
Time 6-8
TInterval [listname,
freqlist,confidence level]
(Data list input)
Computes a t confidence interval.
TESTS
8:TInterval 13-17
TInterval v,Sx,n
[,confidence level]
(Summary stats input)
Computes a t confidence interval.
TESTS
8:TInterval 13-17
tpdf(x,df) Computes the probability density
function (pdf) for the Student-t
distribution at a specified x value
with specified degrees of freedom
df.
y[DISTR]
DISTR
4:tpdf(
13-30
Trace Displays the graph and enters
TRACE mode.
r
3-18
T-Test m0[,listname,
freqlist,alternative,
drawflag]
(Data list input)
Performs a t test with frequency
freqlist. alternative=L1 is <;
alternative=0 is ; alternative=1
is >. drawflag=1 draws results;
drawflag=0 calculates results.
TESTS
2:T-Test
13-11
T-Test m0, v,Sx,n
[,alternative,drawflag]
(Summary stats input)
Performs a t test with frequency
freqlist. alternative=L1 is < ;
alternative=0 is ; alternative=1
is >. drawflag=1 draws results;
drawflag=0 calculates results.
TESTS
2:T-Test
13-11
Table of Functions and Instructions (continued)
Tables and Reference Information A31
826DEC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 2:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:09
PM Page 31 of 58
Function or Instruction/
Arguments Result
Key or Keys/
Menu or Screen/Item
tvm_FV[(,,PV,PMT,
P/Y,C/Y)]
Computes the future value. y[FINANCE]
CALC
6:tvm_FV 14-7
tvm_ [(,PV,PMT,FV,
P/Y,C/Y)]
Computes the annual interest rate. y[FINANCE]
CALC
3:tvm_ 14-7
tvm_ [(,PV,PMT,FV,
P/Y,C/Y)]
Computes the number of payment
periods.
y[FINANCE]
CALC
5:tvm_ 14-7
tvm_Pmt[(,,PV,FV,
P/Y,C/Y)]
Computes the amount of each
payment.
y[FINANCE]
CALC
2:tvm_Pmt 14-6
tvm_PV[(,,PMT,FV,
P/Y,C/Y)]
Computes the present value. y[FINANCE]
CALC
4:tvm_PV 14-7
uvAxes Sets sequence graphs to plot u(n)
on the x-axis and v(n) on the
y-axis.
y[FORMAT]
uv
6-8
uwAxes Sets sequence graphs to plot u(n)
on the x-axis and w(n) on the y-
axis.
y[FORMAT]
uw
6-8
1-Var Stats [Xlistname,
freqlist]
Performs one-variable analysis on
the data in Xlistname with
frequency freqlist.
CALC
1:1-Var Stats 12-25
2-Var Stats [Xlistname,
Ylistname,freqlist]
Performs two-variable analysis on
the data in Xlistname and
Ylistname with frequency freqlist.
CALC
2:2-Var Stats
12-25
variance(list[,freqlist]) Returns the variance of the
elements in list with frequency
freqlist.
y[LIST]
MATH
8:variance( 11-18
Vertical x Draws a vertical line
at x.
y[DRAW]
DRAW
4:Vertical 8-6
vwAxes Sets sequence graphs to plot v(n)
on the x-axis and w(n) on the y-
axis.
y[FORMAT]
vw
6-8
Web Sets sequence graphs to trace as
webs.
y[FORMAT]
Web 6-8
A32 Tables and Reference Information
826DEC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 2:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:09
PM Page 32 of 58
Function or Instruction/
Arguments Result
Key or Keys/
Menu or Screen/Item
:While condition
:commands
:End
:command
Executes commands while
condition is true.
CTL
5:While 16-11
valueA xor valueB Returns 1 if only valueA or
valueB = 0. valueA and valueB
can be real numbers, expressions,
or lists.
y[TEST]
LOGIC
3:xor
2-26
ZBox Displays a graph, lets you draw a
box that defines a new viewing
window, and updates the window.
q
ZOOM
1:ZBox
3-20
ZDecimal Adjusts the viewing window so
that @X=0.1 and @Y=0.1, and
displays the graph screen with the
origin centered on the screen.
q
ZOOM
4:ZDecimal
3-21
ZInteger Redefines the viewing window
using these dimensions:
@X=1 Xscl=10
@Y=1 Yscl=10
q
ZOOM
8:ZInteger
3-22
ZInterval s[,listname,
freqlist,confidence level]
(Data list input)
Computes a z confidence interval.
TESTS
7:ZInterval 13-16
ZInterval s,v,n
[,confidence level]
(Summary stats input)
Computes a z confidence interval.
TESTS
7:ZInterval 13-16
Zoom In Magnifies the part of the graph
that surrounds the cursor location.
q
ZOOM
2:Zoom In 3-21
Zoom Out Displays a greater portion of the
graph, centered on the cursor
location.
q
ZOOM
3:Zoom Out 3-21
Table of Functions and Instructions (continued)
Tables and Reference Information A33
826DEC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 2:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:09
PM Page 33 of 58
Function or Instruction/
Arguments Result
Key or Keys/
Menu or Screen/Item
ZoomFit Recalculates Ymin and Ymax to
include the minimum and
maximum Y values, between
Xmin and Xmax, of the selected
functions and replots the
functions.
q
ZOOM
0:ZoomFit
3-22
ZoomRcl Graphs the selected functions in a
user-defined viewing window.
q
MEMORY
3:ZoomRcl 3-23
ZoomStat Redefines the viewing window so
that all statistical data points are
displayed.
q
ZOOM
9:ZoomStat 3-22
ZoomSto Immediately stores the current
viewing window.
q
MEMORY
2:ZoomSto 3-23
ZPrevious Replots the graph using the
window variables of the graph
that was displayed before you
executed the last ZOOM
instruction.
q
MEMORY
1:ZPrevious
3-23
ZSquare Adjusts the X or Y window
settings so that each pixel
represents an equal width and
height in the coordinate system,
and updates the viewing window.
q
ZOOM
5:ZSquare
3-21
ZStandard Replots the functions
immediately, updating the
window variables to the default
values.
q
ZOOM
6:ZStandard
3-22
A34 Tables and Reference Information
826DEC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 2:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:09
PM Page 34 of 58
Function or Instruction/
Arguments Result
Key or Keys/
Menu or Screen/Item
ZNTest(m0,s[,listname,
freqlist,alternative,
drawflag])
(Data list input)
Performs a z test with frequency
freqlist. alternative=L1 is <;
alternative=0 is ; alternative=1
is >. drawflag=1 draws results;
drawflag=0 calculates results.
TESTS
1:Z.Test(
13-10
ZNTest(m0,s,v,n
[,alternative,drawflag])
(Summary stats input)
Performs a z test. alternative=L1
is <; alternative=0 is ;
alternative=1 is >. drawflag=1
draws results; drawflag=0
calculates results.
TESTS
1:Z.Test(
13-10
ZTrig Replots the functions
immediately, updating the
window variables to preset values
for plotting trig functions.
q
ZOOM
7:ZTrig
3-22
Factorial: value! Returns factorial of value.
PRB
4:! 2-21
Factorial: list! Returns factorial of list elements.
PRB
4:! 2-21
Degrees notation: value Interprets value as degrees;
designates degrees in DMS
format.
y[ANGLE]
ANGLE
1: 2-23
Radian: angle
r
Interprets angle as radians. y[ANGLE]
ANGLE
3:
r
2-24
Transpose: matrix
T
Returns a matrix in which each
element (row, column) is swapped
with the corresponding element
(column, row) of matrix.
MATH
2:
T
10-12
Table of Functions and Instructions (continued)
Tables and Reference Information A35
826DEC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 2:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:09
PM Page 35 of 58
Function or Instruction/
Arguments Result
Key or Keys/
Menu or Screen/Item
x
th
root
x
value Returns x
th
root of value.
MATH
5:
x
2-6
x
th
root
x
list Returns x
th
root of list elements.
MATH
5:
x
2-6
list
x
value Returns list roots of value.
MATH
5:
x
2-6
listA
x
listB Returns listA roots of listB.
MATH
5:
x
2-6
Cube: value
3
Returns the cube of a real or
complex number, expression, list,
or square matrix.
MATH
3:
3
2-6
10-10
Cube root:
3
(value) Returns the cube root of a real or
complex number, expression, or
list.
MATH
4:
3
( 2-6
Equal: valueA=valueB Returns 1 if valueA = valueB.
Returns 0 if valueA valueB.
valueA and valueB can be real or
complex numbers, expressions,
lists, or matrices.
y[TEST]
TEST
1:=
2-25
10-11
Not equal: valueAvalueB Returns 1 if valueA valueB.
Returns 0 if valueA = valueB.
valueA and valueB can be real or
complex numbers, expressions,
lists, or matrices.
y[TEST]
TEST
2:
2-25
10-11
Less than: valueA<valueB Returns 1 if valueA < valueB.
Returns 0 if valueA valueB.
valueA and valueB can be real or
complex numbers, expressions, or
lists.
y[TEST]
TEST
5:<
2-25
A36 Tables and Reference Information
826DEC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 2:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:09
PM Page 36 of 58
Function or Instruction/
Arguments Result
Key or Keys/
Menu or Screen/Item
Greater than:
valueA>valueB
Returns 1 if valueA > valueB.
Returns 0 if valueA valueB.
valueA and valueB can be real or
complex numbers, expressions, or
lists.
y[TEST]
TEST
3:>
2-25
Less than or equal:
valueAvalueB
Returns 1 if valueA valueB.
Returns 0 if valueA > valueB.
valueA and valueB can be real or
complex numbers, expressions, or
lists.
y[TEST]
TEST
6:
2-25
Greater than or equal:
valueAvalueB
Returns 1 if valueA valueB.
Returns 0 if valueA < valueB.
valueA and valueB can be real or
complex numbers, expressions, or
lists.
y[TEST]
TEST
4:
2-25
Inverse: value
L1
Returns 1 divided by a real or
complex number or expression.
2-3
Inverse: list
L1
Returns 1 divided by list
elements.
2-3
Inverse: matrix
L1
Returns matrix inverted. 10-10
Square: value
2
Returns value multiplied by itself.
value can be a real or complex
number or expression.
2-3
Square: list
2
Returns list elements squared.
2-3
Square: matrix
2
Returns matrix multiplied by
itself.
10-10
Powers: value^power Returns value raised to power.
value can be a real or complex
number or expression.
2-3
Powers: list^power Returns list elements raised to
power.
2-3
Powers: value^list Returns value raised to list
elements.
2-3
Table of Functions and Instructions (continued)
Tables and Reference Information A37
826DEC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 2:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:09
PM Page 37 of 58
Function or Instruction/
Arguments Result
Key or Keys/
Menu or Screen/Item
Powers: matrix^power Returns matrix elements raised to
power.
10-10
Negation: Lvalue Returns the negative of a real or
complex number, expression, list,
or matrix.
2-4
10-9
Power of ten: 10^(value) Returns 10 raised to the value
power. value can be a real or
complex number or expression.
y[10
x
]
2-4
Power of ten: 10^(list) Returns a list of 10 raised to the
list power.
y[10
x
]
2-4
Square root: (value) Returns square root of a real or
complex number, expression, or
list.
y[]
2-3
Multiplication:
valueA valueB
Returns valueA times valueB.
2-3
Multiplication:
value list
Returns value times each list
element.
2-3
Multiplication:
list value
Returns each list element times
value.
2-3
Multiplication:
listA listB
Returns listA elements times listB
elements.
2-3
Multiplication:
value matrix
Returns value times matrix
elements.
10-9
Multiplication:
matrixA matrixB
Returns matrixA times matrixB.
10-9
Division: valueAvalueB Returns valueA divided by
valueB.
2-3
Division: listvalue Returns list elements divided by
value.
2-3
Division: valuelist Returns value divided by list
elements.
2-3
Division: listAlistB Returns listA elements divided by
listB elements.
2-3
A38 Tables and Reference Information
826DEC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 2:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:09
PM Page 38 of 58
Function or Instruction/
Arguments Result
Key or Keys/
Menu or Screen/Item
Addition: valueA+valueB Returns valueA plus valueB. 2-3
Addition: list+value Returns list in which value is
added to each list element.
2-3
Addition: listA+listB Returns listA elements plus listB
elements.
2-3
Addition:
matrixA+matrixB
Returns matrixA elements plus
matrixB elements.
10-9
Concatenation:
string1+string2
Concatenates two or more strings.
15-6
Subtraction:
valueANvalueB
Subtracts valueB from valueA.
2-3
Subtraction:
valueNlist
Subtracts list elements from
value.
2-3
Subtraction:
listNvalue
Subtracts value from list
elements.
2-3
Subtraction:
listANlistB
Subtracts listB elements from
listA elements.
2-3
Subtraction:
matrixANmatrixB
Subtracts matrixB elements from
matrixA elements.
10-9
Minutes notation:
degreesminutes'
seconds"
Interprets minutes angle
measurement as minutes.
y[ANGLE]
ANGLE
2:' 2-23
Seconds notation:
degreesminutes'
seconds"
Interprets seconds angle
measurement as seconds.
[]
2-23
Table of Functions and Instructions (continued)
Tables and Reference Information A39
826DEC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 2:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:09
PM Page 39 of 58
The TI-82 STATS Menu Map begins at the top-left corner of the keyboard and
follows the keyboard layout from left to right. Default values and settings are shown.
o
(Func mode)
Plot1 Plot2 Plot3
Y1=
Y2=
Y3=
Y4=
...
Y9=
Y0=
(Par mode)
Plot1 Plot2 Plot3
X1T=
Y1T=
X2T=
Y2T=
...
X6T=
Y6T=
(Pol mode)
Plot1 Plot2 Plot3
r1=
r2=
r3=
r4=
r5=
r6=
(Seq mode)
Plot1 Plot2 Plot3
nMin=1
u(n)=
u(nMin)=
v(n)=
v(nMin)=
w(n)=
w(nMin)=
y [STAT PLOT]
y[STAT PLOT]
STAT PLOTS
1:Plot1Off
" "" " L1 L2
2:Plot2Off
" "" " L1 L2
3:Plot3Off
" "" " L1 L2
4:PlotsOff
5:PlotsOn
(PRGM editor)
PLOTS
1:Plot1(
2:Plot2(
3:Plot3(
4:PlotsOff
5:PlotsOn
(PRGM editor)
TYPE
1:Scatter
2:xyLine
3:Histogram
4:ModBoxplot
5:Boxplot
6:NormProbPlot
(PRGM editor)
MARK
1:
2:+
3:
p
(Func mode)
WINDOW
Xmin=-10
Xmax=10
Xscl=1
Ymin=-10
Ymax=10
Yscl=1
Xres=1
(Par mode)
WINDOW
Tmin=0
Tmax=p2
Tstep=p24
Xmin=-10
Xmax=10
Xscl=1
Ymin=-10
Ymax=10
Yscl=1
(Pol mode)
WINDOW
qmin=0
qmax=p2
qstep=p24
Xmin=-10
Xmax=10
Xscl=1
Ymin=-10
Ymax=10
Yscl=1
(Seq mode)
WINDOW
nMin=1
nMax=10
PlotStart=1
PlotStep=1
Xmin=-10
Xmax=10
Xscl=1
Ymin=-10
Ymax=10
Yscl=1
y [TBLSET]
y[TBLSET]
TABLE SETUP
TblStart=0
@Tbl=1
Indpnt:Auto Ask
Depend:Auto Ask
(PRGM editor)
TABLE SETUP
Indpnt:Auto Ask
Depend:Auto Ask
TI-82 STATS Menu Map
A40 Tables and Reference Information
826DEC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 2:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:09
PM Page 40 of 58
q
ZOOM
1:ZBox
2:Zoom In
3:Zoom Out
4:ZDecimal
5:ZSquare
6:ZStandard
7:ZTrig
8:ZInteger
9:ZoomStat
0:ZoomFit
MEMORY
1:ZPrevious
2:ZoomSto
3:ZoomRcl
4:SetFactors
MEMORY
(Set Factors...)
ZOOM FACTORS
XFact=4
YFact=4
y [FORMAT]
(Func/Par/Pol modes)
RectGC PolarGC
CoordOn CoordOff
GridOff GridOn
AxesOn AxesOff
LabelOff LabelOn
ExprOn ExprOff
(Seq mode)
Time Web uv vw uw
RectGC PolarGC
CoordOn CoordOff
GridOff GridOn
AxesOn AxesOff
LabelOff LabelOn
ExprOn ExprOff
y [CALC]
(Func mode)
CALCULATE
1:value
2:zero
3:minimum
4:maximum
5:intersect
6:dy/dx
7:f(x)dx
(Par mode)
CALCULATE
1:value
2:dy/dx
3:dy/dt
4:dx/dt
(Pol mode)
CALCULATE
1:value
2:dy/dx
3:dr/dq
(Seq mode)
CALCULATE
1:value
z
EDIT
1:Edit
2:SortA(
3:SortD(
4:ClrList
5:SetUpEditor
CALC
1:1-Var Stats
2:2-Var Stats
3:Med-Med
4:LinReg(ax+b)
5:QuadReg
6:CubicReg
7:QuartReg
8:LinReg(a+bx)
9:LnReg
0:ExpReg
A:PwrReg
B:Logistic
C:SinReg
TESTS
1:Z-Test
2:T-Test
3:2-SampZTest
4:2-SampTTest
5:1-PropZTest
6:2-PropZTest
7:ZInterval
8:TInterval
9:2-SampZInt
0:2-SampTInt
A:1-PropZInt
B:2-PropZInt
C:c
2
-Test
D:2-Samp Test
E:LinRegTTest
F:ANOVA(
A42 Tables and Reference Information
826DEC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 2:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:09
PM Page 42 of 58
y [LIST]
NAMES
1:listname
2:listname
3:listname
...
OPS
1:SortA(
2:SortD(
3:dim(
4:Fill(
5:seq(
6:cumSum(
7:@List(
8:Select(
9:augment(
0:List4matr(
A:Matr4list(
B:
MATH
1:min(
2:max(
3:mean(
4:median(
5:sum(
6:prod(
7:stdDev(
8:variance(
MATH
1:4Frac
2:4Dec
3:
3
4:
3
(
5:
x
6:fMin(
7:fMax(
8:nDeriv(
9:fnInt(
0:Solver
NUM
1:abs(
2:round(
3:iPart(
4:fPart(
5:int(
6:min(
7:max(
8:lcm(
9:gcd(
CPX
1:conj(
2:real(
3:imag(
4:angle(
5:abs(
6:4Rect
7:4Polar
PRB
1:rand
2:nPr
3:nCr
4:!
5:randInt(
6:randNorm(
7:randBin(
y [TEST]
TEST
1:=
2:
3:>
4:
5:<
6:
LOGIC
1:and
2:or
3:xor
4:not(
TI-82 STATS Menu Map (continued)
Tables and Reference Information A43
826DEC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 2:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:09
PM Page 43 of 58
y[ANGLE]
NAMES
1:[A]
2:[B]
3:[C]
4:[D]
5:[E]
6:[F]
7:[G]
8:[H]
9:[I]
0:[J]
MATH
1:det(
2:
T
3:dim(
4:Fill(
5:identity(
6:randM(
7:augment(
8:Matr4list(
9:List4matr(
0:cumSum(
A:ref(
B:rref(
C:rowSwap(
D:row+(
E:row(
F:row+(
EDIT
1:[A]
2:[B]
3:[C]
4:[D]
5:[E]
6:[F]
7:[G]
8:[H]
9:[I]
0:[J]
ANGLE
1:
2:'
3:
r
4:4DMS
5:R4Pr(
6:R4Pq(
7:P4Rx(
8:P4Ry(
EXEC
1:name
2:name
...
EDIT
1:name
2:name
...
NEW
1:Create New
(PRGM editor)
CTL
1:If
2:Then
3:Else
4:For(
5:While
6:Repeat
7:End
8:Pause
9:Lbl
0:Goto
A:IS>(
B:DS<(
C:Menu(
D:prgm
E:Return
F:Stop
G:DelVar
H:GraphStyle(
(PRGM editor)
I/O
1:Input
2:Prompt
3:Disp
4:DispGraph
5:DispTable
6:Output(
7:getKey
8:ClrHome
9:ClrTable
0:GetCalc(
A:Get(
B:Send(
(PRGM editor)
EXEC
1:name
2:name
...
A44 Tables and Reference Information
826DEC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 2:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:09
PM Page 44 of 58
y [DRAW]
DRAW
1:ClrDraw
2:Line(
3:Horizontal
4:Vertical
5:Tangent(
6:DrawF
7:Shade(
8:DrawInv
9:Circle(
0:Text(
A:Pen
POINTS
1:Pt-On(
2:Pt-Off(
3:Pt-Change(
4:Pxl-On(
5:Pxl-Off(
6:Pxl-Change(
7:pxl-Test(
STO
1:StorePic
2:RecallPic
3:StoreGDB
4:RecallGDB
VARS
1:Window
2:Zoom
3:GDB
4:Picture
5:Statistics
6:Table
7:String
Y-VARS
1:Function
2:Parametric
3:Polar
4:On/Off
VARS
(Window)
X/Y
1:Xmin
2:Xmax
3:Xscl
4:Ymin
5:Ymax
6:Yscl
7:Xres
8:@X
9:@Y
0:XFact
A:YFact
(Window)
T/q
1:Tmin
2:Tmax
3:Tstep
4:qmin
5:qmax
6:qstep
(Window)
U/V/W
1:u(nMin)
2:v(nMin)
3:w(nMin)
4:nMin
5:nMax
6:PlotStart
7:PlotStep
TI-82 STATS Menu Map (continued)
Tables and Reference Information A45
826DEC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 2:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:09
PM Page 45 of 58
VARS
(Zoom)
ZX/ZY
1:ZXmin
2:ZXmax
3:ZXscl
4:ZYmin
5:ZYmax
6:ZYscl
7:ZXres
(Zoom)
ZT/Zq
1:ZTmin
2:ZTmax
3:ZTstep
4:Zqmin
5:Zqmax
6:Zqstep
(Zoom)
ZU
1:Zu(nMin)
2:Zv(nMin)
3:Zw(nMin)
4:ZnMin
5:ZnMax
6:ZPlotStart
7:ZPlotStep
VARS
(GDB)
GRAPH DATABASE
1:GDB1
2:GDB2
...
9:GDB9
0:GDB0
(Picture)
PICTURE
1:Pic1
2:Pic2
...
9:Pic9
0:Pic0
VARS
(Statistics)
XY
1:n
2:v
3:Sx
4:sx
5:w
6:Sy
7:sy
8:minX
9:maxX
0:minY
A:maxY
(Statistics)
G
1:Gx
2:Gx
2
3:Gy
4:Gy
2
5:Gxy
(Statistics)
EQ
1:RegEQ
2:a
3:b
4:c
5:d
6:e
7:r
8:r
2
9:R
2
(Statistics)
TEST
1:p
2:z
3:t
4:c
2
5:
6:df
7:
8: 1
9: 2
0:s
A: 1
B: 2
C:Sx1
D:Sx2
E:Sxp
F:n1
G:n2
H:lower
I:upper
(Statistics)
PTS
1:x1
2:y1
3:x2
4:y2
5:x3
6:y3
7:Q1
8:Med
9:Q3
A46 Tables and Reference Information
826DEC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 2:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:09
PM Page 46 of 58
VARS
(Table)
TABLE
1:TblStart
2:@Tbl
3:TblInput
(String)
STRING
1:Str1
2:Str2
3:Str3
4:Str4
...
9:Str9
0:Str0
Y-VARS
(Function)
FUNCTION
1:Y1
2:Y2
3:Y3
4:Y4
...
9:Y9
0:Y0
(Parametric)
PARAMETRIC
1:X1T
2:Y1T
3:X2T
4:Y2T
...
A:X6T
B:Y6T
(Polar)
POLAR
1:r1
2:r2
3:r3
4:r4
5:r5
6:r6
(On/Off)
ON/OFF
1:FnOn
2:FnOff
TI-82 STATS Menu Map (continued)
Tables and Reference Information A47
826DEC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 2:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:09
PM Page 47 of 58
y [DISTR]
DISTR
1:normalpdf(
2:normalcdf(
3:invNorm(
4:tpdf(
5:tcdf(
6:c
2
pdf(
7:c
2
cdf(
8: pdf(
9: cdf(
0:binompdf(
A:binomcdf(
B:poissonpdf(
C:poissoncdf(
D:geometpdf(
E:geometcdf(
DRAW
1:ShadeNorm(
2:Shade_t(
3:Shadec
2
(
4:Shade (
y [FINANCE]
CALC
1:TVM Solver
2:tvm_Pmt
3:tvm_
4:tvm_PV
5:tvm_
6:tvm_FV
7:npv(
8:irr(
9:bal(
0:GPrn(
A:GInt(
B:4Nom(
C:4Eff(
D:dbd(
E:Pmt_End
F:Pmt_Bgn
VARS
1:
2:
3:PV
4:PMT
5:FV
6:P/Y
7:C/Y
A48 Tables and Reference Information
826DEC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 2:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:09
PM Page 48 of 58
y [MEM]
MEMORY
MEMORY
1:Check RAM
2:Delete
3:Clear Entries
4:ClrAllLists
5:Reset
(Check RAM)
MEM FREE 27225
Real 15
Complex 0
List 0
Matrix 0
Y-Vars 240
Prgm 14
Pic 0
GDB 0
String 0
(Delete)
DELETE FROM
1:All
2:Real
3:Complex
4:List
5:Matrix
6:Y-Vars
7:Prgm
8:Pic
9:GDB
0:String
(Reset)
RESET
1:All Memory
2:Defaults
MEMORY (Reset...)
y[CATALOG]
(All Memory)
RESET MEMORY
1:No
2:Reset
Resetting memory erases
all data and programs.
(Defaults)
RESET DEFAULTS
1:No
2:Reset
CATALOG
cosh(
cosh
L1
(
...
Equ4String(
expr(
...
inString(
...
length(
...
sinh(
sinh
L1
(
...
String4Equ(
sub(
...
tanh(
tanh
L1
(
TI-82 STATS Menu Map (continued)
Tables and Reference Information A49
826DEC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 2:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:09
PM Page 49 of 58
The TI-82 STATS uses the variables listed below in various
ways. Some variables are restricted to specific data types.
The variables A through Z and q are defined as real or complex
numbers. You may store to them. The TI-82 STATS can update
X, Y, R, q, and T during graphing, so you may want to avoid
using these variables to store nongraphing data.
The variables (list names) L1 through L6 are restricted to lists;
you cannot store another type of data to them.
The variables (matrix names) [A] through [J] are restricted to
matrices; you cannot store another type of data to them.
The variables Pic1 through Pic9 and Pic0 are restricted to
pictures; you cannot store another type of data to them.
The variables GDB1 through GDB9 and GDB0 are restricted to
graph databases; you cannot store another type of data to them.
The variables Str1 through Str9 and Str0 are restricted to
strings; you cannot store another type of data to them.
You can store any string of characters, functions, instructions, or
variables to the functions Yn, (1 through 9, and 0), XnT/YnT (1
through 6), rn (1 through 6), u(n), v(n), and w(n) directly or
through the Y= editor. The validity of the string is determined
when the function is evaluated.
The variables below must be real numbers. You may store to
them. Since the TI-82 STATS can update some of them, as the
result of a ZOOM, for example, you may want to avoid using
these variables to store nongraphing data.
Xmin, Xmax, Xscl, @X, XFact, Tstep, PlotStart, nMin, and
other window variables.
ZXmin, ZXmax, ZXscl, ZTstep, ZPlotStart, Zu(nMin), and
other ZOOM variables.
The variables below are reserved for use by the TI-82 STATS.
You cannot store to them.
n, v, Sx, sx, minX, maxX, Gy, Gy
2
, Gxy, a, b, c, RegEQ, x1, x2,
y1, z, t, F, c
2
, , v1, Sx1, n1, lower, upper, r
2
, R
2
and other
statistical variables.
Variables
User Variables
System Variables
A50 Tables and Reference Information
826DEC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 2:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:09
PM Page 50 of 58
This section contains statistics formulas for the Logistic and SinReg regressions,
ANOVA, 2.Samp Test, and 2.SampTTest.
The logistic regression algorithm applies nonlinear recursive
least-squares techniques to optimize the following cost function:
J
c
ae
y
bx
i
i
N
i
=
+
|
\
|
.
|
1
2
1
which is the sum of the squares of the residual errors,
where: x = the independent variable list
y = the dependent variable list
N = the dimension of the lists
This technique attempts to estimate the constants a, b, and c
recursively to make J as small as possible.
The sine regression algorithm applies nonlinear recursive least-
squares techniques to optimize the following cost function:
[ ]
J a bx c d y
i i
i
N
= + +
=
sin( )
2
1
which is the sum of the squares of the residual errors,
where: x = the independent variable list
y = the dependent variable list
N = the dimension of the lists
This technique attempts to recursively estimate the constants a,
b, c, and d to make J as small as possible.
Statistics Formulas
Logistic
SinReg
Tables and Reference Information A51
826DEC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 2:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:09
PM Page 51 of 58
The ANOVA statistic is:
=
Factor MS
Error MS
The mean squares (MS) that make up are:
Factor MS
Factor SS
Factor df
=
Error MS
Error SS
Error df
=
The sum of squares (SS) that make up the mean squares are:
Factor SS n x x
i i
i
I
( ) =
=
2
1
Error SS n Sx
i i
i
I
( ) =
=
1
2
1
The degrees of freedom df that make up the mean squares are:
Factor df I df = = 1 numerator for
Error df n df
i
i
I
( ) denominator for = =
=
1
1
where: I = number of populations
x
i
= the mean of each list
Sxi = the standard deviation of each list
ni = the length of each list
x = the mean of all lists
ANOVA(
A52 Tables and Reference Information
826DEC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 2:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:09
PM Page 52 of 58
Below is the definition for the 2.Samp Test.
Sx1, Sx2 = Sample standard deviations having n
1
-1
and n
2
-1 degrees of freedom df,
respectively.
= -statistic =
Sx
Sx
1
2
2
|
\
|
.
|
df(x, n
1
-1, n
2
-1) = pdf( ) with degrees of freedom
df, n
1
-1, and n
2
-1
p = reported p value
2.Samp Test for the alternative hypothesis s
1
> s
2
.
p f x n n dx
F
=
( ) , ,
1 2
1 1
2.Samp Test for the alternative hypothesis s
1
< s
2
.
p f x n n dx
F
=
( ) , ,
1 2
0
1 1
2.Samp Test for the alternative hypothesis s
1
s
2
. Limits
must satisfy the following:
p
f x n n dx f x n n dx
L
U
bnd
bnd
2
1 1 1 1
1 2
0
1 2
= =
( ) ( ) , , , ,
where: [Lbnd,Ubnd] = lower and upper limits
The -statistic is used as the bound producing the smallest
integral. The remaining bound is selected to achieve the
preceding integrals equality relationship.
Statistics Formulas (continued)
2.Samp Test
Tables and Reference Information A53
826DEC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 2:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:09
PM Page 53 of 58
The following is the definition for the 2.SampTTest. The two-
sample t statistic with degrees of freedom df is:
t
x x
S
=
1 2
where the computation of S and df are dependent on whether the
variances are pooled. If the variances are not pooled:
S
Sx
n
Sx
n
= +
1
2
1
2
2
2
df
Sx
n
Sx
n
n
Sx
n n
Sx
n
=
+
|
\
|
.
|
|
\
|
.
|
+
|
\
|
.
|
1
2
1
2
2
2
2
1
1
2
1
2
2
2
2
2
2
1
1
1
1
otherwise:
Sx
n Sx n Sx
df
p
=
+ ( ) ( )
1 1
2
2 2
2
1 1
S
n n
Sx
p
= +
1 1
1 2
df n n = +
1 2
2
and Sxp is the pooled variance.
2.SampTTest
A54 Tables and Reference Information
826DEC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 2:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:09
PM Page 54 of 58
This section contains financial formulas for computing time value of money,
amortization, cash flow, interest-rate conversions, and days between dates.
[ ]
i e
y x
=
+ ( ( )) ln 1
1
where: PMT 0
y = C/Y P/Y
x = (.01 I%) C/Y
C/Y = compounding periods per year
P/Y = payment periods per year
I% = interest rate per year
i FV PV
N
=
( )
( ) 1
1
where: PMT = 0
The iteration used to compute i:
0
1 1
1 = +
+
(
+ +
PV PMT G
i
i
FV i
i
N
N
( )
( )
[ ]
I C Y e
y x
% / =
+
1100
( ln( )) 1
1
where: x = i
y = P/Y C/Y
G i k
i
= + 1
where: k = 0 for end-of-period payments
k = 1 for beginning-of-period payments
N
PMT G FV i
PMT G PV i
i
i
i
=
|
\
|
.
|
+
+
ln
ln( ) 1
where: i 0
N PV FV PMT = +
( )
where: i = 0
Financial Formulas
Time Value of
Money
Tables and Reference Information A55
826DEC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 2:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:09
PM Page 55 of 58
PMT
i
G
PV
PV FV
i
i
N
= +
+
+
( ) 1 1
where: i 0
PMT PV FV N = +
( )
where: i = 0
PV
PMT G
i
FV
i
PMT G
i
i
N
i
=
+
1
1 ( )
where: i 0
PV FV PMT N = +
( )
where: i = 0
FV
PMT G
i
i PV
PMT G
i
i
N
i
=
+ +
|
\
|
.
|
( ) 1
where: i 0
FV PV PMT N = +
( )
where: i = 0
Time Value of
Money
(Continued)
A56 Tables and Reference Information
826DEC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 2:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:09
PM Page 56 of 58
If computing bal( ), pmt2 = npmt
Let bal(0) = RND(PV)
Iterate from m = 1 to pmt2
I
I
m
m
=
= +
RND RND i bal m
bal m bal m RND PMT
[ ( ( ))]
( ) ( ) ( )
12 1
1
then:
bal bal pmt ( ) ( ) = 2
Pr n bal pmt bal pmt ( ) ( ) ( ) = 2 1
Int pmt pmt RND PMT n ( ) ( ) ( ) ( ) = + 2 1 1 Pr
where: RND = round the display to the number of
decimal places selected
RND12 = round to 12 decimal places
Balance, principal, and interest are dependent on the values of
PMT, PV, , and pmt1 and pmt2.
Financial Formulas (continued)
Amortization
Tables and Reference Information A57
826DEC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 2:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:09
PM Page 57 of 58
npv CF CF i
i
i
j
S
n
j
N
j
j
( ) ( )
( ( ) )
= + +
+
0
1
1
1 1
1
where: S
n j
j
j
i
i
j
=
=
1
1
0 0
Net present value is dependent on the values of the initial cash
flow (CF
0
), subsequent cash flows (CFj), frequency of each
cash flow (nj), and the specified interest rate (i).
irr( ) = 100 i, where i satisfies npv( ) = 0
Internal rate of return is dependent on the values of the initial
cash flow (CF
0
) and subsequent cash flows (CFj).
i = I% 100
4Eff( ) ( )
( )
=
+
100 1
1
e
CP x ln
where: x = .01 NOM CP
[ ]
4Nom( )
( )
=
+
100 1
1 1
CP e
CP x ln
where: x = .01 EFF
EFF = effective rate
CP = compounding periods
NOM = nominal rate
Cash Flow
Interest Rate
Conversions
A58 Tables and Reference Information
826DEC~1.DOC TI-83 international English Bob Fedorisko Revised: 10/26/05 2:20 PM Printed: 10/27/05 3:09
PM Page 58 of 58
With the dbd( function, you can enter or compute a date within
the range Jan. 1, 1950, through Dec. 31, 2049.
Actual/actual day-count method (assumes actual number of
days per month and actual number of days per year):
dbd( (days between dates) =
Number of Days II - Number of Days I
Number of Days I = (Y1-YB) 365
+ (number of days MB to M1)
+ DT1
+
( ) Y YB 1
4